Tiggo PDF
Tiggo PDF
Tiggo PDF
2009
Title Section
CHERY
GENERAL INFORMATION 01
Tiggo
ENGINE 02
Service Manual
ELECTRONIC ENGINE CONTROLS 03
FOREWORD
This manual contains on-vehicle service
and diagnosis procedures for the Chery Tiggo. FUEL DELIVERY 04
CONTENTS page
Service Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 01-1
Vehicle Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 01-9
Electrical Circuit Diagnosis Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 01-14
Electrical Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 01-19
SERVICE INFORMATION
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL 01-2 PROPER SERVICE PRACTICES 01-5
Topics 01-2 Removal of Parts 01-5
Service Procedures 01-2 Component Disassembly 01-5
Diagnostic Procedures 01-2 Inspection of Parts 01-5
Specifications 01-2 Arrangement of Parts 01-6
Cleaning of Parts 01-6
VEHICLE SERVICE PREPARATION 01-3 Component Reassembly 01-6
Preparation For Vehicle Service 01-3 Adjustments 01-7
Tools and Testing Equipment 01-3 Rubber Parts and Rubber Tubing 01-7
Special Tools 01-4 Hose Clamps 01-8
Disconnection of the Negative Battery Vise 01-8
Cable 01-4 Dynamometer 01-8
Service Procedures
Most repair procedures begin with an illustration. It identifies the components, shows how the parts fit together and
describes visual part inspection. Removal & Installation procedures have written instructions.
Service procedures include the following elements:
• Detailed removal & installation instructions
• Integrated torque specifications
• Integrated illustrations
• Component specifications
Diagnostic Procedures
The diagnostic procedures are grouped into the following:
Diagnostic Symptoms
• Symptom troubleshooting quickly determines the location of the malfunction according to symptom type.
Specifications
This manual contains specifications that are divided into the following groups:
• Torque specifications
• Clearance specifications
• Capacity specifications
BESM010004
BESM010005
Special Tools
• Use special tools when they are required.
BESM010006T
LTSM010002
BESM010007
Component Disassembly
• If the disassembly procedure is complex requiring
many parts to be disassembled, make sure that all
parts are disassembled in a way that will not affect
their performance or external appearance. Identify
each part so reassembly can be performed easily
and efficiently.
BESM010008
Inspection of Parts
• When removed, inspect each part for possible mal-
function, deformation, damage or other problems.
BESM010009
Arrangement of Parts
• All disassembled parts should be carefully arranged
for reassembly.
• Be sure to separate or otherwise identify the parts
to be replaced from those that will be reused.
BESM010010
Cleaning of Parts
• Carefully and thoroughly clean all parts to be
reused.
BESM010011
WARNING!
Using compressed air can cause dirt and other particles to fly out causing injury to the eyes. Wear protective
eyewear whenever using compressed air.
Component Reassembly
• Standard values, such as torques and certain
adjustments, must be strictly observed in the reas-
sembly of all parts. If removed, replace these parts
with new ones:
− Oil seals
− Gaskets
− O-rings
− Lock washers
− Cotter pins
− Nylon nuts
BESM010012
Depending on location:
• Apply sealant and gaskets, or both, to specified
locations. When sealant is applied, install parts
before sealant hardens to prevent leaks.
• Apply oil to the moving components of parts.
• Apply specified oil or grease at the prescribed loca- 01
tions (such as oil seals) before reassembly.
BESM010013
Adjustments
• Use suitable gauges and testers when making
adjustments.
BESM010014
BESM010015
Hose Clamps
• When reinstalling, position the hose clamp in the
original location on the hose and squeeze the
clamp lightly with large pliers to ensure a good fit.
BESM010016
Vise
• When using a vise, put protective plates in the
jaws of the vise to prevent damage to parts.
BESM010017
Dynamometer
• When test-running a vehicle on a dynamometer:
− Place a fan, preferably a vehicle-speed proportional type, in front of the vehicle.
− Connect an exhaust gas ventilation unit.
WARNING!
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless. Breathing
it can make you unconscious and can eventually poison you.
01
BESM010002
• Digits #1, #2, #3 The first 3 vehicle identification number (VIN) positions are the world manufacturer identifier:
− ⬙LVV⬙ represents Chery Automobile Co., Ltd.
• Digit #4 The fourth digit of the VIN code represents the brand of the vehicle:
− The brand ⬙Chery⬙ is represented by the letter ⬙D⬙.
• Digit #5 The fifth digit of the VIN code represents the body configuration of the vehicle:
− ⬙A⬙ represents three compartments, five-door, and 4X2.
− ⬙B⬙ represents two compartments, five-door, and 4X2.
− ⬙C⬙ represents three compartments, four-door, two-lid, and 4X2.
− ⬙D⬙ represents two compartments, five-door, and 4X4.
• Digit #6 The sixth digit of VIN code represents the type of transmission:
− ⬙1⬙ represents manual transmission.
− ⬙2⬙ represents automatic transmission.
• Digit #7 The seventh digit of VIN code represents the type of engine:
− ⬙1⬙ represents electronically controlled gasoline engines 1.5L - 2.0L (excluding 2.0L) series.
− ⬙2⬙ represents engines smaller than 1.5L (excluding 1.5L).
− ⬙4⬙ represents 2.0L - 2.5L engines (excluding 2.5L).
• Digit #8 The eighth digit of VIN code represents the Restraint System:
− ⬙A⬙ represents manual safety belts.
− ⬙B⬙ represents manual safety belts plus air bags in the front row.
• Digit #9 The ninth digit of VIN code is the check digit:
− It is to check accuracy of VIN record, and is made out through computation after confirming the other six-
teen digits of VIN
• Digit #10 The tenth VIN position represents the model year code:
− ⬙5⬙ represents the year 2005
• Digit #11 The eleventh VIN position represents the assembly plant code:
− ⬙D⬙ represents the ⬙Chery Automobile Co., Ltd.⬙
• Digits #12, #13, #14, #15, #16, #17 The last six VIN positions represent the production sequence number.
− This represents the actual production number of the vehicle.
BESM010003
Fasteners and torque specification references in this Service Manual are identified in metric format.
During any maintenance or repair procedures, it is important to salvage all fasteners (nuts, bolts, etc.) for reassembly.
If the fastener is not salvageable, a fastener of equivalent specification must be used.
STEP DESCRIPTION 01
Obtain detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the electrical
Step 1
incident occurred.
Operate the affected system, road test the vehicle if necessary.
Step 2 Verify the parameter of the incident.
If the problem cannot be duplicated, refer to “Electrical Failure Simulation Tests”.
Gather the proper diagnosis material together including:
• Electrical Power Supply Routing Diagram
• System Operation Descriptions
Step 3 • Applicable Service Manual Sections
• Check for any Service Bulletins
Identify where to begin diagnosis based upon your knowledge of the system operation
and the customer comments.
Inspect the system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage.
Step 4 Determine which circuits and components are involved and diagnose using the Electrical
Power Supply Routing Diagram and Harness Layouts.
Step 5 Repair the circuit or replace the component as necessary.
Operate the system in all modes. Verify the system functions properly under all conditions.
Step 6 Confirm you have not inadvertently created an additional new incident during your
diagnosis or repair steps.
NOTE :
Always get a thorough description of the incident from the customer. It is important for simulating the conditions of
the problem.
NOTE :
Connectors can be exposed to moisture. It is possible for a thin film of corrosion to form on the connector terminals.
A visual inspection may not reveal this without disconnecting the connector. If the problem occurs intermittently, per-
haps the problem is caused by corrosion. It is a good idea to disconnect, inspect and clean the terminals on related
connectors in the system.
Engine Compartment
• There are several reasons a vehicle or engine vibration could cause an electrical complaint. Some of the things
to check for are:
− Connectors not fully seated.
− Wiring harness not long enough and is being stressed due to engine vibrations or rocking.
− Wires laying across brackets or moving components.
− Loose, dirty or corroded ground wires.
− Wires routed too close to hot components.
• To inspect components under the hood, start by verifying the integrity of the ground connections (See Ground
Inspection described later). First, verify that the system is properly grounded. Then check for any loose connec-
tions by gently shaking the wiring or components as previously explained. Using the wiring diagrams, inspect
the wiring for continuity.
CAUTION:
Do not heat components above 60 °C (140 °F).
If the incident occurs while heat testing the component, replace or properly insulate the component as needed.
Freezing Test
The customer may indicate the incident goes away after the vehicle warms up (winter time). The cause could be
related to water freezing somewhere in the wiring/electrical system. There are two methods to check for this:
• The first method is to arrange for the owner to leave the vehicle overnight. Make sure it will get cold enough to
demonstrate the complaint. Leave the vehicle parked outside overnight. In the morning, do a quick and thor-
ough diagnosis of those electrical components which could be affected.
• The second method is to put the suspect component into a freezer long enough for any water to freeze. Rein-
stall the part into the vehicle and check for the reoccurrence of the incident. If it occurs, repair or replace the
component as needed.
LTSMD030028
• When checking input and output signals of the control module, use the specified test adapter (if applicable).
NOTE :
If the male terminal can be easily inserted into the female terminal, replace the female terminal.
BESMW010003T
• In wiring diagrams, male terminals are shown in
black and female terminals are shown in white.
NOTE :
Connector guides for male terminals are shown in
black and female terminals in white in wiring
diagrams.
BESMW010004T
Option Splices
01
BESMW010002T
• Option splices are shown with solid diamond-shaped boxes with identification numbers inside.
BESMW010001T
NOTE :
Some service manual chapters DO NOT contain electrical schematics, and will be identified as None in the Com-
ponent/Vehicle System column.
02 - Engine • None
• Fuel Injectors
04 - Fuel Delivery
• Fuel Level Sensor and Fuel Pump
• Starter Motor
• Ignition Switch
05 - Starting & Charging
• Clutch Pedal Switch (if equipped)
• Generator
07 - Exhaust • None
01
• Transaxle Control Module (TCM)
• Automatic Transaxle Shifter Selector
• Automatic Transaxle Assembly
• Manual Transaxle Assembly
08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case
• Winter Mode Switch
• EPDE Solenoid Valve
• Backup Lamp Switch
• Integrated Torque Management (ITM) Control Module
10 - Suspension • None
• Power Distribution
• Front Fuse and Relay Box
16 - Wiring
• Power Fuse Box
• Ignition Switch
• Ground Distribution
Abbreviation List
TERM ABBREVIATION
Antilock Brake System ABS
Accelerator Sensor AES
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor APS
Automatic Temperature Control ATC
Automatic Transaxle Fluid ATF
Body Control Module BCM
Brake Pressure Sensor BPS
Camshaft Position CMP
Clutch Pedal Position Switch CPP Switch
Crankshaft Position CKP
Data Link Connector DLC
Diagnostic Trouble Code DTC
Engine Control Module ECM
Engine Coolant Temperature ECT
Engine Speed RPM
Evaporative Emission EVAP
Evaporative Emission Canister EVAP Canister
Evaporative Emission System EVAP System
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve EGR Valve
TERM ABBREVIATION
Front Left Wheel Speed Sensor FLS
Front Right Wheel Speed Sensor FRS
Rear Left Wheel Speed Sensor RCS 01
Rear Right Wheel Speed Sensor RRS
Ground GND
Heated Oxygen Sensor O2S
Idle Air Control IAC
Intake Air Temperature IAT
Ignition IGN
Ignition Control IC
Injector INJ
Input Shaft Speed Sensor ISS Sensor
Knock Sensor KS
Manifold Absolute Pressure MAP
Mass Air Flow MAF
Malfunction Indicator Lamp MIL
Oil Pressure Switch OPS
Output Shaft Speed Sensor OSS Sensor
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve PCV Valve
Power Supply PWR
SRS Airbag Control System SRC
Throttle Position Sensor TPS
Transmission Control Module TCM
Turbine Speed Sensor TSS
Vehicle Identification Number VIN
Vehicle Speed Sensor VSS
Operation
The 1.6L & 1.8L engines utilize 4 valve-per-cylinders and a dual overhead camshaft design. The engines use an
individual coil ignition system. The cylinder block is made of cast iron (1.6L is the Aluminum cylinder block) and the
bearing caps are integrated into the lower cylinder block assembly. An aluminum oil pan bolts to the bottom of the
lower cylinder block. The camshafts are mounted in the cylinder head and act against valve tappets to open and
close the valves. The camshafts are driven off the front of the cylinder head by one timing belt. The belt is driven by
a sprocket that is located on the crankshaft. The piston assembly is an aluminum piston with a cast iron connecting
rod.
The aluminum cylinder head contains dual overhead camshafts with 4 valve-per-cylinder construction. The valves are
arranged in two in-line banks. The cylinder head incorporates powdered metal valve guides and seats. The cylinder
head is sealed to the block using a multi-layer steel head gasket and retaining bolts.
Specifications
1.6L Engine Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Type In-Line OHV, DOHC
Number of Cylinders 4
Compression Ratio 10.5:1
Compression Pressure 10-15 Bar
Max. Compression Pressure Variation Between
25%
Cylinders
Stroke 77.5 mm
Bore 81 mm
Displacement 1597 cc
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Type In-Line OHV, DOHC
Number of Cylinders 4
Compression Ratio 10.5:1
Compression Pressure 10-15 Bar
Max. Compression Pressure Variation Between
25%
Cylinders
Stroke 89.5 mm
Bore 81 mm
Displacement 1845 cc
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Torque Specifications
CAUTION:
When torquing a fastener in two steps, DO NOT use a torque wrench for the second step.
Special Tools
Crankshaft Holder
CH-20003
Camshaft Holder
CH-20010
02
Engine Hoist
Lubrication System
02
LTSM020161
The engine lubrication system operates as follows:
• Oil is drawn into the oil pump through the oil pump strainer tube in the sump of the oil pan.
• Oil is pumped through the oil filter to the cylinder block.
• Oil enters the main oil gallery where it is distributed to the crankshaft main journals and to the cylinder head.
• From the main journals, the oil is routed through cross-drilled passages in the crankshaft to lubricate the con-
necting rod bearings. Controlled leakage through the crankshaft main bearings and connecting rod bearings is
slung radially outward to cool and lubricate the cylinder walls as well as the entire connecting rod, piston and
piston ring assembly.
BESM020088
NOTE :
The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide to diagnosing engine problems. An engine
should not be disassembled to determine the cause of low compression unless some malfunction is present.
02
LTSM020163
WARNING!
Inspect the drive belt only when the engine is stopped.
1. While using a suitable tool and securely holding the hexagonal portion of the drive belt tensioner, rotate the
pulley counterclockwise to loosen the drive belt.
WARNING!
Avoid placing hands near the drive belt tensioner while it is being held.
LTSM020196
LTSM020226
BESM020022
NOTE :
Install a new cylinder head cover gasket during
installation.
LTSM020198
Camshaft
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20002 - Camshaft seal installer
• CH-20010 - Camshaft holder
1. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove the intake or exhaust camshaft timing belt pulley.
(Tighten: Camshaft timing belt pulley bolt to 120 N·m)
5. Remove the rear timing cover of the timing pul-
ley.
(Tighten: Rear timing cover bolts to 7 N·m)
BESM020034
BESM020035
Installation Notes:
• Use special tool CH-20010 (1), to install the camshaft holder to hold the camshafts in place.
NOTE :
The camshaft holder will prevent the camshafts from
rotating in either direction.
BESM020016
02
LTSM020215
BESM020036
Cylinder Head
Removal & Installation
02
LTSM020167
NOTE :
Replacement cylinder head comes complete with valves, seals, springs, retainers, keepers, and camshafts.
1. Remove engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the camshafts (See Camshaft Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove intake manifold (See Intake Manifold Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
5. Remove exhaust manifold (See Exhaust Manifold Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
6. Remove water pipe and thermostat assembly.
BESM020065
Installation Notes:
• Ensure cylinder head bolt holes in the block are clean, dry (free of residual oil or coolant), and threads are not
damaged.
• The cylinder head bolts should not be reused. The new bolts should be examined before use. If the bolts are
stretched, the bolts should be replaced.
• Position the new cylinder head gasket on the engine block with the part number facing up. Ensure gasket is
seated over the locating dowels in the block.
• Before installing the bolts, the threads should be lightly coated with engine oil.
02
LTSM020236
BESM020055
3. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to damage the front cover seal
surface while removing the seal.
LTSM020199
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate the new front seal with engine oil prior to assembly.
• Use the front crankshaft seal installer CH-20008 (1), to install the new seal.
LTSM020216
BESM080046
02
BESM020058
Installation Notes:
• When installing seal, lubricate seal guide with
clean engine oil.
• Position the seal over the rear crankshaft seal
guide.
• Use special tool CH-20005 (2) CH-20006 (1), to
install the rear crankshaft oil seal.
• Ensure that the lip of the seal is facing toward
the crankcase during installation.
LTSM020217
Engine Mounts
Removal & Installation - Left Mount
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• Engine Hoist
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the air cleaner housing (See Air Cleaner
Housing Removal & Installation in Section 02
Engine).
3. Remove the engine left mount retaining bolts (2)
and remove the engine left mount bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Engine left mount bolts to 70 N·m)
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM020156
LTSM020155
BESM080035
LTSM020188
Engine Assembly
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20001 - Right engine mount bolt remover
• Engine hoist
NOTE :
The engine is removed with the transaxle as an assembly.
1. Remove the vehicle hood.
2. Remove the negative battery cable from the engine.
3. Remove the engine cover.
4. Remove the battery, battery hold downs, and battery tray (See Battery Removal & Installation in Section 05
Starting & Charging).
5. Discharge air conditioning system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air
Conditioning).
LTSM020190
7. Remove the coolant fan & radiator assembly if necessary (See Coolant Fan & Radiator Assembly Removal &
Installation in Section 06 Cooling).
8. Remove the starter motor wiring.
9. Relieve the fuel pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
10. Disconnect and remove the fuel line at the fuel rail.
11. Remove the air inlet hose and the air cleaner case
assembly.
NOTE: For 1.8L engine, disconnect the air flow
sensor electrical connector.
LTSM020226
12. Remove the ground cable bolt from the cylinder head.
LTSM020235
BESM020025
LTSM020200
BESM020029
BESM020078
LTSM020201
02
LTSM020202
BESM020028
32. Lower the vehicle and install engine lift chain hangers.
33. Remove the bolts (1) securing the front engine
mount.
(Tighten: Engine front mount bolt to 60 N·m)
BESM080035
LTSM020207
BESM080036
LTSM020218
38. Verify all components between the engine and vehicle are disconnected.
39. Hoist the engine from vehicle.
CAUTION:
Verify all electrical connectors are disconnected prior to engine/transaxle removal.
40. Separate engine and transaxle.
41. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
02
LTSM020162
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20001 - Right engine mount bolt remover
• CH-20003 - Crankshaft holder
• CH-20010 - Camshaft holder
• Engine hoist
1. Release the coolant system pressure.
WARNING!
Never remove the pressure relief cap under any conditions while the engine is operating or hot. Failure to follow
these instructions could result in personal injury or damage to the cooling system or engine. To avoid having
scalding hot coolant or steam blow out of the cooling system, use extreme care when removing the pressure
relief cap. Wait until the engine is cooled, then wrap a thick cloth around the pressure relief cap and turn it
slowly one turn (counterclockwise). Step back while the pressure is released from the cooling system. When you
are certain all the pressure has been released, (with a cloth) turn and remove the pressure relief cap. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
LTSM020190
3. Attach an engine hoist and support the engine using an engine hoist.
4. Using special tool CH-20001 (2), remove the
engine right mount bolts (1) and bracket.
(Tighten: Engine right mount bolts to 70 N·m)
LTSM020219
5. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
6. Remove the crankshaft vibration damper bolts (1).
(Tighten: Crankshaft vibration damper bolts to 25
N·m)
BESM020055
02
BESM020020
8. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
9. Remove the plug in the cylinder block.
10. Using special tool CH-20003 (1), install the crank-
shaft holder into the cylinder block and rotate the
crankshaft until the crankshaft tool completely
holds the crankshaft in place.
(Tighten: Crankshaft holder to 28 N·m)
NOTE: The crankshaft holder will prevent the
crankshaft from rotating in either direction.
LTSM020234
BESM020016
CAUTION:Rotating the camshafts or crankshaft with timing components loosened or removed can cause
serious damage to the valves or pistons.
Installation Notes:
• Install the timing belt and rotate the tensioner
pulley with an Allen wrench in order to apply ten-
sion to the belt and align the finger pointer of
the tensioner to the middle of the U-slot opening.
Tighten the tensioner pulley bolt (1) to 30 N·m,
then tighten the intake and exhaust camshaft
pulley bolts (2, 4) to 120 N·m.
PZSM020037
Exhaust Manifold
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the engine cover.
2. Remove the bolts (1) attaching the exhaust mani-
fold heat shield.
(Tighten: Exhaust manifold heat shield bolts to 15
N·m)
3. Remove the exhaust manifold heat shield.
BESM020078
02
LTSM020201
BESM020033
LTSM020169
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces of manifold and cylinder head.
• Install a new exhaust manifold gasket during installation.
Idler Pulley
Removal & Installation
1. While using a suitable tool and securely holding the hexagonal portion of the drive belt tensioner, rotate the
pulley counterclockwise to loosen the drive belt.
WARNING!
Avoid placing hands near the drive belt tensioner while it is being held.
Intake Manifold
Removal & Installation
02
LTSM020164
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Drain the engine coolant.
WARNING!
Never remove the pressure relief cap under any conditions while the engine is operating or hot. Failure to follow
these instructions could result in personal injury or damage to the cooling system or engine. To avoid having
scalding hot coolant or steam blow out of the cooling system, use extreme care when removing the pressure
relief cap. Wait until the engine is cooled, then wrap a thick cloth around the pressure relief cap and turn it
slowly one turn (counterclockwise). Step back while the pressure is released from the cooling system. When you
are certain all the pressure has been released, (with a cloth) turn and remove the pressure relief cap. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
4. Remove the coolant fan & radiator assembly if necessary (See Coolant Fan & Radiator Assembly Removal &
Installation in Section 06 Cooling).
LTSM020221
LTSM020204
LTSM020227
10. Loosen the clamp between the air intake hose and the air cleaner.
11. Loosen the clamp between the air intake hose and the throttle body and then remove the intake pipe.
12. Loosen the clamp on the PCV hose and then disconnect the PCV hose.
02
LTSM020222
14. Remove the fuel rail with the fuel injectors and set aside.
15. Remove the screws securing the vacuum valve bracket to the intake manifold.
16. Set aside the vacuum valve and pipe.
17. Disconnect intake manifold electrical harness, and vacuum hose.
18. Remove the bolts (2) & (3) securing the engine oil
dipstick to intake manifold. Remove the dipstick.
(Tighten: Dipstick bracket bolts to 11 N·m)
19. Disconnect the oil pressure switch connect (4) if
necessary.
20. Remove the nuts (1) securing the intake manifold
to cylinder head.
(Tighten: Intake manifold nuts to 11 N·m)
LTSM020223
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces of manifold and cylinder head.
• Install a new intake manifold gasket during installation.
• Install new O-rings on the fuel injectors.
Oil Filter
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-10003 - Oil filter remover
WARNING!
Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the skin, leading
to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially harmful contaminants which
may cause skin cancer. Adequate means of skin protection must be provided.
CAUTION:
When servicing the oil filter, install the special tool against the base of the filter to avoid deforming
the filter.
1. Using special tool CH-10003 oil filter remover,
remove the oil filter (1).
(Tighten: Oil filter to 25 N·m)
LTSM020206
Installation Notes:
• Clean the surface, and verify the oil filter does not leak.
Oil Pan
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the oil dipstick.
2. Raise and support the vehicle.
3. Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the
engine oil.
(Tighten: Oil pan drain plug to 40 N·m)
NOTE :
Do not pry on cylinder block to remove oil pan.
4. Remove oil pan bolts (1).
(Tighten: Oil pan bolts to 18 N·m)
LTSM020205
Installation Notes:
• Oil pan sealing surfaces must be free of grease or oil.
Oil Pump
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the crankshaft vibration damper retaining
bolt (1).
(Tighten: Crankshaft vibration damper bolts to 25 02
N·m)
BESM020055
3. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove the crankshaft timing belt pulley bolt (2)
from the crankshaft.
(Tighten: Crankshaft timing belt pulley bolt to 130
N·m and an additional 65°)
5. Remove the key-way from the crankshaft.
6. Using an appropriate tool, remove the front crank-
shaft oil seal (1).
LTSM020199
BESM020032
Installation Notes:
• Before installing, prime the new oil pump. Fill the oil pump with engine oil and rotate the oil pump.
• Replace the oil pump gasket.
Oil Strainer
Removal & Installation
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the oil pan (See Oil Pan Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the oil strainer retaining bolts (1).
(Tighten: Oil strainer bolts to 18 N·m)
BESM020018
Installation Notes:
• Install new O-rings on the oil strainer pipe.
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Surface Distortion Limit 0.15 mm
Inner Diameter Standard 81 mm
Out-Of-Round Less than 0.008 mm
Taper Less than 0.01 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the oil pan and then remove oil baffle.
2. Remove the oil strainer.
BESM020060
3. For each connecting rod/piston assembly to be removed, rotate the crankshaft to the bottom dead center position
for each cylinder.
NOTE :
Before removing the connecting rod/piston assembly, check the connecting rod side clearance.
BESM020042
BESM020043
BESM020044
BESM020045
CAUTION:When removing the connecting rod side bearings, note the installation position. Keep them in
the correct order.
Inspection
NOTE :
All measurements should be taken with the engine block at room temperature, 21°C.
Engine Block
02
• Clean cylinder block thoroughly and check all core hole plugs for evidence of leaking.
• Examine block and cylinder bores for cracks or fractures.
• Check block deck surfaces for flatness. Deck surface must be within service limit of 0.050 mm.
Cylinder Bore
• The cylinder walls should be checked for out-of-round and taper with cylinder indicator or equivalent. If the cyl-
inder walls are badly scuffed or scored, the cylinder block should be replaced, and new pistons and rings fitted.
• Measure the cylinder bore at three levels in directions X and Y. Top measurement should be 10 mm down and
bottom measurement should be 10 mm up from
bottom of bore.
BESM020063
CYLINDER BORE
All Cylinders 81.000 - 81.010 mm
Assembly
NOTE :
Cleanliness is extremely important during the engine assembly procedure. Any foreign material, including any mate-
rial created while cleaning gasket surfaces, that enters the oil passages, coolant passages or the oil pan can cause
engine failure.
NOTE :
Assemble all components in their original position.
1. Install the pistons to the connecting rods.
2. Using a piston ring expander, install the piston rings.
3. Assemble all components in the reverse order of disassembly.
Pistons
Specifications
Clearance Specifications - Pistons
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Surface Distortion Limit 0.15 mm
Inner Diameter Standard 81 mm
Out-Of-Round Less than 0.008 mm
Taper Less than 0.01 mm
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
First Ring 0.04 - 0.08 mm
Second Ring 0.01 - 0.0251 mm
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Piston To Piston Pin 0.002 - 0.013 mm
Disassembly
• Piston Ring Removal
− Using a suitable ring expander, remove upper
and intermediate piston rings.
− Remove the upper oil ring side rail, lower oil
ring side rail and then oil ring expander from
piston.
− Clean ring grooves of any carbon deposits.
BESM020047
CAUTION:
Before removing the piston rings (1), check the
piston ring side clearance. Be careful to mark
the location of the piston rings if they are to
be reused.
02
BESM020046
• Piston Pin Snap Ring Removal
− Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring
(1).
− Heat the pistons if necessary.
BESM020048
• Piston Pin Removal
− Push out the piston pin with a suitable tool.
BESM020049
BESM020041
Inspection
Check the piston diameter.
BESM020050
PISTON DIAMETER
All Pistons 80.946 - 80.964 mm
BESM020063
CYLINDER BORE
All Cylinders 81.000 - 81.010 mm
02
BESM020051
• Wipe the cylinder bore clean. Insert ring and push down with piston to ensure it is square in the bore. The ring
gap measurement must be made with the ring posi-
tioned at least 13 mm from bottom of cylinder bore
and below the bottom of the oil ring travel where
the cylinder bore has minimal wear. Check gap with
feeler gauge.
BESM020052
BESM020053
• Check the inner diameter of connecting rod (small end).
BESM020054
Assembly
1. Install the piston to the connecting rod. Assemble the components in their original positions.
2. Using a piston ring expander, install the piston rings. Assemble the components in their original positions.
3. Assemble all components in the reverse order of disassembly.
Connecting Rods
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Connecting Rod Radial Clearance 0.016 - 0.051 mm
Connecting Rod Axial Clearance 0.002 - 0.013 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the connecting rod cap bolts.
2. Remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
BESM020043
BESM020044
NOTE: Before removing the piston and connecting rod assembly, check the connecting rod side clearance.
BESM020045
CAUTION:When removing the connecting rod side bearings, note the installation position. Keep them in
the correct order.
Inspection
• Check the radial clearance of connecting rod bearing.
Assembly
NOTE :
The rod bolts should not be reused.
1. Before installing the NEW rod bolts, the threads and under the bolt head should be oiled with clean engine oil.
2. Install each bolt finger tight, then alternately tighten each bolt to assemble the cap properly.
3. Tighten the connecting rod bolts using the two step
torque-turn method:
• 1st Step: Tighten bolts to 25 N·m
• 2nd Step: Tighten the connecting rod bolts an addi-
tional 90°
LTSM020208
02
BESM020064
Crankshaft
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Diameter of Crankshaft Main Journals 53.981 - 54 mm
Diameter of Crankshaft Rod Journals 47.884 - 47.9 mm
Out-of-Round Maximum of Crankshaft Main Journals 0.008 mm
Axial Clearance of Crankshaft 0.07 - 0.265 mm
Radial Clearance of Crankshaft 0.0035 - 0.034 mm
Coaxality Crankshaft Main Journal 0.05 mm
Thrust Washer Thickness 2.4 - 2.405 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the front crankshaft oil seal (See Front Crankshaft Oil Seal Removal & Installation in Section 02
Engine).
2. Remove the rear crankshaft oil seal (See Rear Crankshaft Oil Seal Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the pistons with connecting rod assemblies.
BESM020074
Inspection
• The crankshaft main journals should be checked for
excessive wear, roundness and scoring. Limits of
roundness on any crankshaft main journals should
be held to 0.008 mm. Limits of roundness on any
crankshaft rod journals should be held to 0.005
mm. DO NOT nick crank pin or bearing fillets. Lim-
its of out of round on any crankshaft journals
should be held to 0.005 mm.
BESM020075
• Check the axial clearance after installation. Stan-
dard of axial clearance should be 0.07 mm. Limits
of axial clearance should be held to 0.265 mm.
BESM020076
BESM020077
Assembly
1. Install the main bearings and thrust bearings to the upper cylinder block and lower cylinder block.
NOTE: Identify and number the bearings, if reusing them, so that they are assembled in the same position and
direction.
2. Assemble the crankshaft and main bearings in the reverse order of disassembly.
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Cylinder Head Flatness 0.04 mm
Intake Valve Deflection 0.02 mm
Exhaust Valve Deflection 0.04 mm
Spring Height 47.7 mm
Disassembly
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20011 - Valve seal installer
• CH-20012 - Valve stem seal installer guide
• CH-20013 - Valve seal remover
• CH-20017 - Valve keeper installer
• CH-20018 - Valve spring compressor
NOTE :
Replacement cylinder head comes complete with valves, seals, springs, retainers, keepers, tappets, and camshafts.
1. Remove camshafts.
2. Remove the hydraulic tappet assembly (1).
BESM020071
02
BESM020067
BESM020069
LTSM020225
Inspection
• Cylinder head must be flat within 0.04 mm.
• Inspect camshaft bearing journals for scoring.
• Remove carbon and varnish deposits from inside of
valve guides with a valve guide cleaner.
• Verify the valve tappets move freely in their bores,
and that they have been rotating.
• Check the valve guide height.
BESM020068
Assembly
1. Install new valve guide if necessary.
2. Install new valve seat if necessary.
3. Using special tool CH-20011 (1), install the new
valve oil seal.
LTSM020224
4. Install the valves into the cylinder head (larger diameter on intake side).
5. Install the valve springs.
6. Install the valve spring retainers.
02
BESM020067
9. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer after installation to verify proper assembly.
10. Install valve tappets in the head.
11. Install the camshafts.
Installation Notes:
• Coat the valve oil seal with engine oil.
Camshaft
Specifications
Camshaft Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Intake Cam Lobe Height 37.15 mm
Exhaust Cam Lobe Height 37.05 mm
Journal #1 Outer Diameter 31.934 - 31.95 mm
Journal #2, #3, #4, #5, Outer Diameter 23.947 - 23.96 mm
Cam Bearing #1 Inner Diameter 32 - 32.025 mm
Cam Bearing #2, #3, #4, #5, Inner Diameter 24 - 24.021 mm
Journal #1 Clearance 0.05 - 0.091 mm
Journal #2, #3, #4, #5 Clearance 0.04 - 0.074 mm
Intake Camshaft Axial Clearance 0.15 - 0.20 mm
Exhaust Camshaft Axial Clearance 0.15 - 0.20 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the camshaft bearing cap bolts.
NOTE: Equally loosen camshaft bearing cap
bolts in several steps.
BESM020035
2. Remove the camshaft bearing caps and place them in proper order.
NOTE: The camshaft bearing caps are marked for identification.
3. Remove the camshafts and then remove the camshaft seals.
Inspection
• Measure the camshaft cam lobe height.
• If wear is beyond the limit, replace the camshaft.
BESM020037
02
BESM020038
BESM020039
BESM020070
Assembly
1. Using special tool CH-20010 (1), install the cam-
shaft holder to hold the camshafts in place.
NOTE :
The camshaft holder will prevent the camshafts from
rotating in either direction.
BESM020016
Installation Notes:
• Install the intake and exhaust camshaft bearing
caps in the proper order.
• Slowly tighten bolts to the specified torque.
• Follow the torque sequence as shown.
BESM020036
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION 02
Intake Valve Deflection 0.02 mm
Exhaust Valve Deflection 0.04 mm
Intake Valve Guide Clearance 0.012 - 0.043 mm
Exhaust Valve Guide Clearance 0.032 - 0.063 mm
Disassembly
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20011 - Valve seal installer
• CH-20012 - Valve stem seal installer guide
• CH-20013 - Valve seal remover
• CH-20017 - Valve keeper installer
• CH-20018 - Valve spring compressor
1. Using the special tool CH-20018 (1), compress the
valve springs.
BESM020067
BESM020069
Inspection
• Clean all valves thoroughly and discard burned,
warped and cracked valves.
• Check valve seats and valve faces for damage.
• When reconditioning valves follow the specifica-
tions outlined for both intake and exhaust valves.
BESM020066
BESM020073
Assembly
1. Install the valves into the cylinder head (larger diameter on intake side).
2. Install the valve springs.
3. Install the valve spring retainers.
4. Using valve spring compressor CH-20018 (1), com-
press the valve springs.
5. Install the valve keepers.
BESM020067
6. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer after installation to verify proper assembly.
Valve Springs
Specifications
Valve Spring Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Spring Free Length 47.7 mm
Spring Height At 620 Newtons Of Pressure 32.0 mm
Disassembly
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20011 - Valve seal installer
• CH -20012 - Valve stem seal installer guide
• CH-20013 - Valve seal remover
• CH-20017 - Valve keeper installer
• CH-20018 - Valve spring compressor
1. Using the special tool CH-20018 (1), compress the
valve springs.
BESM020067
02
BESM020069
Inspection
• Whenever valves have been removed for inspection, reconditioning or replacement, valve springs should be
tested for correct load.
• Discard the springs that do not meet specifications.
• The following specifications apply to both intake
and exhaust valve springs.
BESM020072
Assembly
1. Install the valve springs.
2. Install the valve spring retainers.
3. Using valve spring compressor CH-20018 (1), com-
press the valve springs.
4. Install the valve keepers.
BESM020067
5. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer after installation to verify proper assembly.
Operation
The 2.0L engine utilizes 4 valve-per-cylinders and a dual overhead camshaft design. The engine uses an individual
coil ignition system. The cylinder block is made of aluminum and the bearing caps are integrated into the lower cyl-
inder block assembly. An aluminum oil pan bolts to the bottom of the lower cylinder block. The camshafts are
mounted in the cylinder head and act against valve tappets to open and close the valves. The camshafts are driven
off the front of the cylinder head by one timing belt. The belt is driven by a sprocket that is located on the crankshaft.
The piston assembly is an aluminum piston with a cast iron connecting rod.
The aluminum cylinder head contains dual overhead camshafts with 4 valve-per-cylinder construction. The valves are
arranged in two in-line banks. The cylinder head incorporates powdered metal valve guides and seats. The cylinder
head is sealed to the block using a multi-layer steel head gasket and retaining bolts.
Specifications
2.0L Engine Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Type In-Line OHV, DOHC
Number of Cylinders 4
Compression Ratio 10:1
Compression Pressure 10-15 Bar
Max. Compression Pressure Variation Between
25%
Cylinders
Stroke 90 mm
Bore 83.5 mm
Displacement 1971 cc
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Torque Specifications
CAUTION:
When torquing a fastener in two steps, DO NOT use a torque wrench for the second step.
Special Tools
Crankshaft Holder
CH-20003
Camshaft Holder
CH-20010
Engine Hoist
02
Lubrication System
LTSM020161
The engine lubrication system operates as follows:
• Oil is drawn into the oil pump through the oil pump strainer tube in the sump of the oil pan.
• Oil is pumped through the oil filter to the cylinder block.
• Oil enters the main oil gallery where it is distributed to the crankshaft main journals and to the cylinder head.
• From the main journals, the oil is routed through cross-drilled passages in the crankshaft to lubricate the con-
necting rod bearings. Controlled leakage through the crankshaft main bearings and connecting rod bearings is
slung radially outward to cool and lubricate the cylinder walls as well as the entire connecting rod, piston and
piston ring assembly.
BESM020088
NOTE :
The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide to diagnosing engine problems. An engine
should not be disassembled to determine the cause of low compression unless some malfunction is present.
LTSM020163
WARNING!
Inspect the drive belt only when the engine is stopped.
1. While using a suitable tool and securely holding the hexagonal portion of the drive belt tensioner, rotate the
pulley counterclockwise to loosen the drive belt.
WARNING!
Avoid placing hands near the drive belt tensioner while it is being held.
02
LTSM020196
LTSM020203
LTSM020226
BESM020022
NOTE : 02
Install a new cylinder head cover gasket during
installation.
LTSM020198
Camshaft
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20002 - Camshaft seal installer
1. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove the intake or exhaust camshaft timing belt pulley.
(Tighten: Camshaft timing belt pulley bolt to 120 N·m)
BESM020034
BESM020035
Installation Notes:
• Use special tool CH-20010 (1), to install the camshaft holder to hold the camshafts in place.
NOTE :
The camshaft holder will prevent the camshafts from
rotating in either direction.
02
BESM020016
• Use special tool CH-20002 (1), to install the camshaft seal.
• Install the intake and exhaust camshaft bearing
caps in the proper order.
• Slowly tighten bolts to the specified torque.
LTSM020215
• Follow the torque sequence as shown.
BESM020036
Cylinder Head
Removal & Installation
LTSM020167
NOTE :
Replacement cylinder head comes complete with valves, seals, springs, retainers, keepers, and camshafts.
1. Remove engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the camshafts (See Camshaft Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove intake manifold (See Intake Manifold Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
5. Remove exhaust manifold (See Exhaust Manifold Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
6. Remove water pipe and thermostat assembly.
02
BESM020065
Installation Notes:
• Ensure cylinder head bolt holes in the block are clean, dry (free of residual oil or coolant), and threads are not
damaged.
• The cylinder head bolts should not be reused. The new bolts should be examined before use. If the bolts are
stretched, the bolts should be replaced.
• Position the new cylinder head gasket on the engine block with the part number facing up. Ensure gasket is
seated over the locating dowels in the block.
• Before installing the bolts, the threads should be lightly coated with engine oil.
LTSM020236
BESM020055
3. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
LTSM020199
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate the new front seal with engine oil prior to assembly.
• Use the front crankshaft seal installer CH-20007 (1), to install the new seal.
LTSM020216
BESM080046
BESM020058
BESM020031
Installation Notes:
• When installing seal, lubricate seal guide with
clean engine oil.
• Position the seal over the rear crankshaft seal
guide.
• Use special tool CH-20005 (2) and CH-20006
(1), to install the rear crankshaft oil seal.
• Ensure that the lip of the seal is facing toward 02
the crankcase during installation.
LTSM020217
Engine Mounts
Removal & Installation - Left Mount
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• Engine Hoist
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the air cleaner housing. (See Air Cleaner
Housing Removal & Installation in Section 02
Engine).
3. Remove the engine left mount retaining bolts (2)
and remove the engine left mount bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Engine left mount bolts to 70 N·m)
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM020156
LTSM020155
BESM080035
LTSM020188
Engine Assembly
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20001 - Right engine mount bolt remover
• Engine hoist 02
NOTE :
The engine is removed with the transaxle as an assembly.
1. Remove the engine cover.
2. Remove the vehicle hood.
3. Relieve the fuel pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
4. Remove the battery, battery hold downs, and battery tray (See Battery Removal & Installation in Section 05
Starting & Charging).
5. Discharge air conditioning system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air
Conditioning).
6. Drain the cooling system, then remove coolant
reservoir (1).
LTSM020190
7. Remove the coolant fan & radiator assembly if necessary (See Coolant Fan & Radiator Assembly Removal &
Installation in Section 06 Cooling).
8. Remove the starter motor wiring.
9. Remove the negative battery cable from the engine.
10. Disconnect and remove the fuel line at the fuel rail.
11. Remove the air inlet hose and the air cleaner case
assembly.
12. Remove the ground cable bolt from the cylinder
head.
LTSM020226
LTSM020221
LTSM020204
02
BESM020025
LTSM020200
BESM020029
BESM020078
LTSM020201
32. Remove the front axle shaft (See Front Axle Shaft Removal & Installation in Section 09 Driveline & Axle).
33. Raise and support the vehicle.
34. Drain the engine oil.
35. Remove the idler pulley (1).
LTSM020202
02
BESM020028
37. Lower the vehicle and install engine lift chain hangers.
38. Remove the bolts (1) securing the front engine
mount.
(Tighten: Engine front mount bolt to 60 N·m)
BESM080035
LTSM020207
BESM080036
LTSM020218
43. Verify all components between the engine and vehicle are disconnected.
44. Hoist the engine from vehicle.
CAUTION:
Verify all electrical connectors are disconnected prior to engine/transaxle removal.
45. Separate engine and transaxle.
46. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
02
LTSM020162
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20001 - Right engine mount bolt remover
• CH-20003 - Crankshaft holder
• CH-20010 - Camshaft holder
• Engine hoist
1. Release the coolant system pressure.
WARNING!
Never remove the pressure relief cap under any conditions while the engine is operating or hot. Failure to follow
these instructions could result in personal injury or damage to the cooling system or engine. To avoid having
scalding hot coolant or steam blow out of the cooling system, use extreme care when removing the pressure
relief cap. Wait until the engine is cooled, then wrap a thick cloth around the pressure relief cap and turn it
slowly one turn (counterclockwise). Step back while the pressure is released from the cooling system. When you
are certain all the pressure has been released, (with a cloth) turn and remove the pressure relief cap. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
LTSM020190
3. Attach an engine hoist and support the engine using an engine hoist.
4. Using special tool CH-20001 (2), remove the
engine right mount bolts (1) and bracket.
(Tighten: Engine right mount bolts to 70 N·m)
LTSM020219
5. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
6. Remove the crankshaft vibration damper bolts (1).
(Tighten: Crankshaft vibration damper bolts to 25
N·m)
BESM020055
02
BESM020020
8. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
9. Remove the plug in the cylinder block.
10. Using special tool CH-20003 (1), install the crank-
shaft holder into the cylinder block and rotate the
crankshaft until the crankshaft tool completely
holds the crankshaft in place.
(Tighten: Crankshaft holder to 28 N·m)
NOTE: The crankshaft holder will prevent the
crankshaft from rotating in either direction.
LTSM020234
BESM020016
CAUTION:Rotating the camshafts or crankshaft with timing components loosened or removed can cause
serious damage to the valves or pistons.
Installation Notes:
• Install the timing belt and rotate the tensioner
pulley with an Allen wrench in order to apply ten-
sion to the belt and align the finger pointer of
the tensioner to the middle of the U-slot opening.
Tighten the tensioner pulley bolt (1) to 30 N·m,
then tighten the intake and exhaust camshaft
pulley bolts (2 & 4) to 120 N·m.
PZSM020037
Exhaust Manifold
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the engine cover.
2. Remove the bolts (1) attaching the exhaust mani-
fold heat shield.
(Tighten: Exhaust manifold heat shield bolts to 15
N·m)
3. Remove the exhaust manifold heat shield.
BESM020078
02
LTSM020201
BESM020033
LTSM020169
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces of manifold and cylinder head.
• Install a new exhaust manifold gasket during installation.
Idler Pulley
Removal & Installation
1. While using a suitable tool and securely holding the hexagonal portion of the drive belt tensioner, rotate the
pulley counterclockwise to loosen the drive belt.
WARNING!
Avoid placing hands near the drive belt tensioner while it is being held.
Intake Manifold
Removal & Installation
02
LTSM020164
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Drain the engine coolant.
WARNING!
Never remove the pressure relief cap under any conditions while the engine is operating or hot. Failure to follow
these instructions could result in personal injury or damage to the cooling system or engine. To avoid having
scalding hot coolant or steam blow out of the cooling system, use extreme care when removing the pressure
relief cap. Wait until the engine is cooled, then wrap a thick cloth around the pressure relief cap and turn it
slowly one turn (counterclockwise). Step back while the pressure is released from the cooling system. When you
are certain all the pressure has been released, (with a cloth) turn and remove the pressure relief cap. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
LTSM020221
LTSM020204
7. Loosen the clamp between the air intake hose and the air cleaner.
8. Loosen the clamp between the air intake hose and the throttle body and then remove the intake pipe.
9. Loosen the clamp on the PCV hose and then disconnect the PCV hose.
10. Remove the fuel rail bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Fuel rail bracket bolts to 11 N·m)
LTSM020222
11. Remove the fuel rail with the fuel injectors and set aside.
12. Remove the fuel injector O-rings.
NOTE :
Install new O-rings on the fuel injectors.
13. Remove the screws securing the vacuum valve bracket to the intake manifold.
14. Set aside the vacuum valve and pipe.
15. Disconnect intake manifold electrical harness, and vacuum hose.
16. Remove the bolts (2) & (3) securing the engine oil
dipstick to intake manifold. Remove the dipstick.
(Tighten: Dipstick bracket bolts to 11 N·m)
17. Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector (4) if
necessary.
18. Remove the nuts (1) securing the intake manifold
to cylinder head.
(Tighten: Intake manifold nuts to 11 N·m) 02
NOTE: Replace the manifold gasket.
LTSM020223
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces of manifold and cylinder head.
• Install a new intake manifold gasket during installation.
• Install new O-rings on the fuel injectors.
Oil Filter
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-10003 - Oil filter remover
WARNING!
Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the skin, leading
to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially harmful contaminants which
may cause skin cancer. Adequate means of skin protection must be provided.
CAUTION:
When servicing the oil filter, install the special tool against the base of the filter to avoid deforming
the filter.
1. Using special tool CH-10003 oil filter remover,
remove the oil filter (1).
(Tighten: Oil filter to 25 N·m)
LTSM020206
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces, and verify the oil filter does not leak.
Oil Pan
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the oil dipstick.
2. Raise and support the vehicle.
3. Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the
engine oil.
(Tighten: Oil pan drain plug to 40 N·m)
NOTE :
Do not pry on cylinder block to remove oil pan.
4. Remove oil pan bolts (1).
(Tighten: Oil pan bolts to 18 N·m)
LTSM020205
Installation Notes:
• Oil pan sealing surfaces must be free of grease or oil.
Oil Pump
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the crankshaft vibration damper retaining
bolt (1).
(Tighten: Crankshaft vibration damper bolts to 25
N·m)
BESM020055
3. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
LTSM020199
BESM020032
Installation Notes:
• Before installing, prime the new oil pump. Fill the oil pump with engine oil and rotate the oil pump.
• Replace the oil pump gasket.
Oil Strainer
Removal & Installation
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the oil pan (See Oil Pan Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the oil strainer retaining bolts (1).
(Tighten: Oil strainer bolts to 18 N·m)
BESM020018
Installation Notes:
• Install new O-rings on the oil strainer pipe.
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Surface Distortion Limit 0.15 mm
Inner Diameter Standard 84 mm
Out-Of-Round Less than 0.008 mm
Taper Less than 0.01 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the oil pan and then remove oil baffle.
2. Remove the oil strainer.
BESM020060
3. For each connecting rod/piston assembly to be removed, rotate the crankshaft to the bottom dead center position
for each cylinder.
NOTE :
Before removing the connecting rod/piston assembly, check the connecting rod side clearance.
BESM020042
BESM020043
BESM020044
BESM020045
CAUTION:When removing the connecting rod side bearings, note the installation position. Keep them in
the correct order.
Inspection
NOTE :
All measurements should be taken with the engine block at room temperature, 21°C.
Engine Block
02
• Clean cylinder block thoroughly and check all core hole plugs for evidence of leaking.
• Examine block and cylinder bores for cracks or fractures.
• Check block deck surfaces for flatness. Deck surface must be within service limit of 0.050 mm.
Cylinder Bore
• The cylinder walls should be checked for out-of-round and taper with cylinder indicator or equivalent. If the cyl-
inder walls are badly scuffed or scored, the cylinder block should be replaced, and new pistons and rings fitted.
• Measure the cylinder bore at three levels in directions X and Y. Top measurement should be 10 mm down and
bottom measurement should be 10 mm up from
bottom of bore.
BESM020063
CYLINDER BORE
All Cylinders 83.500 - 83.510 mm
Assembly
NOTE :
Cleanliness is extremely important during the engine assembly procedure. Any foreign material, including any mate-
rial created while cleaning gasket surfaces, that enters the oil passages, coolant passages or the oil pan can cause
engine failure.
NOTE :
Assemble all components in their original position.
1. Install the pistons to the connecting rods.
2. Using a piston ring expander, install the piston rings.
3. Assemble all components in the reverse order of disassembly.
Pistons
Specifications
Clearance Specifications - Pistons
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Surface Distortion Limit 0.15 mm
Inner Diameter Standard 84 mm
Out-Of-Round Less than 0.008 mm
Taper Less than 0.01 mm
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
First Ring 0.04 - 0.08 mm
Second Ring 0.01 - 0.0251 mm
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Piston To Piston Pin 0.002 - 0.013 mm
Disassembly
• Piston Ring Removal
− Using a suitable ring expander, remove upper
and intermediate piston rings.
− Remove the upper oil ring side rail, lower oil
ring side rail and then oil ring expander from
piston.
− Clean ring grooves of any carbon deposits.
BESM020047
CAUTION:
Before removing the piston rings (1), check the
piston ring side clearance. Be careful to mark
the location of the piston rings if they are to
be reused.
02
BESM020046
• Piston Pin Snap Ring Removal
− Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring
(1).
− Heat the pistons if necessary.
BESM020048
• Piston Pin Removal
− Push out the piston pin with a suitable tool.
BESM020049
BESM020041
Inspection
• Check the piston diameter.
BESM020050
PISTON DIAMETER
All Pistons 83.451 - 83.469 mm
• Check the inner diameter of each cylinder bore (See Cylinder Bore Inspection in Section 02 Engine).
BESM020063
CYLINDER BORE
All Cylinders 83.500 - 83.510 mm
02
BESM020051
• Wipe the cylinder bore clean. Insert ring and push down with piston to ensure it is square in the bore. The ring
gap measurement must be made with the ring posi-
tioned at least 13 mm from bottom of cylinder bore
and below the bottom of the oil ring travel where
the cylinder bore has minimal wear. Check gap with
feeler gauge.
BESM020052
BESM020053
• Check the inner diameter of connecting rod (small end).
BESM020054
Assembly
1. Install the piston to the connecting rod. Assemble the components in their original positions.
2. Using a piston ring expander, install the piston rings. Assemble the components in their original positions.
3. Assemble all components in the reverse order of disassembly.
Connecting Rods
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Connecting Rod Radial Clearance 0.016 - 0.051 mm
Connecting Rod Axial Clearance 0.002 - 0.013 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the connecting rod cap bolts.
2. Remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
BESM020043
BESM020044
NOTE: Before removing the piston and connecting rod assembly, check the connecting rod side clearance.
BESM020045
CAUTION:When removing the connecting rod side bearings, note the installation position. Keep them in
the correct order.
Inspection
• Check the radial clearance of connecting rod bearing.
Assembly
NOTE :
The rod bolts should not be reused.
1. Before installing the NEW rod bolts, the threads and under the bolt head should be oiled with clean engine oil.
2. Install each bolt finger tight, then alternately tighten each bolt to assemble the cap properly.
3. Tighten the connecting rod bolts using the two step
torque-turn method:
• 1st Step: Tighten bolts to 25 N·m
• 2nd Step: Tighten the connecting rod bolts an addi-
tional 90°
LTSM020208
02
BESM020064
Crankshaft
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Diameter of Crankshaft Main Journals 53.981 - 54 mm
Diameter of Crankshaft Rod Journals 47.884 - 47.9 mm
Out-of-Round Maximum of Crankshaft Main Journals 0.008 mm
Axial Clearance of Crankshaft 0.07 - 0.265 mm
Radial Clearance of Crankshaft 0.0035 - 0.034 mm
Coaxality of Crankshaft Main Journals 0.05 mm
Thrust Washer Thickness 2.4 - 2.405 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the front crankshaft oil seal (See Front Crankshaft Oil Seal Removal & Installation in Section 02
Engine).
2. Remove the rear crankshaft oil seal (See Rear Crankshaft Oil Seal Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the pistons with connecting rod assemblies.
BESM020074
Inspection
• The crankshaft main journals should be checked for
excessive wear, roundness and scoring. Limits of
roundness on any crankshaft main journals should
be held to 0.008 mm. Limits of roundness on any
crankshaft rod journals should be held to 0.005
mm. DO NOT nick crank pin or bearing fillets. Lim-
its of out of round on any crankshaft journals
should be held to 0.005 mm.
BESM020075
• Check the axial clearance after installation. Stan-
dard of axial clearance should be 0.07 mm. Limits
of axial clearance should be held to 0.265 mm.
BESM020076
BESM020077
Assembly
1. Install the main bearings and thrust bearings to the upper cylinder block and lower cylinder block.
NOTE: Identify and number the bearings, if reusing them, so that they are assembled in the same position and
direction.
2. Assemble the crankshaft and main bearings in the reverse order of disassembly.
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Cylinder Head Flatness 0.04 mm
Intake Valve Deflection 0.02 mm
Exhaust Valve Deflection 0.04 mm
Spring Height 47.7 mm
Disassembly
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20011 - Valve seal installer
• CH-20012 - Valve stem seal installer guide
• CH-20013 - Valve seal remover
• CH-20017 - Valve keeper installer
• CH-20018 - Valve spring compressor
NOTE :
Replacement cylinder head comes complete with valves, seals, springs, retainers, keepers, tappets, and camshafts.
1. Remove camshafts (See Camshaft Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the hydraulic tappet assembly (1).
BESM020071
02
BESM020067
BESM020069
LTSM020225
Inspection
• Cylinder head must be flat within 0.04 mm.
• Inspect camshaft bearing journals for scoring.
• Remove carbon and varnish deposits from inside of
valve guides with a valve guide cleaner.
• Verify the valve tappets move freely in their bores,
and that they have been rotating.
• Check the valve guide height.
BESM020068
Assembly
1. Install new valve guide if necessary.
2. Install new valve seat if necessary.
3. Using special tool CH-20011 (1), install the new
valve oil seal.
LTSM020224
4. Install the valves into the cylinder head (larger diameter on intake side).
5. Install the valve springs.
6. Install the valve spring retainers.
02
BESM020067
9. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer after installation to verify proper assembly.
10. Install valve tappets in the head.
11. Install the camshafts.
Camshaft
Specifications
Camshaft Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Intake Cam Lobe Height 37.15 mm
Exhaust Cam Lobe Height 37.05 mm
Journal #1 Outer Diameter 31.934 - 31.95 mm
Journal #2, #3, #4, #5, Outer Diameter 23.947 - 23.96 mm
Cam Bearing #1 Inner Diameter 32 - 32.025 mm
Cam Bearing #2, #3, #4, #5, Inner Diameter 24 - 24.021 mm
Journal #1 Clearance 0.05 - 0.091 mm
Journal #2, #3, #4, #5 Clearance 0.04 - 0.074 mm
Intake Camshaft Axial Clearance 0.15 - 0.20 mm
Exhaust Camshaft Axial Clearance 0.15 - 0.20 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the camshaft bearing cap bolts.
NOTE: Equally loosen camshaft bearing cap
bolts in several steps.
BESM020035
2. Remove the camshaft bearing caps and place them in proper order.
NOTE: The camshaft bearing caps are marked for identification.
3. Remove the camshafts and then remove the camshaft seals.
Inspection
• Measure the camshaft cam lobe height.
• If wear is beyond the limit, replace the camshaft.
BESM020037
02
BESM020038
BESM020039
BESM020070
Assembly
1. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Use special tool CH-20010 (1), to install the camshaft holder to hold the camshafts in place.
NOTE :
The camshaft holder will prevent the camshafts from
rotating in either direction.
BESM020016
• Install the intake and exhaust camshaft bearing caps in the proper order.
• Slowly tighten bolts to the specified torque.
• Follow the torque sequence as shown.
BESM020036
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION 02
Intake Valve Deflection 0.02 mm
Exhaust Valve Deflection 0.04 mm
Intake Valve Guide Clearance 0.012 - 0.043 mm
Exhaust Valve Guide Clearance 0.032 - 0.063 mm
Disassembly
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20011 - Valve seal installer
• CH-20012 - Valve stem seal installer guide
• CH-20013 - Valve seal remover
• CH-20017 - Valve keeper installer
• CH-20018 - Valve spring compressor
1. Using the special tool, compress the valve
springs.
2. Remove the valve keeper (1), valve spring
retainer (2) and valve spring (3).
3. Remove valves (4) from the cylinder head.
BESM020069
Inspection
• Clean all valves thoroughly and discard burned,
warped and cracked valves.
• Check valve seats and valve faces for damage.
• When reconditioning valves follow the specifica-
tions outlined for both intake and exhaust valves.
BESM020066
• Measure valve deflection.
BESM020073
Assembly
1. Install the valves into the cylinder head (larger diameter on intake side).
2. Using special tool CH-20011 (1), install the new
valve oil seal.
02
LTSM020224
BESM020067
7. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer after installation to verify proper assembly.
Valve Springs
Specifications
Valve Spring Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Spring Free Length 47.7 mm
Spring Height At 620 Newtons Of Pressure 32.0 mm
Disassembly
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20011 - Valve seal installer
• CH-20012 - Valve stem seal installer guide
• CH-20013 - Valve seal remover
• CH-20017 - Valve keeper installer
• CH-20018 - Valve spring compressor
1. Using the special tool CH-20018 (1), compress the
valve springs.
BESM020067
02
BESM020069
Inspection
• Whenever valves have been removed for inspection, reconditioning or replacement, valve springs should be
tested for correct load.
• Discard the springs that do not meet specifications.
• The following specifications apply to both intake
and exhaust valve springs.
BESM020072
Assembly
1. Install the valve springs.
2. Install the valve spring retainers.
3. Using valve spring compressor CH-20018 (1), com-
press the valve springs.
4. Install the valve keepers.
BESM020067
5. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer after installation to verify proper assembly.
CYLINDER HEAD UNIT REPAIR 02-227 Valve & Valve Guides 02-232
Specifications 02-232
Cylinder Head 02-227 Disassembly 02-233
Specifications 02-227
Valves 02-234
Disassembly 02-227 Valve Guides 02-236
Inspection 02-228 Valve Seats 02-237
Assembly 02-228
Assembly 02-238
Camshaft 02-229 Valve Springs 02-238
Specifications 02-229 Specifications 02-238
Disassembly 02-230
Disassembly 02-239
Camshaft 02-231 Inspection 02-240
Hydraulic Adjusters 02-231
Assembly 02-241
Rocker Arms 02-232
Specifications
2.4L General Engine Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Type In-Line, OHV, SOHC
Number of Cylinders 4
Compression Ratio 9:1
Output Power (kw) 95 / 5500 rpm
Stroke 100 mm
Cylinder Diameter 86.5 mm
Displacement 2351 cc
Firing Order 1-3-4-2
Max Torque (N·m) 198.1
Torque Specifications
CAUTION:
When torquing a fastener in two steps, DO NOT use a torque wrench for the second step.
Special Tools
Driver Handle
MB-990938
Plug Spanner
MD-998162
Flywheel Holder
MD-998781
Lubrication System
The engine lubrication system operates as follows:
• Oil is drawn into the oil pump through the oil pump strainer tube in the sump of the oil pan.
• Oil is pumped through the oil filter to the cylinder block.
• Oil enters the main oil gallery where it is distributed to the crankshaft main journals and to the cylinder head.
• From the main journals, the oil is routed through cross-drilled passages in the crankshaft to lubricate the con-
necting rod bearings. Controlled leakage through the crankshaft main bearings and connecting rod bearings is
slung radially outward to cool and lubricate the cylinder walls as well as the entire connecting rod, piston and
piston ring assembly.
• The lubrication system is a fully force-fed, full-flow filtration type. The oil pump is a gear type which is driven by
the crankshaft via the timing belt.
WARNING!
Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the skin, leading
to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially harmful contaminants which
may cause skin cancer. Adequate means of skin protection must be provided.
Oiling System
02
LTSM020045
Oil Pump
LTSM020046
LTSM020047
future reference.
− Disconnect fuel injector electrical connectors.
− Be sure throttle blade is fully open during the compression check.
− Insert compression pressure adaptor or the equivalent into each spark plug hole in cylinder head.
− Crank engine until maximum pressure is reached on gauge. Record each cylinder pressure.
− Compression should not be less than 880 kPa and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder.
− If one or more cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
− If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression test, it could
indicate the existence of a problem in the cylinder in question.
NOTE :
The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide to diagnosing engine problems. An engine
should not be disassembled to determine the cause of low compression unless some malfunction is present.
LTSM020146
02
LTSM020176
WARNING!
Inspect the drive belt only when the engine is stopped.
LTSM020185
LTSM050004
LTSM020160
NOTE :
Install a new cylinder head cover gasket during installation.
Camshaft
Removal & Installation
LTSM020081
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MD-998719 - Camshaft belt gear holder
• MB-990767 - Camshaft belt gear holder
• MD-998443 - Hydraulic post keeper
• MD-998442 - Hydraulic post wiring
• MD-998713 - Camshaft oil seal installer
• MD-998441 - Hydraulic post keeper 02
• MD-998440 - Leak tester
1. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Using special tools MD-998719 (1) and MB-990767
(2) remove the camshaft timing belt pulley bolt.
(Tighten: Camshaft timing belt pulley bolt to 120
N·m)
LTSM020056
LTSM020082
Installation Notes:
• Use special tool MD-998442 (1), to depress the plunger several times to exhaust all air from the hydraulic
adjuster.
CAUTION:
The check ball is especially soft, do not push
the check ball too hard or the hydraulic
adjuster will be damaged. When using special
tool MD-998442 (1) the air will be relieved
easily.
LTSM020083
• Insert the hydraulic adjusters into the rocker arms. Insert special tool MD-998443 (1) to prevent dropping the
hydraulic adjuster during installation.
LTSM020084
• Assemble the rocker shaft springs to the rocker shafts from the upper side of the shaft. Install the rocker shafts
to the cylinder head and install the rocker shaft
bolts and hand tighten only.
CAUTION:
The rocker shaft springs should be installed
first and then install the rocker shaft bolts.
LTSM020085
• Make sure that the rocker shafts are installed properly (1) as shown in the illustration.
CAUTION:
The oil hole in the rocker shafts should be
aligned with the cylinder head to ensure cor-
rect installation position.
02
LTSM020086
• Using special tool MD-998713 (1), install the camshaft oil seal.
LTSM020087
Cylinder Head
Removal & Installation
LTSM020090
1. Drain the cooling system (See Cooling System Draining and Filling in Section 06 Cooling).
2. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the cylinder head cover (See Cylinder Head Cover Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove the camshafts (See Camshaft Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
5. Remove the intake manifold (See Intake Manifold Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
6. Remove the exhaust manifold (See Exhaust Manifold Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
7. Remove the water pipe and thermostat assembly.
02
LTSM020237
Installation Notes:
• Ensure cylinder head bolt holes in the block are clean, dry (free of residual oil or coolant), and threads are not
damaged.
• Do not reuse the cylinder head bolts. The new bolts should be examined before use. If the bolts are stretched,
the bolts should be replaced.
• Position the new cylinder head gasket on the engine block with the part number facing up. Ensure gasket is
seated over the locating dowels in the block.
• Before installing the bolts, the threads should be lightly coated with engine oil.
• The cylinder head bolts should be installed and
torqued in the sequence shown.
LTSM020097
• Tighten the cylinder head bolts in the following sequence.
− 1st Step: Tighten the bolt to 78 N·m
− 2nd Step: Completely loosen the bolt
− 3rd Step: Retighten the bolt to 20 N·m
− 4th Step: Tighten the bolt an additional 90°
− 5th Step: Finish tightening the bolt an addi-
tional 90°
LTSM020098
LTSM020153
3. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Install special tool MD-998781 (1), onto the
flywheel.
LTSM020051
LTSM020052
CAUTION:
Be careful not to damage the front cover seal surface while removing the seal.
9. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate the new front seal with engine oil prior to assembly.
• Use the front crankshaft seal installer MD-998285 (1), to install the new seal.
• Tighten the crankshaft timing belt pulley bolt in the 02
following sequence.
− 1st step: Tighten the crankshaft timing belt
pulley bolt to 130 N·m.
− 2nd step: Tighten the bolt an additional 65°
LTSM020220
LTSM020195
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MD-998776 - Crankshaft rear oil seal installer
1. Remove the transaxle assembly (See Transaxle Assembly Removal & Installation in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
02
BESM080046
BESM020058
BESM020031
Installation Notes:
• When installing seal, lubricate seal guide with clean engine oil.
• Position the seal over the rear crankshaft seal guide.
• Use special tool MD-998776 (2) and MD-990938 (1), to install the rear oil seal.
• Ensure that the lip of the seal is facing toward the
crankcase during installation.
LTSM020132
Engine Mounts
Removal & Installation - Left Mount
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• Engine Hoist
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the air cleaner housing. (See Air Cleaner
Housing Removal & Installation in Section 02
Engine).
3. Remove the engine left mount retaining bolts (2)
and remove the engine left mount bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Engine left mount bolts to 70 N·m)
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM020156
LTSM020155
BESM080035
LTSM020188
Engine Assembly
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• Engine Hoist
NOTE :
The engine is removed with the transaxle as an assembly.
1. Relieve the fuel pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the battery, battery hold downs, and battery tray (See Battery Removal & Installation in Section 05
Starting & Charging).
4. Discharge air conditioning system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air
Conditioning).
5. Drain the cooling system (See Cooling System Draining and Filling in Section 06 Cooling).
WARNING!
Do not loosen the radiator drain plug when the cooling system is hot or under the pressure. Serious burns from
coolant may occur.
6. Remove the coolant fan & radiator assembly if necessary (See Coolant Fan & Radiator Assembly Removal &
Installation in Section 06 Cooling).
7. Remove the starter motor wiring.
8. Remove the negative battery cable from the engine.
9. Disconnect and remove the fuel line (2) at the fuel
rail.
10. If necessary remove the fuel pressure regulator
retaining bolt (1) and set the fuel pressure regula-
tor aside.
(Tighten: Fuel pressure regulator bolt to 9 N·m)
LTSM040006
11. Remove the air inlet hose and the air cleaner case
assembly.
LTSM020160
12. Remove the accelerator cable bolt from the cylinder head.
LTSM130010
LTSM130008
LTSM020189
25. Remove the front axle shaft (See Front Axle Shaft Removal & Installation in Section 09 Driveline & Axle).
26. Raise and support the vehicle.
27. Drain the engine oil.
28. Remove the power steering pump piping and set aside (See Power steering pump Removal & Installation in
Section 11 Steering).
29. Lower the vehicle and install engine lift chain hangers.
30. Remove the bolts (1) securing the front engine
mount.
(Tighten: Engine front mount bolt to 60 N·m)
BESM080035
LTSM020188
02
LTSM020156
LTSM020155
35. Verify all components between the engine and vehicle are disconnected.
36. Hoist the engine from vehicle.
CAUTION:
Verify all electrical connectors are disconnected prior to engine/transaxle removal.
37. Separate engine and transaxle.
(Tighten: M12×1.75 bolts to 70 ± 5 N·m)
(Tighten: M10×1.5 bolts to 50 ± 5 N·m)
38. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM020048
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MB-990767 - Timing belt spanner wrench
• MD-998785 - Timing belt gear holder
• MD-998767 - Automatic Tensioner Socket
1. Drain the cooling system (See Cooling System Draining and Filling in Section 06 Cooling).
WARNING!
Never remove the pressure relief cap under any conditions while the engine is operating or hot. Failure to follow
these instructions could result in personal injury or damage to the cooling system or engine. To avoid having
scalding hot coolant or steam blow out of the cooling system, use extreme care when removing the pressure
relief cap. Wait until the engine is cooled, then wrap a thick cloth around the pressure relief cap and turn it
slowly one turn (counterclockwise). Step back while the pressure is released from the cooling system. When you
are certain all the pressure has been released, (with a cloth) turn and remove the pressure relief cap. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
LTSM020155
5. Remove the accessory drive belts (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
6. Remove the crankshaft vibration damper bolts (1).
(Tighten: Crankshaft vibration damper bolts to 25
N·m)
LTSM020153
LTSM020049
Installation Notes:
• Rotate the camshaft pulley and align the timing marks (1) with the cylinder head cover.
• Rotate the crankshaft pulley and align the timing
marks (1) with the front cover.
02
LTSM020073
LTSM020074
NOTE :
If the holder can be inserted more than 60 mm, then
the timing marks are aligned. If the holder could not be
inserted more than 20-25 mm, the lower balance shaft
pulley should be rotated one revolution and the timing
marks should be then be aligned. Keep the holder
installed until the installation of the timing belt is
complete.
LTSM020075
LTSM020174
LTSM020076
• Using special tool MD-998767 (1) and a torque wrench, adjust the timing belt tensioner.
LTSM020078
• Measure distance “A” between the tensioner arm and the automatic tensioner.
− Standard distance is 3.84 mm
LTSM020080
Inspection
1. Inspect the timing belt back rubber for signs of
aging and glistening.
02
LTSM020057
LTSM020058
LTSM020059
LTSM020060
LTSM020233
Installation Notes:
• Perform the following to prepare the automatic tensioner for installation:
− Slowly close the vise jaws until the rod hole
(1) and housing hole (2) are aligned.
− Insert a steel wire (1.4 mm diameter) into
the aligned hole.
− Remove the automatic tensioner from the
vise.
LTSM020070
Inspection
1. Inspect the automatic tensioner for any leaks. Replace the tensioner if any leaks are found.
2. Inspect the automatic tensioner for signs of abra-
sion at the end of the rod. Replace the tensioner if
any abrasions are found.
3. Inspect the length of the rod. If the rod length does 02
not comply with the standard length, replace the
tensioner (standard rod length is 12 mm).
LTSM020061
LTSM020214
LTSM020062
LTSM020051
LTSM020052
LTSM020053
Installation Notes:
• Align the timing marks on the crankshaft pulley (2) and the upper balance shaft pulley with the timing marks on
the front engine cover (1).
• Make sure all timing marks are aligned properly.
• Install the timing belt.
• Make sure that the belt tensioner position is as
shown (3 & 4).
02
LTSM020066
• While applying finger pressure to the belt tensioner in the direction of the arrow, tighten the tensioner bolt to 35
N·m.
LTSM020067
CAUTION:
Do not allow the belt tensioner to move while tightening the bolt, if the tensioner moves it could
cause the belt to be overtightened.
• Ensure that the timing marks (1) have not moved, and are still in alignment.
• Press the center of the timing belt with an index
finger and measure the belt deflection (standard
deflection is 5-7 mm).
• If the belt deflection is not within specifications,
adjust if necessary.
LTSM020068
• Reinstall the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
Exhaust Manifold
Removal & Installation
LTSM020179
1. Remove the bolts attaching the exhaust manifold heat shield.
(Tighten: Exhaust manifold heat shield bolts to 14 N·m)
2. Remove the exhaust manifold heat shield.
3. Remove the three bolts securing the exhaust manifold to the catalytic converter assembly.
(Tighten: Exhaust manifold to catalytic converter bolts to 49 ± 5 N·m)
4. Disconnect the catalytic converter assembly from the manifold.
5. Remove the exhaust manifold nuts.
(Tighten: Exhaust manifold nuts to 29 ± 3 N·m)
6. Remove the exhaust manifold from the cylinder head.
7. Remove and discard exhaust manifold gasket.
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces of manifold and cylinder head.
• Install a new exhaust manifold gasket during installation.
Intake Manifold
02
Removal & Installation
LTSM020178
LTSM030024
LTSM020173
5. Loosen the clamp between the air intake hose and the air cleaner.
6. Loosen the clamp between the air intake hose and the throttle body and then remove the intake pipe.
7. Remove the fuel rail bracket bolts.
(Tighten: Fuel rail bracket bolts to 11 N·m)
8. Remove the fuel rail with the fuel injectors and set aside.
9. Remove the fuel injector O-rings.
10. Remove the screws securing the vacuum valve bracket to the intake manifold.
11. Set aside the vacuum valve and pipe.
12. Disconnect the intake manifold electrical harness, and vacuum hose.
13. Remove the intake manifold bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Intake manifold bracket bolts to 14 ± 1
N·m)
02
LTSM020154
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces of the manifold and cylinder head.
• Install a new intake manifold gasket during installation.
• Install new O-rings on the fuel injectors.
LTSM020133
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MB-991603 - Balance shaft bearing puller limiter
• MD-998162 - Plug spanner
• MD-998371 - Balance shaft bearing puller
• MD-998372 - Balance shaft bearing puller
• MD-998375 - Crankshaft front oil seal installer
• MD-998705 - Balance shaft bearing installer 02
• MD-998727 - Oil pan remover
• MD-998783 - Plug spanner fixer
• MB-991828 - Oil filter wrench
• MB-991396 - Oil filter wrench
1. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the upper balance shaft timing belt (See Upper Balance Shaft Timing Belt Removal & Installation in
Section 02 Engine).
3. Raise and support the vehicle.
4. Loosen the oil drain plug and drain the oil.
5. Remove the oil pan retaining bolts.
(Tighten: Oil pan bolts to 18 N·m)
6. Using special tool MD-998727 (1), remove the oil
pan.
NOTE: Insert the special tool between cylinder
block and the oil pan. Do not use a screwdriver or
chisel, otherwise the edge of oil pan may be dis-
torted and oil leaks will occur.
7. Remove the oil strainer retaining bolts.
(Tighten: Oil strainer bolts to 19 N·m)
8. Remove the oil strainer.
9. Remove the oil strainer gasket.
LTSM020134
LTSM020186
LTSM020174
LTSM020052
LTSM020054
LTSM020172
NOTE :
Special tool MB-991603 (2) should be installed on the
front of the cylinder block when disassembling the 02
upper balance shaft rear bearing.
LTSM020138
NOTE :
There is NO oil hole in the rear bearing.
LTSM020141
NOTE :
Align the oil holes in the front bearing and the cylin-
der block.
LTSM020187
LTSM020133
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MB-991603 - Balance shaft bearing puller limiter
• MD-998162 - Plug spanner
• MD-998371 - Balance shaft bearing puller
• MD-998372 - Balance shaft bearing puller
• MD-998375 - Crankshaft front oil seal installer
• MD-998705 - Balance shaft bearing installer 02
• MD-998727 - Oil pan remover
• MD-998783 - Plug spanner fixer
• MB-991828 - Oil filter wrench
• MB-991396 - Oil filter wrench
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Loosen the oil drain plug and drain the oil.
3. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove the upper balance shaft timing belt (See Upper Balance Shaft Timing Belt Removal & Installation in
Section 02 Engine).
5. Remove the oil pan retaining bolts.
(Tighten: Oil pan bolts to 18 N·m)
6. Using special tool MD-998727 (1), remove the oil
pan.
NOTE: Insert the special tool between cylinder
block and the oil pan. Do not use a screwdriver or
chisel, otherwise the edge of oil pan may be dis-
torted and oil leaks will occur.
7. Remove the oil strainer retaining bolts.
(Tighten: Oil strainer bolts to 19 N·m)
8. Remove the oil strainer.
9. Remove the oil strainer gasket.
LTSM020134
LTSM020186
LTSM020174
LTSM020052
LTSM020054
LTSM020172
02
LTSM020137
LTSM020138
NOTE :
Align the oil holes (1) in the rear bearing and the cyl-
inder block.
LTSM020139
NOTE :
Align the oil holes in the front bearing and the cylin-
der block.
LTSM020187
CAUTION:
When servicing the oil filter, install the special tool against the base of the filter to avoid deforming
the filter.
1. Start the engine and allow it to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop the engine and remove the engine oil filler cap.
3. Raise and support the vehicle.
4. Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the oil out of the engine.
WARNING!
The engine oil is hot and can burn your skin.
Installation Notes:
• Clean all surfaces, and verify the oil filter does not leak.
Oil Pan
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MD-998727 - Oil pan remover
1. Remove the oil dipstick.
2. Raise and support the vehicle.
3. Remove the oil pan drain plug (2) and drain the
engine oil.
(Tighten: Oil pan drain plug to 45 N·m)
4. Remove the oil pan (3) retaining bolts (1).
(Tighten: Oil pan bolts to 18 N·m)
LTSM020192
LTSM020134
Installation Notes:
• Oil pan sealing surfaces must be free of grease or oil.
Oil Pump
Removal & Installation
LTSM020045
1. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
2. Remove the upper balance shaft timing belt (See Upper Balance Shaft Timing Belt Removal & Installation in
Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the oil filter.
4. Remove the oil filter adapter.
(Tighten: oil filter adapter bolts to 11 N·m)
5. Remove the engine front cover.
6. Remove the oil pump drive gear and the driven gear.
7. Remove the oil pump rear cover.
8. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Before installing the new oil pump, prime the oil pump by filling the oil pump with engine oil and rotate the oil
pump.
• Align the oil pump timing marks (1).
02
LTSM020145
• Check oil pump side clearance.
LTSM020149
Oil Strainer
Removal & Installation
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the oil pan (See Oil Pan Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the oil strainer retaining bolts.
(Tighten: Oil strainer bolts to 18 N·m)
4. Carefully remove the oil strainer.
5. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Install new O-rings on the oil strainer pipe.
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Surface Distortion Limit 0.15 mm
Cylinder Diameter Standard 86.50 - 86.53 mm
Out-Of-Round < 0.008 mm
Taper < 0.01 mm
Disassembly
02
LTSM020124
1. Remove the oil pan.
2. Remove the oil strainer.
3. For each connecting rod/piston assembly to be removed, rotate the crankshaft to the bottom dead center position
for each cylinder.
NOTE :
Before removing the connecting rod/piston assembly, check the connecting rod side clearance.
BESM020042
BESM020043
BESM020044
BESM020045
CAUTION:When removing the connecting rod side bearings, note the installation position. Keep them in
the correct order.
Inspection
NOTE :
All measurements should be taken with the engine block at room temperature, 21°C.
Engine Block
02
• Clean cylinder block thoroughly and check all core hole plugs for evidence of leaking.
• Examine block and cylinder bores for cracks or fractures.
• Check block deck surfaces for flatness. Deck surface must be within service limit of 0.050 mm.
Cylinder Bore
• The cylinder walls should be checked for out-of-round and taper with cylinder indicator or equivalent. If the cyl-
inder walls are badly scuffed or scored, the cylinder block should be replaced, and new pistons and rings fitted.
• Measure the cylinder bore at three levels in directions A and B. Top measurement should be 12 mm down and
bottom measurement should be 12 mm up from
bottom of bore.
LTSM020126
CYLINDER BORE
Cylinder Size 86.50 - 86.53 mm
Cylinder Cylindrically ≤ 0.01 mm
Assembly
NOTE :
Cleanliness is extremely important during the engine assembly procedure. Any foreign material, including any mate-
rial created while cleaning gasket surfaces, that enters the oil passages, coolant passages or the oil pan can cause
engine failure.
NOTE :
Assemble all components in their original position.
1. Install the pistons to the connecting rods.
2. Using a piston ring expander, install the piston rings.
3. Assemble all components in the reverse order of disassembly.
Pistons
Specifications
Clearance Specifications - Pistons
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Surface Distortion Limit 0.15 mm
Out-Of-Round < 0.008 mm
Taper < 0.01 mm
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Piston To Piston Pin 0.002 - 0.013 mm
Disassembly
02
LTSM020107
CAUTION:
Before removing the piston rings (1), check the
piston ring side clearance. Be careful to mark
the location of the piston rings if they are to
be reused.
BESM020046
LTSM020180
BESM020041
Inspection
Cylinder Bore
• Check the inner diameter of each cylinder bore (See Cylinder Bore Inspection in Section 02 Engine).
02
BESM020063
CYLINDER BORE
All Cylinders 86.50 - 86.53 mm
LTSM020121
BESM020052
BESM020053
02
BESM020054
Assembly
Piston Pin Installation
• Measure the following dimensions of each piston
(1), piston pin (2) and connecting rod (3).
− Length of piston pin in hole (A).
− Width of pin sockets (B).
− Length of piston pin (C).
− Width of small end of connecting rod (D).
• Put measured sizes above into following formula to
calculate L.
− L=[(A-C)-(B-D)] / 2
LTSM020111
• After inserting the push rod of the special tool into piston pin, install pipe A in the top of the push rod.
• Install forward marks of piston and connecting rod in the same direction.
• Lubricate the external diameter of piston pin with engine oil.
• Through pipe A, insert the push rod, piston pin and pipe component into piston pin hole from the side with the
forward mark.
• Screw on guide block B into guide pipe A to gain clearance between guide block A (2) and guide block B (1)
equal to the value of Value L (L=[(A-C)-(B-D)] / 2)
plus 3 mm.
LTSM020112
• Keep the forward mark of piston upward. Install piston and connecting rod in tool base of piston pin installer.
• Using a press, press the piston pin (1) in under pressure. When the pressure is less than standard value,
replace piston pin and piston component and/or
replace connecting rod.standard value: 7,350-
17,200 Newtons
LTSM020113
• Check to make sure the piston can rotate freely.
LTSM020116
• Size markings of pistons shown as the following:
SIZE IDENTIFICATION
Standard None
Increase 0.50 mm 50
Increase 1.00 mm 100
CAUTION:
Do not use a piston ring expander to install the oil control rings.
NOTE :
There is no difference between the upper and lower oil control rings.
• Install the bottom oil control ring (1). When installing the ring, force one side of the piston ring into the piston
oil ring groove. Then force the ring into oil ring
groove with the thumb as shown.
• Install the top oil control ring. When installing the
ring, force one side of the piston ring into the pis-
ton oil ring groove. Then force the ring into oil ring
groove with the thumb as shown.
• Ensure the ring can turn from the left to the right
freely after installation. 02
LTSM020114
BESM020047
BESM020047
Connecting Rods
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Connecting Rod Radial Clearance 0.016 - 0.051 mm
Connecting Rod Axial Clearance 0.002 - 0.013 mm
Disassembly
1. Remove the connecting rod cap nuts.
BESM020042
BESM020043
02
BESM020044
BESM020045
Inspection
Bearing Radial Clearance
• Check the radial clearance of connecting rod bearing.
LTSM020122
Assembly
NOTE :
• The connecting rod bolts should NOT be reused.
• Before installing the NEW rod bolts, apply clean engine oil to the threads and under the bolt heads.
LTSM020117
• Using a suitable tool, tap the piston and connecting rod assembly into cylinder.
NOTE :
The piston direction mark (2) should point toward the
timing belt side (1).
02
LTSM020118
• Check the axial clearance of the connecting rods.
BESM020064
LTSM020119
• The bearing will have an identification mark (1) imprinted in the position as shown.
LTSM020181
NOTE :
As an example, if the measurement of the external diameter of the connecting rod journal is 44.996 mm, it will be
identified as Group 1 in the table. If the crankshaft has been replaced, check the identification color applied to the
new crankshaft journal. If the journal is yellow, the crankshaft bearing will be from Group 1, and the connecting rod
bearing will be identified as 1.
LTSM020120
CAUTION:
If the nuts are over tightened (exceed angle of 100°), loosen the nuts and restart the torque
sequence from Step 1
Crankshaft
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Diameter of Crankshaft Main Journals 53.981 - 54 mm
Diameter of Crankshaft Rod Journals 47.884 - 47.9 mm
Out-of-Round Maximum of Crankshaft Main Journals 0.008 mm
Axial Clearance of Crankshaft 0.07 - 0.265 mm
Radial Clearance of Crankshaft 0.0035 - 0.034 mm
Coaxality Crankshaft Main Journal 0.05 mm
Thrust Washer Thickness 2.4 - 2.405 mm
Disassembly
LTSM020194
1. Remove the engine front cover.
2. Remove the crankshaft rear oil seal.
02
BESM020042
BESM020043
BESM020044
BESM020045
Inspection
Crankshaft Axial Clearance
• Check the axial clearance of the crankshaft.
BESM020076
BESM020077
BESM020075
Assembly
NOTE :
Cleanliness is extremely important during the engine assembly procedure. Any foreign material, including any mate-
rial created while cleaning gasket surfaces, that enters the oil passages, coolant passages or the oil pan can cause
engine failure.
Before installing the main bearing bolts, clean the threads and oil the bolts with clean engine oil.
LTSM020119
• Identify the bearing markings (1) & (2) on the cylinder block.
LTSM020127
LTSM020181
NOTE :
As an example, if the identification color of the crankshaft main journal is yellow and the identification mark of spindle
bore is “1”, choose the No. 1,2,4,5 bearing of which identification mark is “2” and identification color is “yellow” and
No.3 bearing of which identification mark is “1” and identification color is “green”.
LTSM020128
LTSM020129
• Tighten the main bearing cap bolts an additional 90°- 100° in the sequence shown.
CAUTION:
If the bolts are over tightened (exceed angle of
100°), loosen the bolts and restart the torque
sequence from Step 1
LTSM020130
• After installing the main bearing caps, assure that the crankshaft rotates smoothly.
BESM020076
Clearance Specifications
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION
Cylinder Head Flatness 0.03 mm
Intake Valve Deflection 0.02 mm
Exhaust Valve Deflection 0.04 mm
Spring Height 51 mm
Disassembly
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MD-998772 - Valve spring compressor
• MD-998774 - Valve oil seal installer
NOTE :
Replacement cylinder head comes complete with valves, seals, springs, retainers, keepers, tappets, and camshafts.
1. Remove camshaft.
2. Using the special tool MD-998772 (1), compress
the valve spring.
3. Remove the valve keeper, valve spring retainer
and valve spring.
4. Push the valve stem from the cylinder head and
remove the valve.
LTSM020092
LTSM020225
Inspection
• Cylinder head must be flat within 0.03 mm.
• Inspect camshaft bearing journals for scoring.
• Remove carbon and varnish deposits from inside of
valve guides with a valve guide cleaner.
• Check the valve guide height.
BESM020068
Assembly
1. Install new valve guide if necessary.
LTSM020094
02
LTSM020092
Camshaft
Specifications
Camshaft Specifications
Disassembly
LTSM020081
1. Remove the rocker shaft retaining bolt.
2. Remove the rocker arms.
3. Remove the camshaft thrust plate retaining bolts.
4. Remove the camshaft and then remove the camshaft seal.
Camshaft
• Measure the camshaft cam lobe height.
• If wear is beyond the limit, replace the camshaft.
02
BESM020037
Hydraulic Adjusters
CAUTION:
The hydraulic adjusters are a precision part. There should not be any dust or foreign matter on its
surface. Do not disassemble the hydraulic adjusters. It is required to use clean diesel oil to clean
the hydraulic adjusters.
• Soak the hydraulic adjusters in clean diesel oil.
• Using special tool MD-998442 (1) and MD-998441 (2), press the steel ball on the inside of the hydraulic
adjuster and remove all air by moving the plunger
up and down 4-5 times.
NOTE :
Use the special tool and check whether the plunger can
be pressed. If it is hard to press the plunger, the
hydraulic adjuster is normal. If it is easy to press the
plunger, repeat the previous procedure and then check
the hydraulic adjuster again. If the plunger is still loose,
the hydraulic adjuster should be replaced.
LTSM020088
CAUTION:
After the hydraulic adjuster has been prepared, it should be kept erect to avoid the loss of diesel
oil.
• Using special tool MD-998440 (1) (return leakage tester), install the hydraulic adjuster.
• After the plunger has moved slightly (0.2 - 0.5
mm), measure the time it takes to move an addi-
tional 1.0 mm. If the measurement value is not
within specifications, replace the hydraulic adjuster-
.Standard Value: 4 - 20 seconds/1 mm (applying
diesel oil of 15 - 20°C)
LTSM020159
Rocker Arms
• Inspect the surface of the roller (2) on all rocker
arms. If there is any damage, the rocker arm
should be replaced.
• Inspect the roller for smooth operation. If the roller
does not revolve smoothly or is loose, the rocker
arm should be replaced.
• Inspect the internal diameter (1) of the rocker arms.
If there is any damage, the rocker arm should be
replaced.
LTSM020037
Disassembly
02
LTSM020090
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MD-998772 - Valve spring compressor
LTSM020092
Valves
• Clean all valves thoroughly and discard burned,
warped and cracked valves.
• Check valve seats and valve faces for damage.
• When reconditioning valves follow the specifica-
tions outlined for both intake and exhaust valves.
BESM020066
• Measure valve deflection.
02
LTSM020101
BESM020066
LTSM020102
VALVE HEIGHT
DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATION LIMIT
Intake Valve Height 112.30 mm 111.80 mm
Exhaust Valve Height 114.11 mm 113.61 mm
Valve Guides
• Check the clearance (1) between the valve guide
and the valve stem, if it exceeds the limit, check
valve to valve guide clearance.
− Measure valve stem diameter (2) and valve
guide inner diameter (3).
− Check that clearance is within specification.
− If it exceeds the limit, replace valve or valve
guide.
LTSM020101
CAUTION:
When replacing valve guides, do not use a new valve guide that is the same size as the original
valve guide.
− Enlarge valve guide size 0.05 (11.05 - 11.068 mm) 02
− Enlarge valve guide size 0.25 (11.25 - 11.268 mm)
− Enlarge valve guide size 0.50 (11.50 - 11.518 mm)
• Install the new valve guide from the top of the cylinder head as shown in the illustration.
− Intake valve guide length: 45.5 mm
− Exhaust valve guide length: 50.5 mm
CAUTION:
The intake and exhaust valves are different
lengths, use care when replacing the valve
guides to install the correct valve guide.
• Install the valve guide to the specified height (1) of
14 mm.
LTSM020106
• After installing the valve guide, insert the new valve and check for smooth movement.
Valve Seats
• Before machining the valve seat, check the clear-
ance between the valve guide and the valve stem.
If the clearance is excessive, repair the valve and
valve guide if necessary before machining the valve
seat.
• Repair the width and angle of the valve seat until
the valve seat meets specified values.
• After repairing the valve seat, use valve lapping
compound to lap the valves and seats in pairs.
LTSM020103
LTSM020104
• Select the replacement valve seat according to the outer diameter of the enlarged valve seat.
NOTE :
Before installing the valve seat, heat the cylinder head to the temperature of about 250°, or cool the valve seat in
liquid nitrogen in order to install the valve seat.
• Machine the new valve seat and valve to proper specifications.
Assembly
1. Install the valves into the cylinder head (larger diameter on intake side).
2. Using special tool MD-998774, install the new valve oil seal .
3. Install the valve springs.
4. Install the valve spring retainers.
5. Using valve spring compressor MD-998772 (1),
compress the valve springs.
6. Install the valve keepers.
7. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer
after installation to verify proper assembly.
LTSM020092
Valve Springs
Specifications
Valve Spring Specifications
Disassembly
02
LTSM020090
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MD-998772 - Valve spring compressor
LTSM020092
Inspection
NOTE :
Whenever valves have been removed for inspection, reconditioning or replacement, valve springs should be tested
for correct load.
•
• Check the valve spring length/height. Discard the
springs that do not meet specifications.
• The following specifications apply to both intake
and exhaust valve springs.
BESM020072
• Check the valve spring center line. Discard the springs that do not meet specifications.
• The following specifications apply to both intake
and exhaust valve springs.
02
LTSM020100
Assembly
1. Install the valve springs (2).
2. Install the valve spring retainers (1).
3. Using valve spring compressor MD - 998772, com-
press the valve springs.
4. Install the valve keepers.
5. Strike the valve stem lightly with a plastic hammer
after installation to verify proper assembly.
LTSM020039
ECM Inputs
• Brake Switch Sensor
• Refrigerant Pressure Sensor 03
• Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
• Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
• Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
• Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor (1.6L)
• Air Flow Sensor (1.8L)
• Throttle Position Sensor (Integral with Electronic Throttle Control Actuator)
• Power Steering Switch
• Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
• Knock Sensor
• Oxygen Sensor (Upstream & Downstream)
• Vehicle Speed Sensor
• Clutch Pedal Switch (Manual transaxle only)
ECM Outputs
• Canister Control Valve
• Fuel Injectors
• Fuel Pump Relay
• Electronic Throttle Control Actuator
• Ignition Coil
• A/C Compressor
• Cooling Fan
• Oxygen Sensor Heater (Upstream & Downstream)
Operation
The ECM monitors components and circuits, and tests them in various ways depending on the hardware, function,
and type of signal. For example, analog inputs, such as throttle position or engine coolant temperature are typically
checked for opens, shorts and out-of-range values. This type of monitoring is carried out continuously. Some digital
inputs like vehicle speed or crankshaft position rely on rationality checks - checking to see if the input value makes
sense at the current engine operating conditions. These types of tests may require monitoring several components
and can only be carried out under appropriate test conditions.
The ECM is a pre-programmed, microprocessor-based digital computer. It regulates ignition timing, air-fuel ratio,
emission control devices, charging system, certain transmission features, speed control, air conditioning compressor
clutch engagement and idle speed. The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Engine Analyzer
KES-200
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
03
Compression Gauge
Hardware Requirements
The hardware configuration of X-431 is as follows:
BESM030003
Electrical Schematics
Electronic Engine Controls (Page 1 of 11)
03
LTSMW030080T
LTSMW030081T
03
LTSMW030082T
LTSMW030083T
03
LTSMW030084T
LTSMW030085T
03
LTSMW030086T
LTSMW030087T
03
LTSMW030088T
LTSMW030089T
03
LTSMW030090T
Ground Inspection
Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits. Ground connec-
tions are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The corrosion (rust) can become an unwanted
resistance. This added resistance can alter the way a circuit works.
Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground can drastically
affect an electronically controlled circuit. A poor or corroded ground can effect the circuit. Perform the following when
inspecting a ground connection:
1. Remove the ground bolt or screw.
2. Inspect all mating surface for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
3. Clean as required to assure good contact.
4. Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
5. Inspect for ⬙add-on⬙ accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
6. If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure all of the wires
are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are crimped to one eyelet, make
sure no excess wire insulation has been crimped creating a bad ground.
Self-Learning Components
Perform the self-learning process when the following repairs have been made:
• Replaced the ECM
• ECM which was disconnected and reconnected
• Replaced the Accelerator Pedal
• Replaced the Electronic Throttle Control Actuator
CAUTION:
Make sure that the Electronic Throttle Control Actuator self-learning process lasts for at least 10
seconds according to the Electronic Throttle Control Actuator self-learning condition. If the self-
learning process fails, the engine can’t be started or the EPC lamp will be on. If this condition
occurs, perform the Self-Learning operating again after the DTCs be erased in ECM.
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
(With EOBD)
Intake Air Temperature
1 Upstream Oxygen Sensor 42
Sensor
Heater (Without EOBD)
2 Ignition Coil 2 43 -
3 GND (Ignition) 44 Switched Supply Voltage
(With EOBD)
4 Downstream Oxygen 45 Switched Supply Voltage
Sensor Heater (Without
EOBD)
5 Ignition Coil 1 46 Canister Control Valve
6 Injector 2 47 Injector 4
Upstream Oxygen Sensor
7 Injector 3 48 Heater (With EOBD)
(Without EOBD)
8 Engine Speed Output 49 -
Coolant Temperature
9 50 Fan Relay Control
Output
10 Fuel Consumption Output 51 GND (Signal)
11 EPC Lamp 52 -
Continuous Supply
12 53 GND (Signal)
Voltage
Electronic Throttle Control
13 Ignition Switch 54
Actuator
Downstream Oxygen
14 EMS Relay (Main Relay) 55
Sensor
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
Crankshaft Position
15 56 -
Sensor
Accelerator Position
16 57 -
Sensor
17 Sensor (GND) 58 Brake Switch
18 Upstream Oxygen Sensor 59 Vehicle Speed Sensor
A/C Middle Pressure
19 Knock Sensor 1 60
Switch
20 Knock Sensor 2 61 GND (Power)
21 Brake Switch 62 -
22 - 63 Switched Supply Voltage
Electronic Throttle Control
23 Accelerator Sensor 64
Actuator
Electronic Throttle Control
24 - 65
Actuator
Electronic Throttle Control
25 - 66
Actuator
Electronic Throttle Control
26 - 67
Actuator
27 Injector 1 68 Fan Relay Control 2
Downstream Oxygen
Sensor Heater (With
28 EOBD) 69 Air Compressor Relay
(Without EOBD)
29 - 70 Fuel Pump Relay
30 - 71 Diagnostic Link K
31 MIL Lamp 72 -
Regulated Sensor Supply Regulated Sensor Supply
32 73
2 1
Regulated Sensor Supply
33 74 Clutch Pedal Switch
1
Crankshaft Position
34 75 A/C Stand By
Sensor
35 Sensor (GND) 76 Power Steering Switch
36 Sensor (GND) 77 Headlamp Switch
Manifold Absolute
Pressure Sensor (With
37 1.6L Engine) 78 Sensor (GND)
Air Flow Sensor (With
1.8L Engine)
Electronic Throttle Control
38 79 Camshaft Position Sensor
Actuator (Position Sensor)
Engine Coolant
39 80 GND (Power)
Temperature Sensor
Accelerator Pedal Position
40 81 -
Sensor
41 -
03
LTSMW030042T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
03
LTSMW030043T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Confirmation Procedure:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 12 V.
• Turn ignition switch off.
• Connect the X-431 scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC) - use the most current software available.
• Start the engine and warm it to normal operating temperature.
• With the scan tool, select view data stream.
• If the data stream is not detected, the condition is current. Go to Diagnostic Procedure Step 1.
• If the data stream is detected, the condition is intermittent (See Diagnosis & Testing Diagnostic Help in Section
03 Electronic Engine Controls).
Diagnostic Procedure
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes >> • Go to step 7.
No >> • Go to step 2.
LTSMD030061
Check harness for open or short between ECM terminals 3, 51 ,53, 61, 80 and ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
LTSMD030063
11.CHECK FUSE
• Disconnect fuse 27 (10A), fuse 24 (5A) in the front fuse and relay box.
• If Without EOBD (1.6L): Disconnect fuse 23 (10A), fuse 24 (5A) front fuse and relay box.
Check fuses.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace fuse 23, fuse 24 or fuse 27.
LTSMW030051T
03
LTSMW030046T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
15 Crankshaft Position (CKP) • Ignition switch: ON
3V
34 sensor • Engine: Not cranking
Camshaft Position (CMP) • Ignition switch: ON
79 11 V
sensor • Engine: Not cranking
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE CMP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
03
VISMD030001
LTSMD030044
5. CHECK THE CMP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
03
BESM030016
Inspect and clean the CMP sensor and mounting area for any condition that would result in an incorrect signal, such
as damage, foreign material, or excessive movement.
Check Resistance
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
1&2
1&3 Except 0 or ⬁
2&3
VISMD030004
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
BESM030025
Inspect and clean the CKP sensor and mounting area for any condition that would result in an incorrect signal, such
as damage, foreign material, or excessive movement.
Check Resistance
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
Approximately
03
1&2
1000 ⍀
13.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0016 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program the ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030054T
LTSMW030055T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Oxygen sensor
• Harness or connectors
O2 sensor 1 heater
P0031 Engine is running (The sensor circuit is open
control circuit low
or shorted)
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
BESM030017
LTSMD030029
TERMINAL
OXYGEN SENSOR
ECM Oxygen sensor
• 48 (With EOBD)
Upstream oxygen sensor heater 1
• 1 (Without EOBD)
1 and 2 (including
Approximately 9 ⍀
cable and connector)
1 and 3, 4
⬁ ⍀ (Continuity
should not exist)
4 and 1, 2
6. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030054T
LTSMW030055T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Fuel quality
• Oxygen Sensor
O2 sensor 1 heater •Harness or connectors
P0032 Engine is running.
control circuit high (The sensor circuit is open
or shorted)
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
BESM030017
LTSMD030029
1 and 3, 4
⬁ ⍀ (Continuity
should not exist)
4 and 1, 2
6. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030058T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–53
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
17 Sensor (GND) Approximately 0 V
Regulated sensor
33 • Engine is running 5V
supply 1
• Warm-up condition: 78 °C
Approximately 322
• Idle: 795 RPM
37 Air flow sensor kg/h
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal voltage: 1.88 V Approximately 1.39 V
Regulated sensor
73 5V
supply 1
Diagnostic Procedure
3. CHECK THE MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
LTSMD030075
LTSMD030042
7. CHECK THE MAF SENSOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ECM terminal 37.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for a short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for an open or short to ground in harness or connectors.
DATA
TERMINAL 03
ITEM CONDITION (AVERAGE DC
NO.
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is
running Approximately
• ECT: 78 °C 322 kg/h
Air
• Idle: 795
37 flow
RPM
sensor
• IAT: 36 °C Approximately
• IAT signal: 1.39 V
1.88 V
If without the X-431, check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
DATA
TERMINAL
ITEM CONDITION (AVERAGE DC
NO.
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is
running
• ECT: 78 °C
Air
• Idle: 795 Approximately
37 flow
RPM 1.39 V
sensor
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal:
1.88 V
9. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030058T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
17 Sensor (GND) Approximately 0 V
Ignition switch on
33 Regulated sensor supply 1 5V
• Engine is running
• Warm-up condition ECT:
78 °C Approximately 322 kg/h
• Idle: 795 RPM or approximately 1.39 V
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal: 1.88 V
37 Air flow sensor
• Engine is running
• Warm-up condition ECT:
52 °C Approximately 420 kg/h
• Idle: 910 RPM or approximately 1.52 V
• IAT: 30 °C
• IAT signal: 2.17 V
73 Regulated sensor supply 1 Ignition switch on 5V
Diagnostic Procedure
3. CHECK THE MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
LTSMD030075
Check harness for short to power between air flow sensor and ECM.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK THE MAF SENSOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR SHORT TO POWER
Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ECM terminal 37.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for short to power in harness or connectors.
DATA
TERMINAL 03
ITEM CONDITION (AVERAGE DC
NO.
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is
running Approximately
• ECT: 78 °C 322 kg/h
Air flow • Idle: 795
37
sensor RPM
• IAT: 36 °C Approximately
• IAT signal: 1.39 V
1.88 V
If without the X-431, check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
DATA
TERMINAL
ITEM CONDITION (AVERAGE DC
NO.
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is
running
• ECT: 78 °C
Air flow • Idle: 795 Approximately
37
sensor RPM 1.39 V
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal:
1.88 V
8. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030052T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD030076
VISMD030010
3. CHECK THE MAP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
03
LTSMD030057
• Approximately 5 V should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
• If circuit is normal, Go to the next step.
5. CHECK THE MAP SENSOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR HIGH RESISTANCE
Check for harness continuity between MAP sensor terminal 4 and ECM terminal 37.
• Continuity should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or high resistance in harness or connectors.
Check sensor signal between sensor terminal 4 and ground with digital multimeter.
MAP Sensor Output Signal
• Engine
running: Idle
• Press Approximately 1.3 V
accelerator
MAP Engine: pedal slowly
4
sensor Running
• Press
Up to approximately
accelerator
4 V (instantaneous)
pedal quickly
8. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030052T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
Diagnostic Procedure
03
LTSMD030076
VISMD030010
3. CHECK THE MAP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
LTSMD030057
5. CHECK THE MAP SENSOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
Check for harness continuity between MAP sensor terminal 4 and ECM connector E-001, terminal 37.
• Continuity should exist.
Check harness short to ground or short to power.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for open or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Check sensor signal between sensor terminal 4 and ground with digital multimeter.
MAP Sensor Output Signal
• Press
accelerator Approximately
pedal 1.3 V
slowly.
MAP Engine:
4
sensor Running
• Press Up to
accelerator approximately
pedal 4V
quickly. (instantaneous)
8. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030052T
03
LTSMW030058T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT VOLTAGE
03
LTSMD030075
Turn ignition switch on.
LTSMD030031
LTSMD030076
LTSMD030056
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030058T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–79
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
LTSMW030052T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• IAT sensor
Intake Air • Ignition switch: Output signal is
• Harness or
P0113 Temperature (IAT) ON wrong or out of
connectors
circuit high input • Engine: Running acceptable range.
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD030075
LTSMD030031
LTSMD030076
LTSMD030056
IAT SENSOR
ECM CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 17
For 1.8L engine, check continuity between IAT sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 17.
IAT SENSOR
ECM CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
3 17
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Approximately
42 IAT sensor Ignition switch: ON IAT: 78 °C
1.88 V
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030053T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–85
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
NOTE :
• Before performing this DTC diagnostic procedure, verify that the engine coolant temperature is normal.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT
03
BESM030019
LTSMD030032
ECT °C RESISTANCE K⍀
20 °C 2.37 - 2.63
80 °C 0.299 - 0.345
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030053T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
NOTE :
• Before performing this DTC diagnostic procedure, verify that the Engine coolant temperature is normal.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT
03
BESM030019
LTSMD030032
3. CHECK ECT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT TO POWER
1 17 Yes
ECT °C RESISTANCE K⍀
20 °C 2.37 - 2.63
80 °C 0.299 - 0.345
5. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030044T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030006
LTSMD030035
Check harness for an open or short to ground between TPS connector terminal 2 and ECM connector E-001, ter-
minal 78.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace harness or connectors.
7. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030044T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–99
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030006
LTSMD030035
2 78
5. CHECK TPS
6. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030054T
03
LTSMW030055T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Fuel quality
• Oxygen Sensor 1
(upstream)
O2 sensor 1 (upstream)
P0132 Engine is running • Harness or connectors
circuit high voltage
(The sensor circuit is open
or shorted)
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
BESM030017
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 18 and oxygen sensor terminal 4.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Check harness open and short to power supply circuit.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK OXYGEN SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT
Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and oxygen sensor terminal as follows.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Check Sensor Signal Circuit
NORMAL
CHECK ITEM CHECK CONTENT
VALUE
• Warm-up
Decelerate
condition
from 4,000 Below 200
• Become
RPM mV
lean while
suddenly
decelerate
• Warm-up
condition
Oxygen Accelerate 600 - 1,000
• Become
sensor suddenly mV
rich while
accelerate
• Warm-up Idle 100 - 900 mV
condition
• Check with
oxygen 600 - 1,000
2500 RPM
sensor signal mV
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030052T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–109
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
LTSMW030058T
03
LTSMW030048T
LTSMW030049T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Idle
7 Injector 3 • Engine is running
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Warm-up condition
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
DATA (AVERAGE DC 03
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
17 Sensor (GND) • Engine is running 0V
• Warm-up condition:
33 Regulated sensor supply 1 5V
78 °C
Air flow sensor (1.8L) • Idle: 795 RPM Approximately 322 kg/h
37 • IAT: 36 °C
Approximately 1.39 V
• IAT signal voltage:
73 Regulated sensor supply 1 1.88 V 5V
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
• Engine running: Idle
• Press accelerator pedal Approximately 1.3 V
Manifold Absolute slowly
37 Pressure (MAP) sensor • Engine running: 2000
Approximately 1.5 V
(1.6L) RPM
• Press accelerator pedal Up to Approximately 4 V
quickly (instantaneous)
Diagnostic Procedure
Listen for intake air leak after the air flow sensor.
Check PCV hose connector.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace.
03
BESM030017
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is running
• ECT: 78 °C Approximately 322 kg/h
• Idle: 795 RPM
37 Sensor signal
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal voltage: Approximately 1.39 V
1.88 V
• Engine running:
Idle Approximately
• Press accelerator 1.3 V
pedal slowly
MAP Engine:
4
sensor Running
Up to
• Press accelerator Approximately
pedal quickly 4V
(instantaneous)
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Fuel Pressure Test in section 04 Fuel Delivery).
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine: Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
Start engine.
Select ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ menu.
Perform injector active test.
Make sure that each test produces a momentary engine speed drop.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 11.
No >> • Go to the next step.
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
• Battery voltage should exist.
Turn ignition switch off.
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Check Injector
ECM INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO.
TERMINAL TERMINAL
1 27 2
2 6 2
3 7 2
4 47 2
RESISTANCE
INJECTOR INJECTOR
(APPROXIMATELY)
NO. TERMINAL
⍀ (20 °C)
1 1, 2
2 1, 2
16
3 1, 2
4 1, 2
12.CHECK INJECTOR
WARNING!
Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
Remove fuel delivery rail with injectors (See Fuel Injector Rail Removal & Installation 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L in Section
04 Fuel Delivery).
NOTE :
Be careful not to drop the fuel injectors when removing the fuel delivery rail.
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector rail.
Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
Observe the fuel injectors and crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Fuel should be sprayed evenly by each injector.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to next step.
No >> • Clean any injector that sprays unevenly or replace any injector that does not spray fuel.
13.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
See DTC ⬙Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0171 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030052T
LTSMW030058T
03
LTSMW030048T
LTSMW030049T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
03
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
17 Sensor (GND) 0V
• Engine is running
33 Regulated sensor supply 1 • Warm-up condition: 78 °C 5V
• Idle: 795 RPM 322 kg/h
37 Air flow sensor (1.8L) • IAT: 36 °C 1.39 V
• IAT signal: 1.88 V
73 Regulated sensor supply 1 5V
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
• Engine running: Idle
• Press accelerator pedal Approximately 1.3 V
Manifold Absolute slowly
37 Pressure (MAP) sensor • Engine running: 2000
Approximately 1.5 V
(1.6L) RPM
• Press accelerator pedal Up to Approximately 4 V
quickly (instantaneous)
Diagnostic Procedure
03
BESM030017
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Fuel Pressure Test in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine: Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE) 03
• Engine is running
• ECT: 78 °C 322 kg/h
37 MAF sensor • Idle: 795 RPM
• IAT: 36 °C 1.39 V
• IAT signal: 1.88 V
• Engine
running:
Idle Approximately 1.3
• Press V
accelerator
MAP Engine: pedal
4 slowly.
sensor Running
• Press
accelerator Up to approximately
pedal 4 V (Instantaneous)
quickly.
Start engine.
Select ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ menu.
Perform injector active test.
Make sure that each test produces a momentary engine speed drop.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 10.
No >> • Go to the next step.
BESM040006
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness for a short to ground between the following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should not exist.
ECM INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO.
TERMINAL TERMINAL
1 27 2
2 6 2
3 7 2
4 47 2
RESISTANCE
INJECTOR INJECTOR
(APPROXIMATELY)
NO. TERMINAL
⍀ (20 °C) 03
1 1, 2
2 1, 2
16
3 1, 2
4 1, 2
11.CHECK INJECTOR
WARNING!
Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
Remove fuel delivery rail with injectors (See Fuel Injector Rail Removal & Installation 1.6L &1.8L &2.0L in Section 04
Fuel Delivery).
NOTE :
Be careful not to drop the fuel injectors when removing the fuel delivery rail.
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector rail.
Disconnect all injector harness connectors.
Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to next step.
No >> • Replace the injectors from which fuel is dripping. Always replace O-ring with new one.
12.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0172 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030048T
LTSMW030049T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
03
On Board Diagnostic Logic
• Self-diagnosis detection logic.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
P0201 Cylinder 1 - Injector Circuit
P0202 Cylinder 2 - Injector Circuit • Injector
Engine is running • Harness or connectors
P0203 Cylinder 3 - Injector Circuit • ECM
P0204 Cylinder 4 - Injector Circuit
Diagnostic Procedure
2. INSPECTION START
03
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
ECM INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO.
TERMINAL TERMINAL
1 27 2
2 6 2
3 7 2
4 47 2
9. CHECK INJECTOR
Injector Resistance
1 1, 2
2 1, 2
12
3 1, 2
4 1, 2
Signal Output
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6
• Engine is running
7 • Warm-up condition
Injector Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47
03
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace injector.
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
See ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0201, P0202, P0203 or P0204 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
LTSMW030044T
03
LTSMW030045T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DTC
DTC POSSIBLE
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION
DEFINITION CAUSE
CONDITION
• Electronic
throttle control
actuator (TPS1
and TPS2)
• Harness or
Throttle Position Ignition switch Rationally incorrect voltage is sent connectors (The
P0221 Sensor (TPS) B on or after to ECM compared with the signals sensor signal
performance engine start from TPS1 and TPS2. circuit is open or
shorted)
• Accelerator
pedal position
sensor 2
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030006
LTSMD030035
4. CHECK THE TPS AND THE ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
Check harness for short to power and short to ground between following terminals.
Check TPS Power Supply
• Engine
stopped
• 0.72 - 0.74
Accelerator V
pedal:
Accelerator Fully
APP Pedal released
16 sensor Position
terminal 4 Sensor 1 • Engine 03
(APPS1) stopped
•
Accelerator 3.95 V
pedal:
Fully
Turn depressed
ignition
switch on • Engine
stopped
• 0.36 - 0.37
Accelerator V
pedal:
Accelerator Fully
APP Pedal released
40 sensor Position
terminal 1 Sensor 2 • Engine
(APPS2) stopped
•
Accelerator 1.97 V
pedal:
Fully
depressed
7. CHECK THE TPS SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT
Check harness continuity between electronic throttle control actuator terminal 2 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power and short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or short to power or short to ground in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK TPS
TPS VOLTAGE
TERMINAL ITEM CONDITION (DC
NO. VOLTAGE)
• Engine
stopped
• 4.24 V
Accelerator
pedal: Fully
Throttle released
5 Position
Sensor 2
(TPS2) • Engine
stopped
• 0.72 V
Accelerator
pedal: Fully
depressed
Ignition
switch: ON
• Engine
stopped
• 0.74 V
Accelerator
pedal: Fully
Throttle released
6 Position
Sensor 1
(TPS1) • Engine
stopped
• 4.62 V
Accelerator
pedal: Fully
depressed
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030048T
03
LTSMW030049T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
Cylinder 1 - Injector Circuit
P0261
Low
Cylinder 2 - Injector Circuit
P0264
Low • Injector
Engine is running • Harness or connectors
Cylinder 3 - Injector Circuit • ECM
P0267
Low
Cylinder 4 - Injector Circuit
P0270
Low
Diagnostic Procedure
2. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes >> • If with the X-431, Go to the next step.
• If without the X-431, Go to step 4.
No >> • Go to step 5.
03
3. PERFORM ACTIVE TEST FUNCTION
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
Check Injector
INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO. GROUND
TERMINAL
1 2
2 2
Ground
03
3 2
4 2
9. CHECK INJECTOR
Injector Resistance
RESISTANCE
INJECTOR INJECTOR
(APPROXIMATELY)
NO. TERMINAL
⍀ (20 °C)
1 1, 2
2 1, 2
12
3 1, 2
4 1, 2
Signal Output
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0261, P0264, P0267 or P0270 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030048T
LTSMW030049T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
03
On Board Diagnostic Logic
• Self-diagnosis detection logic.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
Cylinder 1 - Injector Circuit
P0262
High
Cylinder 2 - Injector Circuit
P0265
High • Injector
Engine is running • Harness or connectors
Cylinder 3 - Injector Circuit • ECM
P0268
High
Cylinder 4 - Injector Circuit
P0271
High
Diagnostic Procedure
2. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes >> • If with the X-431, Go to the next step.
• If without the X-431, Go to step 4.
No >> • Go to step 5.
03
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
9. CHECK INJECTOR
RESISTANCE
INJECTOR INJECTOR
(APPROXIMATELY)
NO. TERMINAL
⍀ (20 °C) 03
1 1, 2
2 1, 2
16
3 1, 2
4 1, 2
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
See ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0262, P0265, P0268 or P0271 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
LTSMW030046T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
15 Crankshaft Position (CKP) • Ignition switch: ON
3V
34 sensor • Engine: Not cranking
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030004
LTSMD030048
Check harness for an open or short between CKP sensor and ECM.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • Repair circuit for open or short in harness or connectors.
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
Approximately
1&2
860 ⍀
Check the installed clearance (See Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Removal & Installation in Section 08 Transaxle
& Transfer Case).
• 0.8 - 1.2 mm should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Reinstall CKP sensor.
8. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030047T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–167
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM TEST METHOD
VOLTAGE)
• Test Method 1: Knock at
19 Knock sensor 1 cylinder with rubber
Output signal voltage
hammer
should exist.
20 Knock sensor 2 • Test Method 2: Knock at
sensor slightly
Diagnostic Procedure
03
KNOCK SENSOR
ECM CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
19 1
20 2
BESM030018
Set the digital multimeter to the voltage range.
KNOCK SENSOR
TEST METHOD
TERMINAL NO.
Test Method 1:
Knock at cylinder
with rubber hammer
1&2
Test Method 2:
Knock at sensor
slightly
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030051T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–171
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
VOLT (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Camshaft Position (CMP) • Ignition switch: ON
79 11 V
sensor • Engine: Not cranking
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT
03
VISMD030001
LTSMD030044
5. CHECK THE CMP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT TO POWER
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
03
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
1&2
1&3 Except 0 or ⬁
2&3
Check the install clearance (See CMP Sensor Removal & Installation in section 03 Electronic Engine Controls).
• 0.8 - 1.2 mm should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Reinstall CMP sensor.
9. CHECK CAMSHAFT
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0343 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030050T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–177
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature then select view DTC.
• Touch the EVAP canister valve body, raise engine speed up to 2,000 RPM.
• Use the scan tool X-431 ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ function of the EVAP canister valve, touch the EVAP canister valve
body, perform the action test.
A slight vibration should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 7.
No >> • Go to the next step.
03
VISMD030007
LTSMD030046
Check voltage between EVAP canister control valve terminal 2 and ground with digital multimeter.
• Approximately 3.6 V should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace open circuit in harness or connectors.
• If harness is normal, Go to the next step.
EVAP CANISTER
RESISTANCE ⍀
CONTROL VALVE
(20 °C)
TERMINAL NO.
1&2 Approximately 26 ⍀
Check air passage continuity and operation when apply 12 V current supply voltage between terminal 1 and 2.
• The check results should match specification.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace EVAP canister control valve.
7. CHECK DTC
NOTE :
If DTC P0506 is displayed with other DTCs, perform this diagnostic procedure before other DTCs.
Diagnostic Procedure
3. CHECK DTC
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
Internal control module
P0601
memory check sum error 03
Internal controller module
P0604 Random Access Memory ECM detected an internal
(RAM) error • ECM
failure.
Internal controller module
P0605
ROM test error
P0606 ECM processor
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check if the ECM supply voltage circuit, ground circuit open, high resistance or short circuits existing.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for an open or short in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK DTC
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check if the ECM supply voltage circuit, ground circuit open, high resistance or short circuits existing.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for open or short in harness and connectors.
3. PROGRAM ECM
With the scan tool X-431, program ECM before replace it, and view the DTC with the X-431.
Is DTC P0602 still present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
• Refer to any Technical Bulletins that may be issued.
No >> • The DTC was caused by a programming error.
4. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030065T
LTSMW030066T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD030065
4. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030044T
03
LTSMW030045T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR (TPS) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT - (1)
VISMD030006
LTSMD030035
Check harness for short to power or short to ground, between following terminals.
Check TPS Power Supply
APP SENSOR
ECM TERMINAL
TERMINAL 03
Check harness continuity between electronic throttle control actuator terminal 2 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power and short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK TPS
ECM
DATA (DC
TERMINAL ITEM CONDITION
NO. VOLTAGE)
• Engine
stopped
• Accelerator 4.24 V
Electronic pedal: Fully
38 (TPS throttle control released
connector actuator
terminal 5) (Position • Engine
sensor) stopped
• Accelerator 0.72 V
pedal: Fully
depressed
Ignition switch
on
• Engine
stopped
• Accelerator 0.74 V
pedal: Fully
54 (TPS Electronic released
connector throttle control
terminal 6) actuator • Engine
stopped
• Accelerator 4.62 V
pedal: Fully
depressed
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030045T
03
LTSMW030044T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030008
LTSMD030053
LTSMD030066
Check harness for short to power and short to ground between following terminals.
Check TPS Power Supply
7. CHECK TPS
Check harness continuity between APP sensor 1 terminal 4 and ECM terminal 16, APP sensor 2 terminal 1 and ECM
terminal 40.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power and short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for an open or short to power or short to ground in harness or connectors.
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
• Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.72 - 0.74 V
Accelerator Pedal Fully released
16 Position Sensor 1
(APPS1) • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 3.95 V
Turn ignition switch Fully depressed
on • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.36 - 0.37 V
Accelerator Pedal Fully released
40 Position Sensor 2
(APPS2) • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 1.97 V
Fully depressed
11.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P2138 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
Operation
The ECT provides an input to the Engine Control Module (ECM). As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a different voltage value
03
at the ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, A/C compressor and
radiator fan on/off times.
CAUTION:
Remove the coolant temperature sensor
when the engine is cold.
4. Remove the engine coolant temperature sensor
(1).
(Tighten: Engine coolant temperature sensor to
20 N·m)
LTSM030035
NOTE :
After installed the engine coolant temperature sensor, check the coolant level.
Knock Sensor
Description
The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. The knock sensor is designed to detect engine vibration that is
caused by detonation.
Operation
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the Engine Control Module
(ECM). In response, the ECM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a specified amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input voltage (signal) to the
ECM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal’s vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage
also increases.
The ECM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed exceeds a specified
value, knock retard is allowed.
BESM030018
Oxygen Sensor
Description
This vehicle is equipped with two oxygen sensors (upstream & downstream). The oxygen sensors are located before
and after the three way catalyst. The oxygen sensors continually monitor the oxygen level in the exhaust gas. Even
if switching characteristics of the air flow sensor are shifted, the air flow is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the oxygen sensor. This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from approximately
1 volt in richer conditions to 0 volt in leaner conditions.
Operation
The oxygen sensor has a much longer switching time between rich and lean than the air flow sensor. The oxygen
storage capacity of the three way catalyst (manifold) causes the longer switching time. The oxygen senses the oxy-
gen content in the exhaust flow and outputs a voltage between 0 and 1.0 V. Lean of stoichiometric, air/fuel ratio of
approximately 14.7:1, the oxygen sensor generates a voltage between 0 and 0.45 V. Rich of stoichiometric, the oxy-
gen sensor generates a voltage between 0.45 and 1.0 V.
The oxygen sensor senses the oxygen content in the exhaust flow and outputs a voltage between 0 and 1.0 volt.
Lean of stoichiometric, air/fuel ratio of approximately 14.7:1, the oxygen sensor generates a voltage between 0 and
0.45 V. Rich of stoichiometric, the oxygen sensor generates a voltage between 0.45 and 1.0 V.
CAUTION:
Remove the oxygen sensor when the exhaust
pipe is cold.
3. Remove the upstream oxygen sensor (1) and
downstream oxygen sensor (2).
(Tighten: Oxygen sensor to 45 N·m)
BESM030017
Installation Notes:
• Before installing the oxygen sensor, coat the threads with rust inhibiting lubricant.
Operation
The crankshaft sensor is made of a toothed metal disk mounted on the crankshaft and a stationary detector that
covers a magnetic coil that the current passes through. As the metal teeth move past the coil, its magnetic field is
disturbed. This causes a stream of pulses in the current. The Engine Control Module (ECM) can calculate the speed
of the engine from the crankshaft’s frequency of pulses
LTSM030036
Operation
When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth causes the gap with the sensor to change. The changing
gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to change. Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the
sensor changes. The Engine Control Module (ECM) detects the voltage signal and identify piston position and cyl-
inder timing.
BESM030016
Operation
The vehicle speed sensor generates a signal sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM) and the Transaxle Control
Module (TCM) utilize to perform engine and transaxle functions.
BESM030024
Accelerator Sensor
Description
The accelerator sensor is located on the right front crossbeam.
Operation
The accelerator sensor monitors the road conditions. It sends a signal to the ECM, the ECM determines if a possible
misfire condition exists.
LTSM030030
Operation
The MAP sensor monitors the pressure in the intake manifold. The pressure in the manifold moves a diaphragm
connected to resistors which alter their resistance values. The output voltage of the MAP sensor signals the ECM
about the pressure in the intake manifold.
LTSM030037
Operation
The air flow sensor controls the temperature of the hot wire to a certain amount. The heat generated by the hot wire 03
is reduced as the intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss. Therefore, the electric current
supplied to the hot wire is changed to maintain the temperature of the hot wire as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this voltage signal change.
BESM030029
Operation
The accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor on the accelerator pedal works according to the Hall principal. the sen-
sor is integrated into the pedal lever axis. It consists of a shaft with a ring magnet. This rotates in a printed circuit
board with a stator in the fixed Hall elements. This produces a change in the voltage. The accelerator pedal position
sensor is supplied with 5 V from the Engine Control Module (ECM). The information regarding accelerator position is
supplied to the ECM by means of two voltages.
LTSM030038
Operation
Filtered air from the air cleaner enters the intake manifold through the throttle body. A throttle valve (plate) is used to
supply air for idle and driving conditions. The throttle position sensor is part the throttle body. The throttle position
sensor signal is used by the ECM to determine throttle position. The ECM controls the electronic throttle control to
meter air into the engine. This regulates engine power. The vehicle is in sense a “Drive by Wire” system.
BESM030022
Operation
The ECM is a pre-programmed, microprocessor-based digital computer. It regulates ignition timing, air-fuel ratio,
emission control devices, charging system, certain transmission features, speed control, air conditioning compressor
clutch engagement and idle speed. The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
Installation Notes:
• Program the vehicle Immobilizer module when-
ever the ECM is replaced.
LTSM030025
ECM Outputs
• Canister Control Valve
• Fuel Injectors
• Fuel Pump Relay
• Electronic Throttle Control Actuator
• Ignition Coil
• A/C Compressor
• Cooling Fan
• Oxygen Sensor heating coil (Upstream & Downstream)
Operation
The ECM monitors components and circuits and tests them in various ways depending on the hardware, function,
and type of signal. For example, analog inputs such as throttle position or engine coolant temperature are typically
checked for opens, shorts and out-of-range values. This type of monitoring is carried out continuously. Some digital
inputs like vehicle speed or crankshaft position rely on rationality checks - checking to see if the input value makes
sense at the current engine operating conditions. These types of tests may require monitoring several components
and can only be carried out under appropriate test conditions.
The ECM is a pre-programmed, microprocessor-based digital computer. It regulates ignition timing, air-fuel ratio,
emission control devices, charging system, certain transmission features, speed control, air conditioning compressor
clutch engagement and idle speed. The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Engine Analyzer
KES-200
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Compression Gauge
03
Electrical Schematics
Electronic Engine Controls (Page 1 of 11)
LTSMW030093T
03
LTSMW030094T
LTSMW030103T
03
LTSMW030095T
LTSMW030096T
03
LTSMW030097T
LTSMW030098T
03
LTSMW030099T
LTSMW030100T
03
LTSMW030101T
LTSMW030102T
Ground Inspection
Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits. Ground connec-
tions are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The corrosion (rust) can become an unwanted
resistance. This added resistance can alter the way a circuit works.
Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground can drastically
affect an electronically controlled circuit. A poor or corroded ground can effect the circuit. Perform the following when
inspecting a ground connection:
1. Remove the ground bolt or screw.
2. Inspect all mating surface for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
3. Clean as required to assure good contact.
4. Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
5. Inspect for ⬙add-on⬙ accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
6. If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure all of the wires
are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are crimped to one eyelet, make
sure no excess wire insulation has been crimped creating a bad ground.
Self-Learning Components
Perform the self-learning process when the following repairs have been made:
• Replaced the ECM
• ECM which was disconnected and reconnected
• Replaced the Accelerator Pedal
• Replaced the Electronic Throttle Control Actuator
Self-Learning Condition
The self-learning condition as the ⬙Electronic Throttle Control Actuator Self-Learning Condition⬙.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the Electronic Throttle Control Actuator self-learning process lasts for at least 10
seconds according to the Electronic Throttle Control Actuator self-learning condition. If the self-
learning process fails, the engine can’t be started or the EPC lamp will be on. If this condition
occurs, perform the Self-Learning operating again after the DTCs be erased in ECM.
Diagnostic Tools
• Scan Tool X-431
• Engine Analyzer KES-200
• Digital Multimeter
• Jumper Wire
Hardware Requirements
The hardware configuration of X-431 is as follows:
03
BESM030003
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
(With EOBD)
Intake Air Temperature
1 Upstream Oxygen Sensor 42
Sensor
Heater (Without EOBD)
2 Ignition Coil 2 43 -
3 GND (Ignition) 44 Switched Supply Voltage
(With EOBD)
4 Downstream Oxygen 45 Switched Supply Voltage
Sensor Heater (Without
EOBD)
5 Ignition Coil 1 46 Canister Control Valve
6 Injector 2 47 Injector 4
Upstream Oxygen Sensor
7 Injector 3 48 Heater (With EOBD)
(Without EOBD)
8 Engine Speed Output 49 -
Coolant Temperature
9 50 Fan Relay Control
Output
10 Fuel Consumption Output 51 GND (Signal)
11 EPC Lamp 52 -
Continuous Supply
12 53 GND (Signal)
Voltage
Electronic Throttle Control
13 Ignition Switch 54
Actuator
Downstream Oxygen
14 EMS Relay (Main Relay) 55
Sensor
Crankshaft Position
15 56 -
Sensor
Accelerator Position
16 57 -
Sensor
17 Sensor (GND) 58 Brake Switch
18 Upstream Oxygen Sensor 59 -
A/C Middle Pressure
19 Knock Sensor 1 60
Switch
20 Knock Sensor 2 61 GND (Power)
21 Brake Switch 62 CAN-H
22 - 63 Switched Supply Voltage
Electronic Throttle Control
23 Accelerator Sensor 64
Actuator
Electronic Throttle Control
24 - 65
Actuator
Electronic Throttle Control
25 - 66
Actuator
Electronic Throttle Control
26 - 67
Actuator
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
27 Injector 1 68 Fan Relay Control 2
Downstream Oxygen
Sensor Heater
28 (With EOBD) 69 Air Compressor Relay
(Without EOBD)
29 - 70 Fuel Pump Relay
30 - 71 Diagnostic Link K
03
31 MIL Lamp 72 -
Regulated Sensor Supply Regulated Sensor Supply
32 73
2 1
Regulated Sensor Supply
33 74 -
1
Crankshaft Position
34 75 A/C Stand By
Sensor
35 Sensor (GND) 76 Power Steering Switch
36 Sensor (GND) 77 Headlamp Switch
37 Air Flow Sensor 78 Sensor (GND)
Electronic Throttle Control
38 79 Camshaft Position Sensor
Actuator (Position Sensor)
Engine Coolant
39 80 GND (Power)
Temperature Sensor
Accelerator Pedal Position
40 81 CAN-L
Sensor
41 -
LTSMW030023T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
ECM Power Supply Circuits
LTSMW030024T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes >> • Go to step 7.
No >> • Go to step 2.
LTSMD030061
Check harness for open or short between ECM terminals 3, 51, 53, 61, 80 and ground.
Check harness for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
LTSMD030062
LTSMD030063
11.CHECK FUSE
• Disconnect fuse 23 (10A), fuse 24 (5A) in front fuse and relay box.
Check fuses.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace fuse 23 or 24.
03
LTSMW030032T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–249
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
LTSMW030027T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
15 Crankshaft Position (CKP) • Ignition switch: ON
3V
34 sensor • Engine: Not cranking
Camshaft Position (CMP) • Ignition switch: ON
79 11 V
sensor • Engine: Not cranking
03
On Board Diagnostic Logic
• Self-diagnosis detection logic.
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030001
LTSMD030044
5. CHECK CMP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
BESM030016
Inspect and clean the CMP sensor and mounting area for any condition that would result in an incorrect signal, such
as damage, foreign material, or excessive movement.
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
1&2
1&3 Except 0 or ⬁
2&3
03
VISMD030004
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
BESM030025
Inspect and clean the CKP sensor and mounting area for any condition that would result in an incorrect signal, such
as damage, foreign material, or excessive movement.
Check Resistance
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
Approximately 860
1&2
⍀
12.CHECK TIMING
Check for timing misalignment.
Is the timing misaligned?
Yes >> • Align the engine timing belt (See Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
No >> • Go to the next step.
13.CHECK DTC 03
LTSMW030036T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Fuel quality
O2 sensor 1 heater • Oxygen sensor
P0031 Engine is running
control circuit low • Harness or connectors
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
BESM030017
Turn ignition switch on.
Check supply voltage between oxygen sensor terminal
2 and ground in the oxygen sensor electrical connector
E-005 with digital multimeter.
• Battery voltage should exist.
LTSMD030029
1 and 2 (including
Approximately 9 ⍀
cable and connector)
6. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030036T
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Oxygen Sensor
O2 sensor 1 heater
P0032 Engine is running • Harness or connectors
control circuit high
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
03
BESM030017
LTSMD030029
1 & 2 (including
Approximately 9 ⍀
cable and connector)
6. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030033T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030005
LTSMD030041
LTSMD030042
7. CHECK THE MAF SENSOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ECM terminal 37.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for a short to ground or power.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or short to ground in harness or connectors.
ECM
TERMINAL ITEM CONDITION DATA
NO.
• Engine is Approximately
running 322 kg/h
• ECT: 78 °C
• Idle: 795
37 Air flow sensor RPM
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal
voltage: Approximately
1.88 V 1.39 V
If without the X-431, check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
ECM DATA
ITEM CONDITION (AVERAGE
TERMINAL DC
NO.
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is
running
• ECT: 78 °C
37 Air flow sensor • Idle: 795 Approximately
RPM 1.39 V
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal:
1.88 V
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030033T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030005
Check harness for short to power between air flow sensor and ECM.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for a short to power in harness or connectors.
Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ECM terminal 37.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for short to power in harness or connectors.
ECM
TERMINAL ITEM CONDITION DATA
NO.
• Engine is Approximately
running 322 kg/h
• ECT:
Air flow 78 °C
37
sensor • Idle: 795
RPM
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal: Approximately
1.88 V 1.39 V
If without the X-431, check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
ECM DATA
ITEM CONDITION (AVERAGE
TERMINAL DC
NO.
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is
running
37 (MAF • ECT:
Air flow 78 °C Approximately
sensor • Idle: 795
connector sensor 1.39 V
terminal 5) RPM
• IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal:
1.88 V
8. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030033T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–279
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
03
VISMD030005
LTSMD030031
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
42 IAT sensor Ignition switch on IAT: 36 °C 1.88 V
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030033T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
03
VISMD030005
LTSMD030031
IAT SENSOR
ECM TERMINAL
TERMINAL
3 17
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Approximately
42 IAT sensor Ignition switch on IAT: 36 °C
1.88 V
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030034T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–287
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
ECM TERMINAL
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC VOLTAGE)
NO.
Engine Coolant ECT: 59 °C Approximately 1.89 V
39 Temperature Ignition switch: ECT: 78 °C Approximately 1.25 V
(ECT) sensor ON ECT: 90 °C Approximately 0.94 V
17 Sensor (GND) - Approximately 0 V
NOTE :
• Before performing this DTC diagnostic procedure, verify that the engine coolant temperature is normal.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT
03
BESM030019
LTSMD030032
ECT °C RESISTANCE K⍀
10 °C 8.62 - 10.28
20 °C 2.37 - 2.63
80 °C 0.299 - 0.345
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Approximately
ECT: 59 °C
1.89 V
Approximately
39 ECT sensor ECT: 78 °C
1.25 V
Ignition switch on
Approximately
ECT: 90 °C
0.94 V
Approximately
17 Sensor (GND) -
0V
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030034T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–291
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
03
BESM030019
1 17 Yes
ECT °C RESISTANCE K⍀
20 °C 2.37 - 2.63
80 °C 0.299 - 0.345
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
ECT: 59 °C 1.89 V
39 ECT sensor ECT: 78 °C 1.25 V
Ignition switch: ON
ECT: 90 °C 0.94 V
17 Sensor (GND) - Approximately 0 V
03
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace ECT sensor.
5. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030025T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030006
Check harness for an open or a short to ground between TPS connector terminal 2 and ECM connector E-001,
terminal 78.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace harness or connectors.
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Regulated sensor
32 - Approximately 5 V
supply 2
•Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 4.24 V
Electronic throttle Fully released
38 control actuator
(position sensor) • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.72 V
Fully pressed
• Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.74 V
Ignition switch: ON Fully released
Electronic throttle
54
control actuator • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 4.62 V
Fully depressed
64 Motor 4
12 V or 0 V
65 Motor 3
66 Motor 2 -
0 V or 12 V
67 Motor 1
78 Sensor (GND) Approximately 0 V
7. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030025T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–301
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030006
LTSMD030035
2 78
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030036T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Fuel quality
• Oxygen Sensor 1
O2 sensor 1 (upstream)
P0132 Engine is running (upstream)
circuit high voltage
• Harness or connectors
• ECM
Diagnostic Procedure
BESM030017
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 18 and oxygen sensor terminal 4.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Check harness for an open and short to power supply circuit.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK OXYGEN SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT
Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and oxygen sensor terminal as follows.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Check Sensor Signal Circuit
CHECK NORMAL
CHECK CONTENT
ITEM VALUE
• Warm-up Decelerate
condition Below 100
• Become from 4,000
RPM mV
lean while suddenly
decelerate
• Warm-up
condition Accelerate Approximately
Oxygen • Become 600 - 900
sensor rich while suddenly mV
accelerate
5. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030033T
LTSMW030029T
LTSMW030030T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
03
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
17 Sensor (GND) • Engine is running 0V
• Warm-up condition:
33 Regulated sensor supply 1 78 °C Approximately 5 V
• Idle: 795 RPM Approximately 322 kg/h
37 Air flow sensor • IAT: 36 °C
• IAT signal: 1.88 V Approximately 1.39 V
Diagnostic Procedure
03
BESM030017
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
Continuity should exist.
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
• Engine is running
• ECT: 78 °C Approximately 322 kg/h
37 Air flow sensor • Idle: 795 RPM
• IAT: 36 °C Approximately 1.39 V
• IAT signal: 1.88 V
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Fuel Pressure Test in section 04 - Fuel Delivery).
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
Start engine.
Select ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ menu.
Perform injector active test.
Make sure that each test produces a momentary engine speed drop.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 11.
03
No >> • Go to the next step.
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
• Battery voltage should exist.
Turn ignition switch off
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Check Injector
ECM INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO.
TERMINAL TERMINAL
1 27 2
2 6 2
3 7 2
4 47 2
INJECTOR RESISTANCE
INJECTOR NO. (APPROXIMATELY)
TERMINAL ⍀ (20 °C) 03
1 1&2
2 1&2
16
3 1&2
4 1&2
12.CHECK INJECTOR
Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
Remove fuel delivery rail with injectors (See Fuel Injector Rail Removal & Installation 1.6L/1.8L/2.0L in section 04
Fuel Delivery).
NOTE :
Be careful not to drop the fuel injectors when removing the fuel delivery rail.
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector rail.
Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Fuel should be sprayed evenly for each injector.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to next step.
No >> • Clean or replace the defective fuel injector.
13.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
See DTC Confirmation Procedure.
Is DTC P0171 still pesent?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
LTSMW030033T
03
LTSMW030030T
LTSMW030030T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
03
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION DATA
17 Sensor (GND) 0V
• Engine is running
33
Regulated sensor • Warm-up condition: 78 °C 5V
supply 1 • Idle: 795 RPM
• IAT: 36 °C 322 kg/h
37 Air flow sensor • IAT signal: 1.88 V
1.39 V
Diagnostic Procedure
REFERENCE DATA
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION DATA
• Engine: warm up
• Shift: P or N
Injector pulse Idle Approximately 2.5 ms
• Air condition: Off
• No load
03
BESM030017
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Fuel Pressure Test in section 04 - Fuel Delivery)
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4 - 4.2 bar)
Start engine.
Select ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ menu.
Perform injector active test.
Make sure that each test produces a momentary engine speed drop.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 10.
No >> • Go to the next step.
BESM040006
Disconnect ECM harness connector.
check harness for short to ground between following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should not exist.
ECM INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO.
TERMINAL TERMINAL
1 27 2
2 6 2
3 7 2
4 47 2
INJECTOR RESISTANCE
2 1&2
11 - 16
3 1&2
4 1&2
11.CHECK INJECTOR
WARNING!
Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
Remove fuel delivery rail with injectors (See Fuel Injector Rail Removal & Installation 1.6L/1.8L/2.0L in Section 04
Fuel Delivery).
NOTE :
Be careful not to drop the fuel injectors when removing the fuel delivery rail.
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector rail.
Disconnect all injector harness connectors.
Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to next step.
No >> • Replace any leaking injectors as necessary. Always replace the O-ring seal when replacing the fuel
injector .
12.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0172 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030029T
LTSMW030030T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
03
On Board Diagnostic Logic
• Self-diagnosis detection logic.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
P0201 Cylinder 1 - Injector Circuit
P0202 Cylinder 2 - Injector Circuit • Injector
Engine is running • Harness or connectors
P0203 Cylinder 3 - Injector Circuit • ECM
P0204 Cylinder 4 - Injector Circuit
Diagnostic Procedure
2. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes >> • If with the X-431, Go to the next step.
• If without the X-431, Go to step 4.
No >> • Go to step 5.
Start engine.
Select ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ menu.
Perform injector active test.
Make sure that each test produces a momentary engine speed drop.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 10.
No >> • Go to step 5.
03
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
ECM INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO.
TERMINAL TERMINAL
1 27 2
2 6 2
3 7 2
4 47 2
9. CHECK INJECTOR
1 1&2
2 1&2
11 - 16
3 1&2
4 1&2
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Idle
03
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Warm-up condition
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
See ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0201, P0202, P0203 or P0204 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
LTSMW030025T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030006
LTSMD030035
• Approximately 5.0 V should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 7.
No >> • Go to the next step.
4. CHECK THE TPS AND THE ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
Check harness for short to power and short to ground between following terminals.
Check TPS Power Supply
ECM APP
DATA (DC
TERMINAL SENSOR ITEM CONDITION
NO. TERMINAL VOLTAGE)
• Engine
stopped
• 0.72 -
Accelerator 0.74 V
pedal:
Accelerator Fully
APP released
16 sensor pedal
position • Engine
terminal 4
sensor 1
stopped
•
Accelerator 3.95 V
pedal:
Fully
Ignition depressed
switch on • Engine
stopped
• 0.36 -
Accelerator 0.37 V
pedal:
Accelerator Fully
APP released
40 pedal
sensor position
terminal 1 • Engine
sensor 2
stopped
•
Accelerator 1.97 V
pedal:
Fully
depressed
Check harness continuity between electronic throttle control actuator terminal 2 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power and short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or short to power or short to ground in harness or connectors. 03
8. CHECK TPS
TPS
DATA (DC
TERMINAL ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
NO.
• Engine
stopped
• Accelerator 4.24 V
Throttle pedal: Fully
released
5 Position
Sensor 2 • Engine
(TPS2)
stopped
• Accelerator 0.72 V
pedal: Fully
Ignition depressed
switch: ON • Engine
stopped
• Accelerator 0.74 V
Throttle pedal: Fully
released
6 Position
Sensor 1 • Engine
(TPS1)
stopped
• Accelerator 4.62 V
pedal: Fully
depressed
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030029T
03
LTSMW030030T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
Cylinder 1 - Injector Circuit
P0261
Low
Cylinder 2 - Injector Circuit
P0264
Low • Injector
Engine is running • Harness or connectors
Cylinder 3 - Injector Circuit • ECM
P0267
Low
Cylinder 4 - Injector Circuit
P0270
Low
Diagnostic Procedure
2. INSPECTION START
03
3. PERFORM ACTIVE TEST FUNCTION
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
03
LTSMD030077
Check for harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should not exist.
Check Injector
INJECTOR
INJECTOR NO. GROUND
TERMINAL
1 2
2 2
Ground
3 2
4 2
9. CHECK INJECTOR
1 1&2
2 1&2
11 - 16
3 1&2
4 1&2
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
See ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0261, P0264, P0267 or P0270 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030029T
LTSMW030030T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 V - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
03
On Board Diagnostic Logic
• Self-diagnosis detection logic.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
Cylinder 1 - Injector Circuit
P0262
High
Cylinder 2 - Injector Circuit
P0265
High • Injector
Engine is running • Harness or connectors
Cylinder 3 - Injector Circuit • ECM
P0268
High
Cylinder 4 - Injector Circuit
P0271
High
Diagnostic Procedure
2. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Select ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ menu.
Perform injector active test.
Make sure that each test produces a momentary engine speed drop.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 9.
No >> • Go to step 5.
03
BESM040006
LTSMD030024
9. CHECK INJECTOR
Injector Resistance
1 1&2
2 1&2
11 - 16
3 1&2
4 1&2
DATA (AVERAGE DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
6 Injector 2
• Engine is running
7 Injector 3 • Warm-up condition
Voltage: 11 V - 14 V
27 Injector 1 • Idle
• Accelerate suddenly
47 Injector 4
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
See ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0262, P0265, P0268 or P0271 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
LTSMW030027T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
15 Crankshaft Position (CKP) • Ignition switch: ON
3V
34 sensor • Engine: Not cranking
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030004
LTSMD030048
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
Approximately
1&2
860 ⍀
Check the install clearance (See CKP sensor Removal & Installation in section 08 Transaxle & Transfer Case).
• 0.8 - 1.2 mm should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Reinstall CKP sensor.
03
7. CHECK GEAR TOOTH
8. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030028T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–362
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM TEST METHOD
VOLTAGE)
• Test Method 1: Knock at
19 Knock sensor 1 cylinder with rubber
Output signal voltage
hammer
should exist.
20 Knock sensor 2 • Test Method 2: Knock at
sensor slightly
Diagnostic Procedure
03
KNOCK SENSOR
ECM TERMINAL
TERMINAL
19 1
20 2
BESM030018
Set digital multimeter at voltage range.
KNOCK SENSOR
TEST METHOD
TERMINAL NO.
Test Method 1:
Knock at cylinder
with rubber hammer
1&2
Test Method 2:
Knock at sensor
slightly
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030032T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–366
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DATA (AVERAGE DC
ECM TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Camshaft Position (CMP) • Ignition switch: ON
79 11 V
sensor • Engine: Not cranking
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE CMP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
03
VISMD030001
LTSMD030044
5. CHECK THE CMP SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT TO POWER
ENGINE ANALYZER
( KES-200 )
03
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
1&2
1&3 Except 0 or ⬁
2&3
Check the install clearance (See CMP sensor Removal & Installation in section 03 - Electronic Engine Controls).
• 0.8 - 1.2 mm should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Reinstall CMP sensor.
9. CHECK CAMSHAFT
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P0343 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
03
LTSMW030031T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–372
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature then select view DTC.
• Touch the EVAP canister valve body, raise engine speed up to 2,000 RPM.
• If the scan tool X-431 with the ⬙ACTIVE TEST⬙ function of the EVAP canister valve, touch the EVAP canister
valve body, perform the action test.
Slight vibration and concussion should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 7.
No >> • Go to the next step.
03
VISMD030007
LTSMD030046
Check voltage between EVAP canister control valve terminal 2 and ground with digital multimeter.
• Approximately 3.6 V should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open in harness or connectors.
• If harness is normal, Go to the next step.
EVAP CANISTER
RESISTANCE ⍀
CONTROL VALVE
(20 °C)
TERMINAL NO.
1-2 Approximately 26 ⍀
Check air passage continuity and operation when apply 12 V current supply voltage between terminal 1 and 2.
• The check results should match specification.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace EVAP canister control valve.
7. CHECK DTC
Diagnostic Procedure
3. CHECK DTC
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
Internal controller module Random Access
P0604
Memory (RAM) error ECM detected an
ECM
P0605 Internal controller module ROM test error internal failure
P0606 ECM processor
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check if the ECM supply voltage circuit, ground circuit open, high resistance or short circuits existing.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for open or short in harness and connectors.
3. CHECK DTC
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check if the ECM supply voltage circuit, ground circuit open, high resistance or short circuits existing.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open or short in harness and connectors.
3. PROGRAM ECM
With the scan tool X-431, program ECM before replace it, and view the DTC with the X-431.
Is DTC P0602 setting again?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
• Refer to Technical Bulletin that issued.
4. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030063T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–382
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
LTSMW030064T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK AIR CONDITION CLUTCH RELAY CONTROL CIRCUIT POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
LTSMD030065
4. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030025T
03
LTSMW030026T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
VISMD030006
LTSMD030035
LTSMD030077
Turn ignition switch off.
Check harness continuity between TPS terminal 3 and ECM terminal 32.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace circuit for an open.
Check harness for short to power and short to ground, between following terminals.
CHECK TPS POWER SUPPLY
APP SENSOR
ECM TERMINAL
TERMINAL 03
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
• Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.72 - 0.74 V
Accelerator pedal Fully released
16
position sensor • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 3.95 V
Turn ignition switch Fully depressed
on • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.36 - 0.37 V
Accelerator pedal Fully released
40
position sensor • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 1.97 V
Fully depressed
Check harness continuity between electronic throttle control actuator terminal 2 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power and short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK TPS
TPS DATA
TERMINAL ITEM CONDITION (DC
NO. VOLTAGE) 03
• Engine
stopped
•
Accelerator 4.24 V
pedal:
Electronic Fully
throttle released
5 control
actuator • Engine
(TPS2) stopped
•
Accelerator 0.72 V
pedal:
Fully
Ignition depressed
switch:
ON • Engine
stopped
•
Accelerator 0.74 V
pedal:
Electronic Fully
throttle released
6 control
actuator • Engine
(TPS1) stopped
•
Accelerator 4.62 V
pedal:
Fully
depressed
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030026T
03
LTSMW030025T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
VISMD030008
LTSMD030053
Check harness for short to power and short to ground, between following terminals.
Check TPS Power Supply
7. CHECK TPS
TPS VOLTAGE
TERMINAL ITEM CONDITION (DC
NO. VOLTAGE) 03
• Engine
stopped
• Accelerator 4.24 V
Electronic pedal: Fully
throttle released
5 control
actuator • Engine
(TPS2) stopped
• Accelerator 0.72 V
pedal: Fully
Ignition depressed
switch: ON • Engine
stopped
• Accelerator 0.74 V
Electronic pedal: Fully
throttle released
6 control
actuator • Engine
(TPS1) stopped
• Accelerator 4.62 V
pedal: Fully
depressed
Check harness continuity between APP sensor 1 terminal 4 and ECM terminal 16, APP sensor 2 terminal 1 and ECM
terminal 40.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power and short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for an open or short to power or short to ground in harness or connectors.
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
03
• Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.72 - 0.74 V
Accelerator Pedal Fully released
16
Position sensor • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 3.95 V
Turn ignition switch Fully depressed
on • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 0.36 - 0.37 V
Accelerator Pedal Fully released
40
Position sensor • Engine stopped
• Accelerator pedal: 1.97 V
Fully depressed
11.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC P2138 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
LTSMW030038T
NOTE :
• Ensure that the battery is fully charged.
• Before performing any DTC diagnostic procedures, verify the ECM power and ground circuits are properly con-
nected.
• Before performing the diagnostic procedure, settle all other ECM DTCs first.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK DTC
With the scan tool X-431, enter all the other CAN communication modules such as TCM, CAN converter module.
Read the CAN DTC.
Were other modules CAN DTCs found?
Yes >> • If all of the other modules have the same DTC ⬙CAN Communication⬙, Go to the next step.
• If all of the other modules have the DTC ⬙Lost communication with ECM⬙, and do not have the
⬙CAN Communication⬙, Replace and program the ECM module.
No >> • Go to step 8.
LTSMD030077
Check resistance between ECM connector terminal 62 and 81.
ECM ECM
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
RESISTANCE
TERMINAL TERMINAL
(CAN-H) (CAN-L)
03
62 81 123 ⍀
Disconnect TCM and CAN converter connectors (See Transaxle Control Module Remove & Installation in section 08
Transaxle).
Check harness continuity between following terminals.
TCM ECM
CAN CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
CAN-H 38 62 Yes
TCM ECM
CAN CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
CAN-L 39 81 Yes
6 (CAN-H)
Ground
14 (CAN-L)
Inspect the ECM electrical connector pins for proper fit or any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTC.
Is the check result normal and DTC U0001 not present?
Yes >> • The system is now operating properly.
• Reassemble the vehicle and road test to verify the customers complaint is repaired.
No >> • Replace and program ECM.
• The problem caused by ECM internal error.
Operation
The ECT provides an input to the Engine Control Module (ECM). As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a different voltage value
at the ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, A/C compressor and
radiator fan on/off times.
CAUTION:
Remove the coolant temperature sensor
when the engine is cold.
4. Remove the engine coolant temperature sensor
(1).
(Tighten: Engine coolant temperature sensor to
20 N·m)
LTSM030035
NOTE :
After installed the engine coolant temperature sensor, check the coolant level.
Knock Sensor
Description
The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. The knock sensor is designed to detect engine vibration that is
caused by detonation.
03
Operation
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the Engine Control Module
(ECM). In response, the ECM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a specified amount.
The knock sensor contains a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input voltage (signal) to
the ECM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The ECM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed exceeds a specified
value, knock retard is allowed.
BESM030018
Oxygen Sensor
Description
This vehicle is equipped with two oxygen sensors (upstream & downstream). The oxygen sensors are located before
and after the three way catalyst. The oxygen sensors continually monitor the oxygen level in the exhaust gas. Even
if switching characteristics of the air flow sensor are shifted, the air flow is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the oxygen sensor. This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from approximately
1 volt in richer conditions to 0 volt in leaner conditions.
Operation
The oxygen sensor has a much longer switching time between rich and lean than the air flow sensor. The oxygen
storage capacity of the three way catalyst (manifold) causes the longer switching time.
The oxygen sensor senses the oxygen content in the exhaust flow and outputs a voltage between 0 and 1.0 V. Lean
of stoichiometric, air/fuel ratio of approximately 14.7:1, the oxygen sensor generates a voltage between 0 and 0.45 V.
Rich of stoichiometric, the oxygen sensor generates a voltage between 0.45 and 1.0 V.
CAUTION:
Remove the oxygen sensor when the exhaust
pipe is cold.
3. Remove the upstream oxygen sensor (1) and
downstream oxygen sensor (2).
(Tighten: Oxygen sensor to 45 N·m)
BESM030017
Installation Notes:
• Before installing, coat the threads with rust inhibiting lubricant.
Operation
When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause the gap with the sensor to change. The
changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to change. Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage
from the sensor changes. The Engine Control Module (ECM) receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation
of the engine revolution.
03
LTSM030036
Operation
When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause the gap with the sensor to change. The changing
gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to change. Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the
sensor changes. The Engine Control Module (ECM) detects the voltage signal and identify piston position and cyl-
inder timing.
BESM030016
Operation
The air flow sensor controls the temperature of the hot wire to a certain amount. The heat generated by the hot wire
is reduced as the intake air flows around it. The more air,the greater the heat loss. Therefore, the electric current
supplied to the hot wire is changed to maintain the temperature of the hot wire as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this voltage signal change.
BESM030029
Accelerator Sensor
Description
The accelerator sensor is located on the right front crossbeam.
Operation
The accelerator sensor monitors the road conditions. It sends a signal to the ECM, the ECM determines if a possible
misfire condition exists.
LTSM030030
Operation
Set Operation
• Press CRUISE combination switch (ON/OFF switch). The CRUISE indicator in instrument cluster illuminates.
• When vehicle speed reaches a desired speed between approximately 25 km/h and 130 km/h, press SET
switch.
Speed Operation
• If the vehicle speed has been increased by during cruise control driving, the SET switch is pressed and then
Speed Control System will keep the new set speed.
• If the RESUME/ACC switch is pressed (Less than 0.5 seconds) by during cruise control driving, the cruising
speed is higher than the original speed of 2 km/h.
• If the DEC switch is pressed (Less than 0.5 seconds) by during cruise control driving, the cruising speed is
less than the original speed of 2 km/h.
Cancel Operation
• When any of following conditions exist, cruise operation will be canceled.
− OFF switch is pressed
− Brake pedal is depressed
− If any malfunction occurs in Speed Control System, it automatically deactivates control.
Electrical Schematics
Speed Control System (page 1 of 4)
LTSMW030060T
03
LTSMW030061T
LTSMW030106T
03
LTSMW030062T
Operation
The Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor on the accelerator pedal works according to the Hall principal. the sen-
sor is integrated into the pedal lever axis. It consists of a shaft with a ring magnet. This rotates in a printed circuit
board with a stator in the fixed Hall elements. This produces a change in the voltage. The accelerator pedal position
sensor is supplied with 5 V from the Engine Control Module (ECM). The information regarding accelerator position is
supplied to the ECM by means of two voltages.
LTSM030038
Operation
Filtered air from the air cleaner enters the intake manifold through the throttle body. A throttle valve (plate) is used to 03
supply air for idle and driving conditions. The throttle position sensor is part the throttle body. The throttle position
sensor signal is used by the ECM to determine throttle position. The ECM controls the electronic throttle control to
meter air into the engine. This regulates engine power. The vehicle is in sense a “Drive by Wire” system.
BESM030022
Operation
The ECM is a pre-programmed, microprocessor-based digital computer. It regulates ignition timing, air-fuel ratio,
emission control devices, charging system, certain transmission features, speed control, air conditioning compressor
clutch engagement and idle speed. The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
Installation Notes:
• Program the vehicle immobilizer module when-
ever the ECM is replaced.
LTSM030025
ECM Inputs
• Brake Switch Sensor
• Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
• Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
• Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
• Air Flow Sensor
• Coolant Temperature Sensor (For Instrument Cluster)
• Throttle Position Sensor (Integral with Electronic Throttle Control Actuator)
• Power Steering Switch
• Knock Sensor
• Oxygen Sensor (Upstream & Downstream)
• Clutch Pedal Switch (Manual transmission only)
ECM Outputs
• Canister Control Valve
• Fuel Injectors
• Fuel Pump Relay
• Electronic Throttle Control Actuator
• Ignition Coil
• A/C Compressor
• Cooling Fan
• Oxygen Sensor heating coil (Upstream & Downstream)
Operation
The ECM monitors components and circuits and tests them in various ways depending on the hardware, function,
and type of signal. For example, analog inputs such as throttle position or engine coolant temperature are typically
checked for opens, shorts and out-of-range values. This type of monitoring is carried out continuously. Some digital
inputs like vehicle speed or crankshaft position rely on rationality checks - checking to see if the input value makes
sense at the current engine operating conditions. These types of tests may require monitoring several components
and can only be carried out under appropriate test conditions.
The ECM is a pre-programmed, microprocessor-based digital computer. It regulates ignition timing, air-fuel ratio,
emission control devices, charging system, certain transmission features, speed control, air conditioning compressor
clutch engagement and idle speed. The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Engine Analyzer
KES-200
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Compression Gauge
Electrical Schematics
Electronic Engine Controls (Page 1 of 10)
03
LTSMW030067T
LTSMW030068T
03
LTSMW030069T
LTSMW030070T
03
LTSMW030071T
LTSMW030072T
03
LTSMW030073T
LTSMW030074T
03
LTSMW030075T
LTSMW030076T
Diagnostic Logic
If the DTC can not be deleted, it is a current failure.
If the DTC can be deleted, it is an intermittent incident. In many cases, the malfunction resolves itself (the part or
circuit function returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the
customer’s complaint often do not recur on (1st trip) DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent causes of inter-
mittent incidents occurrences is poor electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident
occurred may not be clear. Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not
indicate the specific malfunctioning area.
Check if it is because of the loosening of cable joint.
Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
Monitor the scan tool data relative to this circuit and wiggle test the wiring and connectors.
Look for the data to change or for the DTC to reset during the wiggle test.
Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
Inspect the sensor and mounting area for any condition that would result in an incorrect signal, such as damage,
foreign material.
Refer to any Technical Service Bulletins that may apply.
DIAGNOSTIC REFERENCE
• Check ground terminals for corroding or loose connection. Refer to ⬙Ground Inspection⬙.
• Search for electrical incident. Refer to ⬙Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident⬙.
• Check connector terminals. Refer to ⬙How to Check Terminal⬙.
DURING ENGINE CHECKS AND REPAIRS USE CAUTION NOT TO HARM THE ENGINE MECHANICAL SYSTEM
• Check cylinder pressure.
• Check ignition timing.
• Check fuel system pressure.
• Check the EVAP system.
• Check for vacuum leaks.
• Check output of the TPS.
• Check the injectors for leaks.
Remove and install the doubtful ECM to a new vehicle and test it. If the DTC can not be deleted, the malfunction is
inside of ECM; if the DTC can be deleted, change the original ECM back and check it again according to above
items.
Inspect and clean all ECM, engine, and body grounds that are related to the DTC. If numerous trouble codes were
set, use a wire schematic and look for any common ground or supply circuits for any camshaft pulley DTCs inspect
for dirt/metal debris.
Use the scan tool to perform a System Test if one applies to a failing component. A co-pilot, data recorder, and/or
oscilloscope should be used to help diagnose intermittent conditions.
CAUTION:
Before starting repairs which do not require battery power:
• Turn ignition switch off.
• Disconnect the negative battery terminal.
Ground Inspection
Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits. Ground connec-
tions are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The corrosion (rust) can become an unwanted
resistance. This added resistance can alter the way a circuit works.
Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground can drastically
affect an electronically controlled circuit. A poor or corroded ground can effect the circuit. Perform the following when
inspecting a ground connection:
1. Remove the ground bolt or screw.
2. Inspect all mating surface for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
3. Clean as required to assure good contact.
4. Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
5. Inspect for ⬙add-on⬙ accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
6. If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure all of the wires
are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are crimped to one eyelet, make
sure no excess wire insulation has been crimped creating a bad ground.
Diagnostic Tools
1. Scan Tool X-431
2. Engine Analyzer (KES-200)
3. Digital Multimeter
4. Jumper Wire
Hardware Requirements
The hardware configuration of X-431 is as follows:
03
BESM030003
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
1 Injector 1 39 -
2 Injector 3 40 -
3 - 41 A/C Pressure Switch
4 Idle Air Control 1 42 - 03
5 Idle Air Control 3 43 -
6 EGR Control 44 -
7 Lan 1 45 -
8 Fuel Pump Relay 46 -
9 EVAP Control 47 -
10 Ignition Coil 1 48 Diagnostic Link K
11 - 49 -
12 Switched Supply Voltage 50 RPM
13 GND 51 Lan 2
Upstream Oxygen Sensor
14 Injector 2 52
Heater
15 Injector 4 53 -
16 - 54 Diagnosis Link K
17 Idle Air Control 2 55 Ignition Switch Start
Intake Air Temperature
18 Idle Air Control 4 56
Sensor
19 Air Flow Sensor 57 -
20 - 58 -
Downstream Oxygen
21 Cooling Fan Control 59
Sensor
22 A/C Relay 60 Upstream Oxygen Sensor
23 Ignition Coil 2 61 -
24 - 62 Knock Sensor
25 Switched Supply Voltage 63 -
26 GND 64 Continuous Supply Voltage
27 - 65 Regulated Sensor Supply
28 - 66 Ignition Switch On
Engine Coolant
29 Generator G 67
Temperature Sensor
30 - 68 Throttle Position Sensor
Atmosphere Pressure
31 - 69
Sensor
32 MIL Lamp 70 Speed In
33 Power Steering Switch 71 Idle Position Switch
34 Main Relay 72 Camshaft Position Sensor
35 - 73 Crankshaft Sensor
36 - 74 Air Flow Sensor
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
37 Generator FR 75 P/N Switch
38 - 76 Sensor (GND)
03
LTSMW030003T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–441
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
LTSMW030004T
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
Confirmation Procedure:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 12 V.
• Turn ignition switch off. 03
• Connect the X-431 scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC) - use the most current software available.
• Start the engine and warm it to normal operating temperature.
• With the scan tool, select view data stream.
• If the data stream is not detected, the condition is current. Go to Diagnostic Procedure Step 1.
• If the data stream is detected, the condition is intermittent (See Diagnosis & Testing Diagnostic Help in Section
03 Electronic Engine Controls).
Diagnostic Procedure
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes >> • Go to step 8.
No >> • Go to step 2.
LTSMD030074
• Battery voltage should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5.
No >> • Go to step 3.
Check voltage between ECM terminal 64 and ground with electronic digital multimeter.
• Battery voltage should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check the following:
− Fuse 27
− Harness connectors A-102, E-105, terminal 4
− Front fuse and relay box connector A
− Harness open or short between ECM and battery
Check harness for open or short between ECM terminals 13, 26 and ground.
Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for an open or short to power in harness or connectors.
03
8. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT - (3)
12.CHECK FUSE
Disconnect fuse 12 (30A), fuse 24 (5A), fuse 25 (10A), front fuse and relay box.
Check fuse.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace fuse 12, 23, 24.
03
LTSMW030016T
LTSMW030017T
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Fuel quality
• Oxygen sensor
11 Oxygen sensor Engine is running
• Harness or connectors
• ECM
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that ECM ground connections are in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSM030004
3. CHECK THE OXYGEN SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and oxygen sensor terminal as follows.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Check harness continuity between following terminals and ground.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should not exist.
Check Sensor Signal Circuit 03
COMPONENT ECM TERMINAL OXYGEN SENSOR TERMINAL
Upstream oxygen sensor 60 4
Downstream oxygen sensor 59 4
LTSMD030002
6. CHECK OXYGEN SENSOR HEATER CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN AND SHORT
2 & 3 (including
Approximately 9
cable and
⍀
connector)
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030013T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD030004
Check reference voltage between air flow sensor terminal 7 and ground in the air flow sensor electrical connector
E-058 with a digital multimeter.
• 4.8 - 5.2 V should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 6.
No >> • Go to the next step.
AIR FLOW
ECM
SENSOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
03
3 74
CAUTION:
To new vehicle (less than 500 km mileage), the sensor output frequency is 10 % higher than stan-
dard value.
AIR FLOW
ECM
SENSOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
7 19
8. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030013T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK THE INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
LTSMD030078
03
5 76 Yes
Check resistance between MAF sensor terminal 5 and 6 under the following conditions.
IAT °C RESISTANCE K⍀
20 °C 2.3 - 3.0
80 °C 0.30 - 0.42
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
IAT: 0 °C 3.2 - 3.8 V
IAT: 20 °C 2.3 - 2.9 V
56 IAT sensor Ignition switch: ON
IAT: 40 °C 1.5 - 2.1 V
IAT: 80 °C 0.4 - 1.0 V
76 Sensor (GND) Ignition switch: ON 0V
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030014T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSM030027
LTSMD030010
Check supply voltage between TPS terminal 1 and ground in the TPS electrical connector E-076 with digital multi-
meter.
• 4.5 - 5.5 V should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair the circuit for an open or short to power supply or ground in harness or connectors.
• If the circuit is normal, Go to the next step.
03
TPS TERMINAL ECM TERMINAL
4 76
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Regulated sensor
65 - Approximately 5 V
supply
TP is in idle position 0.3 - 1.0 V
TP is fully opened 4.5 - 5.5 V
Throttle Position
68 Value is directly
(TP) sensor TP is open step by
Ignition switch: ON proportional to TP
step
opening angle
Adjust TP to idle
0-1V
71 Idle position switch position
TP is ajar Above 4 V
76 Sensor (GND) - Approximately 0 V
8. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030005T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–472
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
LTSM030007
LTSMD030008
ECT SENSOR
ECM TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 76
ECT °C RESISTANCE K⍀
0 °C 5.1 - 6.5
20 °C 2.1 - 2.7
40 °C 0.9 - 1.3
80 °C 0.26 - 0.36
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
ECT: 0 °C 3.2 - 3.8 V
ECT: 20 °C 2.3 - 2.9 V
67 ECT sensor
Ignition switch: ON ECT: 40 °C 1.3 - 1.9 V
ECT: 80 °C 0.3 - 0.9 V
76 Sensor (GND) - Approximately 0 V 03
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace ECT sensor.
6. CHECK DTC
LTSMW030012T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
LTSMD030079
LTSMD030012
CKP
SENSOR TERMINAL CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
03
1 Ground Yes
Check harness for an open or short between CKP sensor and ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace harness or connectors.
Check Resistance
11.CHECK DTC 03
LTSMW030011T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN OR SHORT
LTSMD030080
LTSMD030014
03
CKP
SENSOR TERMINAL CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
1 Ground Yes
Check harness for open or short between CMP sensor and ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for an open or short in harness or connectors.
Check Resistance
9. CHECK CAMSHAFT
LTSMW030013T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
ECM TERMINAL
ITEM CONDITION DATA VOLTAGE
NO.
Regulated sensor
65 - 4.8 - 5.2 V
supply
3.7 - 4.3 V (101
Sea level altitude: 0 M
kPa)
Ignition switch: ON
Atmosphere Sea level altitude: 600 M 95 kPa
69
pressure sensor 3.2 - 3.8 V (88 03
Sea level altitude: 1200 M
kPa)
Sea level altitude: 1800 M 81 kPa
76 Sensor (GND) Ignition switch: ON 0V
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM ground connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD030078
ATMOSPHERE
PRESSURE
ECM TERMINAL
SENSOR
TERMINAL
5 76
Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 69 and atmosphere pressure sensor terminal 2.
03
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
• Continuity should exist.
Also check harness for short to power and short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace harness or connectors.
DATA (DC
TERMINAL NO. ITEM CONDITION
VOLTAGE)
Regulated sensor
65 - 4.8 - 5.2 V
supply
• Sea level altitude: 3.7 - 4.3 V
0M (101 kPa)
5. CHECK DTC
03
LTSMW030006T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–494
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Knock sensor
An excessive voltage from
31 Knock sensor • Harness or connectors
the sensor is sent to ECM.
• ECM
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM ground connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSM030011
Set multimeter at voltage range.
5. CHECK DTC
41 - Injector
03
LTSMW030008T
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions.
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
• Injector
41 Injector Engine is running • Harness or connectors
• ECM
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM ground connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes >> • If with the X-431, Go to the next step.
• If without the X-431, Go to step 4.
No >> • Go to step 5.
03
3. PERFORM ACTIVE TEST FUNCTION
LTSM020173
LTSMD030019
1 1 2
2 14 2
03
3 2 2
4 15 2
Check harness for an open or short between injector control circuit and ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair harness or connectors.
9. CHECK INJECTOR
RESISTANCE (APPROXIMATELY)
INJECTOR NO. INJECTOR TERMINAL
⍀ (20 °C)
1 1&2
2 1&2
13 - 16
3 1&2
4 1&2
10.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC 41 still present?
Yes >> • Replace ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
44 - Ignition Signal
03
LTSMW030007T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 03–504
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
Check reference values between ECM terminals and ground under the following conditions:
NOTE :
Before performing the following procedure, make sure that the ECM ground connection is in good condition.
Diagnostic Procedure
03
3. PERFORM ACTIVE TEST FUNCTION
IGNITION
COIL DATA (DC
ITEM CONDITION
TERMINAL VOLTAGE)
NO.
Ignition coil
10 0.3 - 3.0 V
1 terminal 3
Engine:
3000 RPM
Ignition coil
23 0.3 - 3.0 V
2 terminal 3
If with check tool-timing mark lamp, check the actual ignition time.
LTSM030017
LTSMD030022
• Battery voltage should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 6.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check harness for an open or short between ignition coil and ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for an open or short in harness or connectors.
CAUTION:
This test should be completed quickly (in 10 seconds), to prevent ignition coil from burning and
power transistor from damaging.
Also check resistance between ignition coil terminals as table shown.
• Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information.
Also ignition coil signal output.
Check Resistance
RESISTANCE ⍀
TERMINAL NO.
(25 °C)
1&2 Except 0 or ⬁
1&3
Except 0
2&3
13.CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read ECM DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC 44 still present?
Yes >> • Replace ECM.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
Operation
The ECT sensor provides an input signal to the ECM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor decreases.
As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a different voltage value at the ECT
sensor signal circuit. The ECM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator fan on/off times.
CAUTION:
Remove the coolant temperature sensor when the engine is cold.
4. Remove the engine coolant temperature sensor
(1).
(Tighten: Engine coolant temperature sensor to 20
N·m).
LTSM030007
Operation
The coolant temperature sensor (for instrument cluster) provides an input to the instrument cluster. With the coolant
temperature changes the bimetallic strip will curve complete the circuit and the temperature gauge will change.
LTSM030002
CAUTION:
Before removing the coolant temperature sensor (for instrument cluster), release the coolant pres-
sure and make sure the engine is cold.
Knock Sensor
Description
The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. The knock sensor is designed to detect engine vibration that is
caused by detonation.
Operation
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the ECM. In response, the
ECM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input voltage (signal) to the
ECM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The ECM receives an
input knock sensor voltage signal. If the signal rises above a predetermined level, the ECM will store that value in
memory and retard ignition timing to reduce engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a present value, the
ECM retards ignition timing for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The ECM ignores knock sensor input signal during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed exceeds a spec-
ified value, knock retard is allowed.
LTSM030011
Oxygen Sensor
Description
The oxygen sensor, after three way catalyst (manifold), monitors the oxygen level in the exhaust gas. Even if switch-
ing characteristics of the air flow sensor are shifted, the air flow is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal from the
oxygen sensor. This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from approximately 1 V in
richer conditions to 0 V in leaner conditions.
Operation
The oxygen sensor has a much longer switching time between rich and lean than the air flow sensor. The oxygen
storage capacity of the three way catalyst (manifold) causes the longer switching time. The oxygen senses the oxy-
gen content in the exhaust flow and outputs a voltage between 0 and 1.0 V. Lean of stoichiometric, air/fuel ratio of
approximately 14.7:1, the oxygen sensor generates a voltage between 0 and 0.45 V. Rich of stoichiometric, the oxy-
gen sensor generates a voltage between 0.45 and 1.0 V.
CAUTION:
Remove the oxygen sensor when the exhaust pipe is cold.
3. Remove the upstream oxygen sensor (1).
(Tighten: Upstream oxygen sensor to 45 N·m).
LTSM030004
03
LTSM030008
Installation Notes:
• Before installing, coat the threads with rust inhibiting lubricant.
Operation
When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause the gap with the sensor to change. The changing
gap cause the magnetic field near the sensor to change. Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the
sensor changes. The Engine Control Module (ECM) detects the voltage signal and identify piston position and cyl-
inder timing.
LTSM030005
Operation
The air flow sensor controls the temperature of the hot wire to a certain amount. The heat generated by the hot wire
is reduced as the intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss. Therefore, the electric current
supplied to the hot wire is changed to maintain the temperature of the hot wire as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this voltage signal change.
03
LTSM030006
Operation
Filtered air from the air cleaner enters the intake manifold through the throttle body. A throttle valve (plate) is used to
supply air for idle and driving conditions. The throttle position sensor is part the throttle body. The throttle position
sensor signal is used by the ECM to determine throttle position. The ECM controls the throttle control to meter air
into the engine. This regulates engine power. The vehicle is in sense a “Drive by Wire” system.
LTSM030010
NOTE :
Replace a new throttle control actuator gasket when installing.
Operation
The ECM is a pre-programmed, microprocessor-based digital computer. It regulates ignition timing, air-fuel ratio,
emission control devices, charging system, certain transmission features, speed control, air conditioning compressor
clutch engagement and idle speed. The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
LTSM030025
Operation
The TPS is a 4-wire variable resistor that provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with an input signal that rep-
resents the throttle valve position of the throttle body. The sensor is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the
position of the throttle valve changes, the resistance (output voltage) of the TPS changes.
03
LTSM030027
Operation
At idle, Engine Speed can be increased by retracting the IAC motor pintle and allowing more air to pass through the
port, or it can be decreased by restricting the passage with the pintle and diminishing the amount of air bypassing the
throttle valve.
The IAC is called a stepper motor because it is moved in steps, or increments. Opening the IAC opens an air pas-
sage around the throttle valve with increases RPM
LTSM030013
Operation
When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause the gap with the sensor to change. The
changing gap cause the magnetic field near the sensor to change. Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage
from the sensor changes. The Engine Control Module (ECM) receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation
of the engine revolution.
Visual Inspection
• Check if there is any fuel pipe is leaking.
• Check if the vacuum pipe is broken, kinked up or linked correctly. 03
• Check if the air intake pipe is jammed, leaking, staved or damaged.
• Check the high voltage line of ignition system if it is broken or aging and if the ignition order is correct.
• Check the cable grounding place if it is clean and fastness.
• Check the sensor and actuator joint if it is loosening or bad contact.
WARNING!
If the above phenomenon is appeared, you should repair the above the failure at first otherwise it will influence
the later service.
Diagnostic Help
• Confirm there is no engine failure record.
• Confirm that the failure exists before the customer complaints.
• Inspect the engine according to the above steps and find nothing wrong.
• During the service please do not ignore the influence from vehicle maintenance, cylinder pressure, mechanical
ignition timing and fuel conditions.
• Replace ECM and carry out test. If the failure is deleted, the failure is in ECM; if the failure can not be deleted,
replace back to the original ECM and repeat the flow and check and repair it again.
SYMPTOM DEFINITION
Engine Cranks Normal But Will Not Start
Engine Will Not Crank
Hard Start / Long Crank Time
Fast Idle
Lack / Loss Of Power
Back Fires
Engine Poor Driveability
Low Idle / Stalls During Deceleration
Idle Speed Slow Return To Normal Idle
1. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
Extended cranking because of a No Start can load the exhaust system with raw fuel, damaging the catalytic con-
verter after the engine starts.
Carry out the following preliminary checks:
• Fuel quality
• Electrical connections
• Intake air tube integrity
• Fuses and relays
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to next step.
No >> • Repair as necessary.
• Verify symptom no longer exists.
2. CHECK DTC
1. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
• Is a clicking sound heard from the starter relay when the ignition key is turned to START?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 5.
Check the starter, starter ground, starter relay cable to starter and battery.
Is a fault indicated?
Yes >> • Repair as required.
No >> • Go to the next step.
5. CHECK DTC
1. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
With the scan tool X-431, select view DTC and stream data in ECM.
Are there any DTCs present?
Yes >> • Check for cause. See diagnostic trouble code (DTC) index.
No >> • Go to the next step.
03
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Diagnosis & Testing Fuel Pressure Test in Section 04 Fuel
Delivery).
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
VISMD030024
Place a stiff piece of paper over the hose end, start engine.
• Does vacuum hold the paper?
Yes >> • Check for a vacuum leak in EVAP system (refer to EVAP system) and refer to EVAP control circuit
relative DTC.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Fast Idle
The following conditions apply to this symptom:
• The engine idles at a higher than recommended speed.
2. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
1. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
03
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Diagnosis & Testing Fuel Pressure Test in Section 04 Fuel
Delivery).
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
Check for base engine concerns (such as improper compression, worn camshaft/valve train, gasket leaks).
• Is a fault indicated?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • Go to the next step.
• Is a fault indicated?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • Go to the next step.
10.ADDITIONAL CHECKS
03
Additional checks:
• Customer driving habits (such as excessive loads or over RPM/speed limiting functions enabled).
• Ignition base timing (if not previously checked).
− If the base timing is not correct, align the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation
in Section 02 Engine).
• Clutch (M/T).
• Charging system.
• Are all checks OK?
Yes >> • See Diagnostic Help for additional information.
No >> • Repair as required. Verify symptom no longer exists.
Back Fires
The following conditions apply to this symptom:
• The engine will back fire when operated.
• The engine back fire occurs at all operating parameters.
1. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
6. CHECK TIMING 03
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Diagnosis & Testing Fuel Pressure Test in 04 Fuel Delivery).
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
Check for base engine concerns (such as improper cylinder compression, worn camshaft/valve train, gasket leaks).
• Is a fault indicated?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • See Diagnostic Help for additional information.
03
BESM030020
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing (See Diagnosis & Testing Fuel Pressure Test in Section 04 Fuel
Delivery).
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
VISMD030007
Additional checks:
• Driveline
• Transmission
• Charging system
• A/C system (for surge with A/C on)
• A/C compressor diode (for rolling idle and/or stumble when A/C cycles on)
• Are the checks OK?
Yes >> • See Diagnostic Help for additional information.
No >> • Repair as necessary.
1. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
Start engine.
Cycle A/C switch from on to off (verify A/C clutch engages condition).
Check the A/C system operation.
Does the A/C system operate normally?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair as necessary.
BESM030020
FUEL PRESSURES
Key On 400 kPa (4.0 bar)
Key Off 380 kPa (3.8 bar) in 10 minutes
Engine Idle 400 - 420 kPa (4.0 - 4.2 bar)
Check for base engine concerns (such as improper compression, worn camshaft/valve train, gasket leaks).
• Is a fault indicated?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • See Diagnostic Help for additional information.
1. PRELIMINARY CHECKS
Start engine and bring to normal operating temperature. Disconnect crankcase ventilation hose from PCV valve.
Place a stiff piece of paper over the hose. Wait 1 minute.
• Does vacuum hold paper in place?
Yes >> • Verify test results. If OK, see diagnostic index to repair any additional symptom.
No >> • Check for vacuum leaks, obstructions in the PCV system, oil cap, PCV valve, rocker cover bolt
torque/gasket leak. Repair as required.
Visual Inspection
• Check the fuel lines for any fuel leakage.
• Check the vacuum lines for breaks, kinked or incorrectly linked. 03
• Check the air intake pipe for any blockage, leaks or damage.
• Check the spark plug wires for signs of breaks, aging or if the ignition firing order is correct.
• Check the ground cables for clean and tight grounds.
• Check the sensors and actuators for loose electrical connections or bad contact.
WARNING!
If any of the above failures are present, repair the failure first before continuing any troubleshooting.
Diagnostic Help
• Confirm there is no engine failure record.
• Confirm that the failure exists before the customer complaints.
• Inspect the engine according to the above steps and find nothing wrong.
• During the service please do not ignore the influence from vehicle maintenance, cylinder pressure, mechanical
ignition timing and fuel conditions.
• Replace ECM and carry out test. If the failure is deleted, the failure is in ECM; if the failure can not be deleted,
replace back to the original ECM and repeat the flow and check and repair it again.
SYMPTOM DEFINITION
Unstable idle (too high or too low)
Bad acceleration performance and force shortage when accelerate
Idle speed control servo system
Ignition circuit system
Long time to start (improper starting)
Starting impossible (Starter Operative but No Initial Combustion)
The engine stalls when decelerating
The engine stalls when starting the car
The feeling of impact or vibration when accelerating
The feeling of impact or vibration when decelerating
Unstable Idle (Too High Or Too Low), Engine Stalls During Idling
1. CHECK BATTERY
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list to check power steering fluid pressure switch.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check power steering fluid pressure switch system.
LTSM030004
19.CHECK ECM
Replace ECM.
After ECM is replaced, re-check for trouble symptom.
Does trouble symptom persist?
Yes >> • Check for foreign matters (water, kerosene, etc.) in fuel and replace if necessary.
No >> • The system is normal.
1. PRELIMINARY CHECK
Apply the special connecting terminal to directly supply the fuel injector 12 V from the battery, and examine the nor-
mal operation of fuel injector.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 6.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Rinse the fuel injector, and then reexamine the normal operation of fuel injector.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check and replace the injector of the defective cylinder.
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list reference value to check these sensors:
With the scan tool X-431 or timing lamp, select view data stream item.
Check the ignition advance angle while starting.
Check the ignition advance angle when engine is at idle and 2500 RPM.
Key in ON position.
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list reference value to check the idle speed control position.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • The condition that caused the symptom is currently not present. Monitor the scan tool data relative 03
to this circuit and wiggle test the wiring and connectors. Refer to the diagnosis help.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check the starter relay K4 connector and fuse 12, fuse 22 and fuse 24 in front fuse and relay box.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Check and repair harness between (terminal 2 or 5) idle speed control servo connector and (termi-
nal F3) starter relay K4 connector. Check power supply line for open/short circuit.
No >> • Repair or replace the connector.
Check voltage between ignition coil connector E-069 and E-070, terminal and ground.
System voltage should exist.
Are the check results normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the harness between ignition switch connector and ignition coil connector.
With depressing the accelerator pedal slightly, and start the engine.
Is the start ability good?
Yes >> • Go to Step 6.
No >> • Go to Step 7.
Check engine-ECM power supply, engine control relay and ignition switch system.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair as necessary.
Check timing belt for breakage (see if the camshaft can rotate when start the engine).
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace the timing belt.
With depressing the accelerator pedal slightly, and start the engine to see the engine start ability.
Is the start ability good?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 8.
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list reference value to check cranking signal.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 10.
No >> • Go to the next step.
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list reference value to check the throttle position switch.
Diagnosis code set?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check throttle position switch.
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list reference value to check the throttle position sensor.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check throttle position sensor.
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list reference value to check the ISC motor steps.
Idle speed control servo drops to 0 − 2 steps at deceleration (Engine below 1,000 RPM).
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check idle speed control servo system.
Key in ON position.
With the scan tool X-431, select view the DTC.
Is there any DTC present?
Yes >> • Inspection chart for diagnosis code.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Key in ON position.
With the scan tool X-431, select view DTC.
Is there any DTC present?
Yes >> • Inspection chart for diagnosis code.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Key in ON position.
With the scan tool X-431, select view DTC.
Is there any DTC present?
Yes >> • Inspection chart for diagnosis code.
No >> • Go to the next step. 03
With the scan tool X-431, select view data stream item.
Refer to data list reference value to check the throttle position sensor.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check throttle position sensor system.
Ignition Coil 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L 03-581 Spark Plug 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L 03-584
Description 03-581 Removal & Installation 03-584
Operation 03-581 Spark Plug 2.4L 03-585
Removal & Installation 03-581 Removal & Installation 03-585
Ignition Coil 2.4L 03-582
Specifications
Torque Specifications
DESCRIPTION GAP
FR7DTC 0.7 mm - 1.1 mm
Special Tools
Engine Analyzer
KES-200
Electrical Schematics
Ignition Control System - 1.6L / 1.8L (Page 1 of 1)
03
LTSMW030057T
LTSMW030037T
03
LTSMW030007T
Operation
When the primary wire is connected to power, current will flow causing a strong magnetic field to form. When the
primary wire is disconnected, the magnetic field will collapse into the secondary wire causing very high voltage out-
put.
BESM030028
BESM030015
Operation
When the primary wire is connected to power, current will flow causing a strong magnetic field to form. When the
primary wire is disconnected, the magnetic field will collapse into the secondary wire causing very high voltage out- 03
put.
LTSM030022
BESM020022
BESM030013
Cylinder Number 1 2 3 4
Part Number A11-3707130HA A11-3707140HA A11-3707150HA A11-3707160HA
Length (mm) 405 275 165 125
Resistance (K⍀) 6.99 - 12.08 5.32 - 9.59 3.92 - 7.48 3.4 - 6.71
03
LTSM030017
LTSM030019
BESM020022
Installation Notes:
• Verify the proper spark plug gap before installing
spark plugs.
BESM030011
LTSM030022
LTSM030018
Operation
1.6L / 1.8L / 2.0L
BESM030026
2.4L
03
LTSM030031
The ECM will only energize the solenoid when the engine is at operating temperature, but will de-energize it during
periods of deceleration. When de-energized, no vapors are purged. The pulse-width modulated canister control valve
modulates the fuel vapor purge rate from the vapor canister and fuel tank to the engine intake manifold.
Electrical Schematics
Canister Control Valve 1.6L /1.8L
LTSMW030050T
03
LTSMW030031T
LTSMW030009T
03
LTSMW030010T
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Engine Analyzer
KES-200
Operation
The canister control valve is installed near of the engine air filter. The Engine Control Module (ECM) controls the
03
opening and closing of the canister control valve. When the ECM relay is energized, the canister control valve
switches from closed to open.
BESM030027
BESM030014
Operation
The Engine Control Module (ECM) controls the opening and closing of the canister control valve. When the ECM
relay is energized, the canister control valve switches from closed to open. The ECM uses a pulse-width modulated
canister control valve to regulates the rate of vapor flow from the vapor canister to the throttle body. The ECM con-
trols the frequency when the canister control valve operates in order to accommodate the vapor volume for each
cylinder.
LTSM030014
Operation
The vapor canister is filled with activated carbon granules. Fuel tank vapors are vented into the canister where they
are absorbed by the activated carbon granules. The canister temporarily holds the fuel vapors until intake manifold
vacuum draws them into the cylinder chamber. The Engine Control Module (ECM) purges the canister through the
pulse-width modulated canister control valve. The ECM purges the canister at predetermined intervals and engine
conditions.
03
BESM030010
Operation
The vapor canister is filled with activated carbon granules. Fuel tank vapors are vented into the canister where they
are absorbed by the activated carbon granules. The canister temporarily holds the fuel vapors until intake manifold
vacuum draws them into the cylinder chamber. The Engine Control Module (ECM) purges the canister through the
pulse-width modulated canister control valve. The ECM purges the canister at predetermined intervals and engine
conditions.
LTSM030016
LTSM030020
LTSM030033
Operation
The EGR valve can heighten the intake air temperature and reduce the NOx content in the exhaust. It is controlled
by coolant temperature sensor and the throttle position sensor.
03
LTSM030015
LTSM040008
04
LTSM040009
EVAP Assembly
LTSM040010
Operation
The fuel delivery system is enabled when it reaches the following conditions:
• Turn the ignition switch ON (engine off), the fuel delivery system is enabled for 3-6 seconds.
• The Engine Control Module (ECM) receives a Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor signal.
The fuel injectors are a solenoid-operated valve that meter fuel flow to each cylinder. The fuel injectors are opened
and closed constantly during engine operation. The amount of fuel is controlled by the length of time the fuel injector
is held open. The fuel injectors are powered by a 12-volt source and are controlled through the ground side of the
circuit by the ECM.
The fuel pump operation is defined in the fuel system control strategy and is controlled by the ECM.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
2.4L PRESSURE
Fuel Pressure at Fuel Rail - Key On 329 kPa (3.29 bar)
Fuel Pressure at Fuel Rail - Engine Idle 320 kPa (3.2 bar) - 350 kPa (3.5 bar)
04
Fuel Pressure at Fuel Rail - Key Off 350 kPa (3.5 bar) in 10 minutes
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Electrical Schematics
Fuel Delivery System (Page 1 of 6)
LTSMW040001T
04
LTSMW040002T
LTSMW040003T
04
LTSMW040004T
LTSMW040005T
04
LTSMW040006T
BESM030020
WARNING!
Wrap towels around hoses to catch any gasoline spillage.
1. Remove the protective cap and connect the fuel pressure gauge (2) to the fuel rail service test port pressure
fitting (1) on the fuel rail (3).
2. Start and warm the engine and note pressure gauge reading:
2.4L
• Fuel pressure at idle: 320-350 kPa (3.2 - 3.5 bar)
3. If the engine runs, but pressure is below the minimum pressure, check for a kinked fuel delivery line somewhere
between the fuel rail (3) and the fuel pump. If the line is not kinked, replace the fuel pump (See Fuel Pump
Removal & Installation in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
4. If operating pressure is above the maximum pressure, the electric fuel pump is OK, but fuel pressure regulator
is defective. Replace the fuel pressure regulator (See Fuel Pump Removal & Installation in Section 04 Fuel
Delivery).
NOTE:
• The 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L fuel pressure regulator is integrated into the fuel pump assembly and is not serviced
separately.
• The 2.4L fuel pressure regulator is connected to the fuel rail, and is serviced separately.
5. Install the protective cap to the service test port pressure fitting (1) on the fuel rail. 04
Observe the following fuel pressures when testing:
Perform the following procedure to relieve fuel pressure from the fuel system:
1. Remove the cover of the front fuse and relay box.
2. Identify and remove the fuel pump relay from the front fuse and relay box.
3. Start and run engine until it stalls.
4. Attempt to restart engine until it will no longer run.
5. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position.
Fuel Pump
Description
The fuel pump assembly contains the fuel pump motor and fuel level sensor.
Operation
The Engine Control Module (ECM) activates the fuel pump relay for several seconds after the ignition switch is
turned ON. When the relay is activated, it provides voltage to the fuel pump. When the ECM receives an engine
speed signal from the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor, the ECM will again energize the fuel pump relay. If the
engine speed signal is not received when the ignition switch is ON, the ECM will de-energize the fuel pump relay.
NOTE :
The following special tool is required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-20032 - Fuel pump remover
1. Release the fuel system pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the rear seat cushion.
LTSM040001
LTSM040002
NOTE :
Make sure not to spill fuel inside of the vehicle.
8. Tip the fuel pump on its side and drain the fuel from the fuel pump and remove the fuel pump from the vehicle.
NOTE: To keep the fuel tank portion clean and to avoid damage and foreign materials, cover them completely
with plastic bags or something similar.
9. Remove and discard the seal from the fuel tank.
10. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Install a new seal to the fuel pump sealing surface.
• Turn the ignition switch to ON (without starting the engine) to apply fuel pressure to the fuel system, then
check the connections for fuel leaks.
• Start the engine and let it idle and check for fuel leaks at the fuel system connections.
MEASURING
SPECIFICATION INSPECTION DIAGRAM
CONDITION
Digital Multimeter
Positive (+) to
terminal – 2
< 130 ⍀
Digital Multimeter
Negative (-) to
terminal – 3
Fuel Filter
Description
The fuel filter consists of a housing with an integrated filter element.
Operation
The fuel flows through the filter from the outside to the inside. As a result, any impurities are trapped inside the filter.
1. Release the fuel system pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the fuel delivery hose (1), fuel outlet hose
(2) and the ground wire (3).
4. Remove the fuel filter.
5. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Verify there are no leaks at the fuel line connec-
tions of the fuel filter.
LTSM040003
Operation
The fuel rail supplies the necessary fuel to each individual fuel injector and is located above the intake manifold and
fuel injectors.
1. Release the fuel system pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the engine cover.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors (1) from the
fuel injectors.
5. Remove the fuel line (2) from the fuel rail.
6. Remove the two fuel rail (4) bracket bolts (3) that
mount the fuel rail to the intake manifold.
(Tighten: Fuel rail bracket bolts to 11 N·m)
BESM040003
Installation Notes:
• Install new seals on the fuel injector sealing
surfaces.
BESM040005
1. Release the fuel system pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Disconnect four fuel injector electrical connectors
(1).
04
LTSM020173
4. Remove the fuel pressure regulator (See Fuel Pressure Regulator Removal & Installation in Section 04 Fuel
Delivery).
5. Remove the two fuel rail mounting bolts.
(Tighten: Fuel rail mounting bolts to 12 N·m)
6. Remove the fuel rail with the four fuel injectors.
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Install new seals on the fuel injector sealing surfaces.
Fuel Injector
Description
The fuel injectors are positioned in the intake manifold with the nozzle ends directly above the intake valve port.
Operation
Injector operation is controlled by a ground path provided for each injector by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
Injector on-time (pulse-width) is variable, and is determined by the ECM. Based on the engine operating conditions,
the ECM will control injector pulse-width operation to obtain optimum performance.
1. Release the fuel system pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the engine cover.
4. Remove the ground cable on the cylinder head.
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors (1) from the
fuel injectors.
6. Remove the fuel line (2) from the fuel rail.
7. Remove the two fuel rail (4) bracket bolts (3) that
mount the fuel rail to the intake manifold.
(Tighten: Fuel rail bracket bolts to 11 N·m)
BESM040003
BESM040005
Installation Notes:
• Coat the surface of the O-ring seals with clean engine oil before installing the fuel injector. Be careful not to
damage the O-ring seals when inserting the fuel injector into the fuel distribution tube.
1. Release the fuel system pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Disconnect four fuel injector electrical connectors
(1).
04
LTSM020173
4. Remove the fuel pressure regulator (See Fuel Pressure Regulator Removal & Installation in Section 04 Fuel
Delivery).
5. Remove the two fuel rail mounting bolts.
(Tighten: Fuel rail mounting bolts to 12 N·m)
6. Remove the fuel rail with the four fuel injectors.
7. Remove the clamp holding the fuel injector to the fuel rail.
8. Remove the fuel injector from the fuel rail.
LTSM040005
Installation Notes:
• Install new seals on the fuel injector sealing surfaces.
SPECIFICATION TEMPERATURE
11 - 13 ⍀ 20 °C
LTSM040007
The fuel pressure regulator is connected to the fuel rail. The fuel pressure regulator has a vacuum connection to it.
The fuel pressure regulator is used to regulate the fuel pressure in the fuel system.
NOTE :
The 2.4L is the ONLY engine that uses an external fuel pressure regulator.
Operation
The fuel pressure regulator is designed to keep the fuel pressure in the fuel system at a constant pressure. It does
this with a spring-loaded diaphragm that controls a valve. The valve, when opened by excessive pressure in the fuel
lines, uncovers a fuel line that returns excess fuel to the fuel tank. The vacuum connection is there to help reduce
emissions during deceleration. During deceleration, the vacuum connection serves to open the fuel return valve
wider, which reduces pressure in the system and prevents excess hydrocarbon emissions due to less fuel being
injected as a result of the lower pressure in the system.
1. Release the fuel system pressure (See Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Section 04 Fuel Delivery).
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Disconnect the fuel return pipe (2).
4. Remove the fuel pressure regulator mounting bolts
(1).
(Tighten: Fuel pressure regulator mounting bolts to
9 N·m) 04
LTSM040006
Installation Notes:
• Install new seals on the fuel pressure regulator sealing surfaces.
• Coat the surface of the fuel pressure regulator O-ring seal with clean engine oil before assembly.
• While installing the fuel pressure regulator, ensure that the fuel pressure regulator rotates smoothly in the fuel
distribution tube. If it does not rotate smoothly, the O-ring seal may have been damaged. Remove the fuel
pressure regulator and inspect the O-ring seal for damage.
SPECIFICATION PRESSURE
Idle 350 kPa
2500 RPM 350 kPa
STARTING SYSTEM
GENERAL INFORMATION 05-2 Positive Battery Cable 05-7 05
Description 05-2 Removal & Installation 05-7
Operation 05-3 Negative Battery Cable 05-8
Specifications 05-3 Removal & Installation 05-8
Special Tools 05-3
Electrical Schematics 05-4 Battery Hold Down 05-8
Removal & Installation 05-8
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING 05-6 Battery Tray 05-8
Starter Motor Bench Test 05-6 Removal & Installation 05-8
Starter Solenoid Test 05-6
Starter Motor 05-8
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 05-7 Description 05-8
Operation 05-9
Battery 05-7 Removal & Installation - 1.6L & 1.8L &
Description 05-7 2.0L 05-9
Operation 05-7 Removal & Installation - 2.4L 05-9
Removal & Installation 05-7
LTSM050007T
2.4L
LTSM050006T
The starting system consists of the following components:
• Starter motor (including an integral starter solenoid)
• Battery
• Battery cables
• Ignition switch and key lock cylinder
• Wire harnesses and connections
• Starter relay and fuse
• Charge fuse
Operation
The battery, starting, and charging systems operate in conjunction with one another, and must be tested as a com-
plete system. For correct operation of starting/charging systems, all components used in these 3 systems must per-
form within specifications. When attempting to diagnose any of these systems, it is important that you keep their
interdependency in mind. These components form two separate circuits, a high amperage circuit that feeds the
starter motor up to 150 amps, and a control circuit that operates on less than 20 amps.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Electrical Schematics
Starting System (Page 1 of 2)
LTSMW050001T
05
LTSMW050003T
Operation
The battery is designed to store electrical energy in a chemical form. When an electrical load is applied to the ter- 05
minals of the battery, an electrochemical reaction occurs. This reaction causes the battery to discharge electrical
current from its terminals. As the battery discharges, a gradual chemical change takes place within each cell. The
sulfuric acid in the electrolyte combines with the plate materials, causing both plates to slowly change to lead sulfate.
At the same time, oxygen from the positive plate material combines with hydrogen from the sulfuric acid, causing the
electrolyte to become mainly water. The chemical changes within the battery are caused by the movement of excess
or free electrons between the positive and negative plate groups. This movement of electrons produces a flow of
electrical current through the load device attached to the battery terminals.
LTSM050001
LTSM050001
Battery Tray
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the positive battery cable.
3. Remove the battery hold down.
4. Remove the battery.
5. Remove the three bolts (1) from the battery tray.
6. Lift the battery tray out of the engine compartment
and remove from the vehicle.
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM050002
Starter Motor
Description
The starter motor is mounted with two bolts to the transaxle housing and is located on the side of the engine. The
starter motor incorporates several features to create a reliable, efficient, compact, lightweight and powerful unit. The
electric motor of the starter features electromagnetic field coils wound around pole shoes, and brushes contact the
motor commutator. The starter motor is serviced only as a unit and cannot be repaired.
Operation
The starter motor is equipped with a planetary gear reduction system. The planetary gear reduction system consists
of a gear that is integral to the output end of the electric motor armature shaft that is in continual engagement with
a larger gear that is splined to the input end of the starter pinion gear shaft. This feature makes it possible to reduce
the dimensions of the starter. At the same time, it allows higher armature rotational speed and delivers increased
torque through the starter pinion gear to the starter ring gear.
NOTE :
After removing the engine oil dipstick, you should immediately plug the hole in the cylinder block in order to prevent
any debris from entering the engine. 05
5. Remove the starter solenoid nut (1) from the
starter.
(Tighten: Starter solenoid nut to 10 N·m)
6. Remove the two starter mounting bolts connecting
the starter and transaxle.
(Tighten: Starter mounting bolts to 30 N·m)
7. Remove the starter from the engine.
8. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
BESM050004
LTSM050005
05
LTSM050009T
2.4L
LTSM050008T
The generator is belt-driven by the engine. It is serviced only as a complete assembly. If the generator fails for any
reason, the entire assembly must be replaced. The generator produces DC voltage.
Operation
As the energized rotor begins to rotate within the generator, the spinning magnetic field induces a current into the
windings of the stator coil.
The Y-type stator winding connections deliver the induced AC current to 3 positive and 3 negative diodes for recti-
fication. From the diodes, rectified DC current is delivered to the vehicle’s electrical system through the generator,
battery, and ground terminals.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Electrical Schematics
Charging System (Page 1 of 2)
05
LTSMW050002T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 05–13
GENERAL INFORMATION
LTSMW050004T
05
BESM050002
BESM050003
LTSM050003
LTSM050004
Generator Inspection
1. Start the engine.
NOTE: If the battery warning lamp lights, there may be a problem with the charging system.
2. With the engine running, check the output voltage of the generator with a digital multimeter (note the voltage).
SPECIFICATION ACTION
< 14.4 ± 0.3 V Repair or Replace Generator
> 14.4 ± 0.3 V Generator is Good
COOLING SYSTEM
GENERAL INFORMATION 06-2 Removal & Installation - 2.4L 06-13
Description 06-2 Thermostat Inspection 06-14
Operation 06-4 Coolant Pump 06-14
Specifications 06-5 Removal & Installation - 1.6L & 1.8L &
Special Tools 06-5 2.0L 06-14 06
Electrical Schematics 06-6 Removal & Installation - 2.4L 06-15
Coolant Pump Inspection 06-15
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING 06-11
Cooling System Pressure Test 06-11 Radiator 06-16
Cooling System Concentration Test 06-11 Description 06-16
Operation 06-16
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 06-12 Removal & Installation 06-16
LTSM060006
06
LTSM060007
The cooling system regulates engine operating temperature. It allows the engine to reach normal operating temper-
ature as quickly as possible, maintains normal operating temperature and prevents overheating.
The cooling system also provides a means of heating the passenger compartment. The cooling system is pressurized
and uses a centrifugal water pump to circulate coolant throughout the system.
The cooling system consists of the following components:
• Radiator
• Coolant
• Coolant pump
• Electric cooling fans
• Electric cooling fans control module
• Thermostat
• Coolant reservoir
• Hoses and clamps
• Coolant temperature sensor
• Coolant temperature sensor (for instrument cluster) (with 2.4L engine)
• Heater core
Operation
Engine Coolant Flow Diagram - 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L
LTSM060005
The primary purpose of a cooling system is to maintain engine temperature in a range that will provide satisfactory
engine performance and emission levels under all expected driving conditions. It also provides hot coolant for heater
performance and cooling for automatic transmission oil. It does this by transferring heat from engine metal to coolant,
moving this heated coolant to the radiator, and then transferring this heat to the ambient air.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Fluid Specifications
06
Special Tools
Electrical Schematics
Cooling System (Page 1 of 5)
LTSMW060001T
06
LTSMW060002T
LTSMW060003T
06
LTSMW060004T
LTSMW060005T
CAUTION:
Do not pressurize the cooling system beyond the maximum pressure listed in the specifications
table in this section, or cooling system components can be damaged.
1. Turn the engine off.
2. Check the engine coolant level. Adjust the coolant level as necessary.
3. Attach the pressure tester to the coolant recovery reservoir. Install a pressure test pump to the quick-connect
fitting of the test adapter.
06
4. Pressurize the engine cooling system to 111 kPa. Observe the gauge reading for approximately 2 minutes. Pres-
sure should not drop during this time. If the pressure drops within this time, inspect for leaks and repair as nec-
essary.
5. If no leaks are found and the pressure drops, the pressure relief cap may be leaking. Install a new pressure
relief cap and retest the system.
6. If no leaks are found after a new pressure relief cap is installed, and the pressure drops, the leak may be inter-
nal to the radiator transmission cooler (if equipped). Inspect the coolant for transmission fluid and the transmis-
sion fluid for coolant. Repair as necessary.
7. If there is no contamination of the coolant or transmission fluid, the leak may be internal to the engine. Inspect
the coolant for engine oil and the engine oil for coolant.
8. Release the system pressure by loosening the pressure relief cap. Check the coolant level and adjust as nec-
essary.
LTSM060015
Thermostat
Description
A pellet-type thermostat controls the operating temperature of the engine by controlling the amount of coolant flow to
the radiator. On all engines the thermostat is closed below 90 °C. Above this temperature, coolant is allowed to flow
to the radiator. This provides quick engine warm up and overall temperature control.
Operation
The wax pellet is located in a sealed container at the spring end of the thermostat. When heated, the pellet expands,
overcoming closing spring tension and water pump pressure to force the valve to open.
LTSM060001
Installation Notes:
• Install a new thermostat gasket during installation.
• Verify the cooling system is filled to proper specifications.
1. Drain the cooling system (See Cooling System Draining Procedure in Section 06 Cooling System).
Installation Notes:
• Install a new thermostat gasket during installation.
• Verify the cooling system is filled to proper
specifications.
LTSM060009
Thermostat Inspection
1. Inspect the sealing surface of the thermostat valve
(the valve seat should be tight at room tempera-
ture).
2. Inspect the opening temperature and maximum
stroke of the valve.
• Opening temperature of the valve is 87 ± 2 °C
• Maximum stroke of the valve is 8 mm
• Full opening temperature of the valve is 104 °C
3. Verify the valve closes 5 ° lower than the opening
temperature.
4. If the thermostat fails any of the inspection steps,
replace the thermostat.
• Replace the thermostat in the reverse order of
removal. LTSM060014
• Replace the thermostat gasket.
Coolant Pump
Removal & Installation - 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L
WARNING!
Always allow the engine to cool before opening the cooling system. Do not remove the coolant pressure relief
cap when the engine is operating or the cooling system is hot. The cooling system is under pressure; steam and
hot liquid can come out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in serious personal injury.
1. Drain the cooling system (See Cooling System Draining Procedure in Section 06 Cooling System).
2. Remove the timing belt (See Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the coolant pump mounting bolts (1).
(Tighten: Coolant pump mounting bolts to 15 N·m)
BESM060001
Installation Notes:
• Install a new coolant pump gasket during installa-
tion.
• Verify the cooling system is filled to proper
specifications.
BESM060002
1. Drain the cooling system (See Cooling System Draining Procedure in Section 06 Cooling System).
2. Remove the accessory drive belt (See Accessory Drive Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
3. Remove the engine timing belt (See Engine Timing Belt Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
4. Remove the upper balance shaft timing belt (See Upper Balance Shaft Timing Belt Removal & Installation in
Section 02 Engine).
5. Remove the coolant pump mounting bolts (1).
(Tighten: Coolant pump mounting bolts to 14 N·m)
LTSM060003
Installation Notes:
• Install a new coolant pump gasket during installation.
• Verify the cooling system is filled to proper specifications.
Radiator
Description
The radiator is a cross-flow type (horizontal tubes) with design features that provide greater strength, as well as
sufficient heat transfer capabilities to keep the engine coolant within operating temperatures.
Operation
The radiator functions as a heat exchanger, using air flow across the exterior of the radiator tubes. Heat from the
coolant is then transferred from the radiator into the moving air.
LTSM060016
Installation Notes:
• Verify the cooling system is filled to proper
specifications.
LTSM060004
Cooling Fan
Description
The radiator cooling fans are dual-speed electric motor driven fans. The radiator fan assembly includes two electric
motors, two five-blade fans, and a support shroud that is attached to the radiator. The radiator fans are serviced as 06
an assembly.
Operation
The radiator cooling fan operation is controlled by the Engine Control Module (ECM) and the fan relays, with inputs
from the following:
• Engine coolant temperature
• Automatic transaxle fluid temperature (with DP0 transaxle)
• A/C signal
Inspect the cooling fan for proper low speed and high speed operation:
• The low speed fan should be switched on at 98 °C and switched off at 94 °C.
• The high speed fan should be switched on at 105 °C and switched off at 101 °C.
• If the water temperature is greater than 101 °C after the fan is switched off, the fan will continue to operate for
1 minute.
• If the water temperature is greater than 94 °C after the fan is switched off, the fan will continue to operate for
0.5 minute.
• If the water temperature is less than 85 °C after the fan is switched off, the fan will stop operating.
LTSM060008
Installation Notes:
• Verify the cooling system is filled to proper specifications.
MEASURING
OPERATION INSPECTION DIAGRAM
CONDITION
MEASURING
OPERATION INSPECTION DIAGRAM
CONDITION
06
EXHAUST SYSTEM
GENERAL INFORMATION 07-2 Removal & Installation - 1.6L & 1.8L &
Description 07-2 2.0L 07-5
Operation 07-3 Removal & Installation - 2.4L 07-5
Specifications 07-3 Muffler 07-6
Removal & Installation 07-6
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING 07-4
Exhaust System Diagnostic Chart 07-4 Catalytic Converter 07-6
Description 07-6 07
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 07-5 Operation 07-6
Removal & Installation 07-7
Exhaust Pipe Assembly 07-5
LTSM070003
LTSM070004
The exhaust system provides an exit for exhaust gases and reduces engine noise by moving exhaust gases through
the three-way catalytic converter, a muffler inlet pipe and a muffler. Rubber exhaust hanger insulators attach the
exhaust system to the mounting hooks.
The exhaust system contains the following components:
• Catalytic converter assembly
• Muffler assembly
• Exhaust brackets with isolators bolted to the body
• Heated oxygen sensors mounted to the exhaust pipes
• Tailpipe assembly
WARNING!
Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide which can be harmful to your health and are potentially lethal. Exhaust
system leaks should be repaired immediately. Never operate the engine in enclosed areas. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury or death.
Operation
In order to reduce vehicle emissions released by the engine, the catalytic converter is required to perform in all oper-
ating conditions. This reduction is especially beneficial during the cold start and warm up phases of operation, which
is when a majority of the tailpipe emissions occur on today’s vehicles because the catalytic converter has not yet
reached its operating temperature. The exhaust system channels exhaust gases from the engine and away from the
vehicle.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
07
LTSM070005
LTSM020189
Muffler
Removal & Installation
WARNING!
The normal operating temperature of the exhaust system is very high. Therefore, never work around, or attempt
to service any part of the exhaust system until it has cooled. Special care should be taken when working near
the catalytic converter. The temperature of the converter rises to a high level after a short period of engine oper-
ating time.
LTSM070002
Catalytic Converter
Description
The catalytic converter is attached to the exhaust manifold using fasteners and a gasket for sealing.
The catalytic converter plays a major role in the emission control system. The catalytic converter operates as a gas
reactor. Its catalytic function is to speed the heat-producing chemical reaction of components in the exhaust gases in
order to reduce air pollutants.
Operation
Catalyst operation is dependent on its ability to store and release the oxygen needed to complete the emissions-
reducing chemical reactions. As a catalyst deteriorates, its ability to store oxygen is reduced. Since the catalyst’s
ability to store oxygen is somewhat related to proper operation, oxygen storage can be used as an indicator of cat-
alyst performance.
CAUTION:
Unleaded gasoline must be used in order to avoid damaging the catalyst core.
08
LTSM080152
The DP0 automatic transaxle is a four-speed transaxle that is a conventional hydraulic/mechanical transaxle assem-
bly with an integral differential, and is controlled with adaptive electronic controls and monitors. The hydraulic system
of the transaxle consists of the transaxle fluid, fluid passages, hydraulic valves, fluid pump, and various line pressure
control components.
The Transaxle Control Module (TCM) is the heart of the electronic control system and relies on information from
various direct and indirect inputs (sensors, switches, etc.) to determine driver demand and vehicle operating condi-
tions. With this information, the ECM/TCM can calculate and perform timely and quality shifts through various output
or control devices.
The TCM also performs certain self-diagnostic functions and provides comprehensive information (sensor data,
DTCs, etc.) which is helpful in proper diagnosis and repair. This information can be viewed with the X-431 scan tool.
Interior View
BESM080056
Operation
08
LTSM080154T
Automatic transaxle control is divided into the electronic and hydraulic transaxle control functions. While the elec-
tronic transaxle control is responsible for gear selection and for matching the pressures to the torque to be trans-
mitted, the transaxle’s power supply control occurs via hydraulic elements in the electro-hydraulic control module. The
fluid supply to the hydraulic elements, such as the torque converter, the shift elements and the hydraulic transaxle
control, is provided by way of a fluid pump connected to the torque converter.
The Transaxle Control Module (TCM) allows for the precise adaptation of pressures to the corresponding operating
conditions and to the engine output during the gearshift phase, resulting in a noticeable improvement in shift quality.
The engine speed limit can be reached in the individual gears at full throttle and kickdown. The shift range can be
changed in the forward gears while driving, but the TCM employs a downshift safeguard to prevent engine over
speed. The system offers the additional advantage of flexible adaptation to different vehicle and engine variants.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Lubrication Specifications
DESCRIPTION ITEM
Transaxle Fluid Quantity 6.0L
Transaxle Fluid Change Quantity 3.0L
Fluid Type DEXTRON III
Fluid Change Cycle 40000 Km
Special Tools
Spline Spanner
CH-30001
08
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Electrical Schematics
Automatic Transaxle (Page 1 of 8)
08
LTSMW080033T
LTSMW080034T
08
LTSMW080035T
LTSMW080040T
08
LTSMW080036T
LTSMW080037T
08
LTSMW080038T
LTSMW080039T
Ground Inspection
Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits. Ground connec-
tions are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The corrosion (rust) can become an unwanted
resistance. This added resistance can alter the way a circuit works.
Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground can drastically 08
affect an electronically controlled circuit. A poor or corroded ground can effect the circuit. Perform the following when
inspecting a ground connection:
1. Remove the ground bolt or screw.
2. Inspect all mating surface for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
3. Clean as required to assure good contact.
4. Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
5. Inspect for ⬙add-on⬙ accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
6. If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure all of the wires
are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are crimped to one eyelet, make
sure no excess wire insulation has been crimped creating a bad ground.
Diagnostic Tools
1. Diagnostic Scan Tool X-431
2. Digital Multimeter
3. Jumper Wire
NOTE :
Using the TCM electrical harness test tool will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
1 + EVS 29 -
Flow Control Solenoid
2 30 -
Valve (+)
3 - 31 Shift 2
4 - 32 Shift 3
5 - 33 Shift 4
6 - 34 P/N Switch
7 Shift Solenoid Valve 3 35 -
8 Shift Solenoid Valve 4 36 Sequential (-)
9 Shift Solenoid Valve 2 37 Sequential (+)
10 Shift Solenoid Valve 1 38 CAN-H
11 Shift Lock 39 CAN-L
12 Fluid Cooler Flow Control 40 Winter Mode
13 Shift Solenoid Valve 5 41 -
14 Shift Solenoid Valve 6 42 MFS Switch
15 - 43 Brake Switch
16 Brake Switch 44 -
17 - 45 Turbine Shaft (+)
18 - 46 Turbine Shaft (-)
19 CDE EVM PTG 47 Secondary Shaft (-)
Torque Converter Lock
20 Solenoid Valve (CDE EVM 48 Secondary Shaft (+)
PRSN)
21 - 49 -
22 - 50 -
23 - 51 -
24 Regulated Sensor Supply 52 -
Fluid Temperature Sensor
25 Sensor (GND) 53
(-)
Pressure Adjust Solenoid Fluid Temperature Sensor
26 54
Valve (+EVM) (+)
27 Ignition Switch 55 Fluid Pressure Sensor
28 GND 56 BATT
08
LTSMW080015T
LTSMW080018T
NOTE :
• If DTCs P0840 and P0710 are present, diagnose and repair them before continuing with this test.
• Using the appropriate diagnostic test tool, you can diagnose the TCM harness while the TCM is still connected.
This will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK A/T FLUID PRESSURE SENSOR AND TRANSAXLE FLUID TEMPERATURE (TFT) SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
LTSMD080023
Turn the ignition switch on.
Using a digital multimeter, check the A/T fluid pressure sensor voltage supply circuit for 5 V between connector
E-037, terminal C1 and ground.
Using a digital multimeter, check the Transaxle Fluid Temperature (TFT) sensor voltage supply circuit for 5 V between
connector E-037, terminal B1 and ground.
LTSMD080024
2. CHECK A/T FLUID PRESSURE SENSOR AND TFT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT
Disconnect the Transaxle Control Module (TCM) electrical connector E-036 (1).
08
LTSMD080074
DISPLAY
ITEM CONDITION
VALUE
• Ignition switch:
ON
Below 0.2 bar
• Engine: Not
running
Fluid Pressure
• Engine: Idle
Approximately
• TFT: 31 °C
0.05 bar
• ECT: 30 °C
5. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080022T
NOTE :
Using the appropriate diagnostic test tool, you can diagnose the TCM harness while the TCM is still connected. This
will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the gear position while driving, and compare it to the table.
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
#: Operating component
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. ACTUATE TEST
LTSMD080023
LTSMD080026
4. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080022T
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the gear position while driving, and compare it to the table.
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
#: Operating component
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. ACTUATE TEST
08
LTSMD080026
A/T A/T
ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY TEMPERATURE CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
B3 B2 23 °C Yes
5. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080025T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 08–37
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
NOTE :
• If using the appropriate diagnostic test tool, you can diagnose the TCM harness while the TCM is still connected.
Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
• Using the appropriate diagnostic test tool in this way will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
Diagnostic Procedure
Is DTC P0705 present and the status active for this DTC?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
BESM080061
Do the circuits check OK, and do the reverse lamps also illuminate?
Yes >> • The transaxle range switch is normal.
• Reassemble the vehicle and road test to verify the customers complaint is repaired.
No >> • Go to the next step.
LTSMW080018T
Diagnostic Procedure
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR TERMINAL VOLTAGE
TERMINAL
B1 Ground 5V
5 V should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
08
No >> • Repair or replace the open circuit or short to power or short to ground in harness or connectors.
• If circuit is normal, replace TCM.
4. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080017T
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of turbine speed sensor while driving.
Is the check result normal and DTC not present?
Yes >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
No >> • Go to the next step.
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR GROUND VOLTAGE
TERMINAL
D1
Ground 2V
D2
2 V should exist.
Is 2 V present at each electrical connector pin?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the open circuit or short to power or short to ground in harness or connectors.
• If circuit is normal, replace the TCM.
Check the resistance of the turbine speed sensor between the turbine speed sensor electrical connector pin D1 and
D2.
TERMINAL RESISTANCE 23 °C
D1 - D2 260 - 340 ⍀
4. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080016T
公 Operating components
DTC
DTC DTC SET
DTC NO. DETECTION POSSIBLE CAUSE
DEFINITION CONDITION
CONDITION
• Input shaft speed sensor
The Transaxle
• Output shaft speed sensor
Control Module
• The retainer of deceleration clutch
(TCM) detects
• Transfer case driven and drive
that a Gear
gear
Ratio Error is
Ratio of • 2, 3, 4 gear clutch (E2)
P0730 Vehicle is driving already present.
transaxle error • Reverse and 1 - 3 gear clutch
The DTC is set
(E1)
if the fault
• 4 gear brake (F1)
happened within
• Reverse gear brake (F2)
seconds of a
• 1, 2 gear brake (F3)
shift.
• Noise interference
NOTE :
Checking the automatic transaxle fluid quality and fluid level is the most basic check of the automatic transaxle. The
fluid check is also an important inspection to determine if the transaxle will need to be disassembled.
CAUTION:
The burnt scent of ATF fluid indicates that the transaxle fluid is contaminated. The tiny particles in
the fluid pan indicate that the transaxle is worn and it will be necessary to overhaul the transaxle.
Diagnostic Procedure
Drive the vehicle until the TFT reaches working temperature (70 - 80 °C).
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shift the gear selector lever to all gear positions once, stay in one gear about 5 seconds, then shift to gear “N”.
Clean and check the outside of dipstick and remove the dipstick to check the fluid level.
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
LEVER EVS
POSITION EVS1 EVS2 EVS3 EVS4 EVS5 EVS6
Not Not Not Not Not Not
R
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not
N/P Active
active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
1 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not
2 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not Not
3
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
4 Active Active
active active active active
Is the check result not normal and DTC P0730, DTC P0715 or DTC P0720 present?
Yes >> • If DTC P0715 is present, see DTC P0715 diagnostic procedure.
• If DTC P0720 is present, see DTC P0720 diagnostic procedure.
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. HYDRAULIC TEST
LTSMD080021
In accordance with the shown status of standard fluid pressure measurement table, measure the fluid pressure of
measurement port. The measurement of port should be within the standard range.
If some measurement values is beyond the standard range, please refer to the fluid pressure measurement and
diagnosis table for causes.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5 for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check low speed clutch system: Low speed clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when compressed
air is applied to the fluid hole.
Check reverse/low brake clutch system: Low speed clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when com-
pressed air is applied to the fluid hole.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Replace the damaged components as needed.
7. CHECK DTC
P0753 - Shift Solenoid Valve 1 (SSV1) Open Circuit Or Short To Power Supply Or
Short To Ground
LTSMW080022T
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
• Shift Solenoid Valve 1
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV1)
Valve 1 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P0753 (SSV1) short the TCM detected an improper sensor circuit short to power
driving
to power voltage drop when it tries to supply)
supply operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
• Shift Solenoid Valve 1
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV1)
Valve 1 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P0753 (SSV1) open the TCM detects an improper sensor circuit is open or
driving
or short to voltage drop when it tries to shorted)
ground circuit operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
NOTE :
• If using the appropriate diagnostic test tool, you can diagnose the TCM harness while the TCM is still connected.
• Using the appropriate diagnostic test tool in this way will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
2. ACTUATE TEST
LTSMD080028
Or using the appropriate diagnostic test tool and a digital multimeter perform the following:
• Check the EVS1 solenoid supply voltage between TCM pin 1 and TCM pin 10 when activating the EVS1 sole-
noid and deactivating the EVS1 solenoid.
Check the shift solenoid control signal. Check the voltage of the shift solenoid in each shift position.
Check the voltage of the EVS1 solenoid supply circuit between the transaxle assembly electrical connector pin B3
and pin B11.
B11 10 Yes
6. CHECK DTC
P0758 - Shift Solenoid Valve 2 (SSV2) Open Circuit Or Short To Power Supply Or
Short To Ground
EVS
LTSMW080022T
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
• Shift Solenoid Valve 2
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV2)
Valve 2 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P0758 (SSV2) short the TCM detected an improper sensor circuit short to power
driving
to power voltage drop when it tries to supply)
supply operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
• Shift Solenoid Valve 2
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV2)
Valve 2 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P0758 (SSV2) open the TCM detected an improper sensor circuit is open or
driving
or short to voltage drop when it tries to shorted)
ground circuit operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
NOTE :
• If using the appropriate diagnostic test tool, you can diagnose the TCM harness while the TCM is still connected.
• Using the appropriate diagnostic test tool in this way will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 REFERENCE VALUE
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
2. ACTUATE TEST
NUMBER SOLENOID
1 Shift Solenoid Valve 1
2 Shift Solenoid Valve 2
3 Shift Solenoid Valve 3
4 Shift Solenoid Valve 4
5 Shift Solenoid Valve 5
6 Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Pressure adjust solenoid
7
valve
Torque converter lock
8
solenoid valve
9 Manual valve
10 Valve body
LTSMD080033
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR
GROUND VOLTAGE
E-037
TERMINAL
B8 9 Yes
6. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080022T
NOTE :
• If using the appropriate diagnostic test tool, you can diagnose the TCM harness while the TCM is still connected.
• Using the appropriate diagnostic test tool in this way will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
LEVER EVS
POSITION EVS1 EVS2 EVS3 EVS4 EVS5 EVS6
Not Not Not Not Not Not
R
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not
N/P Active
active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
1 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not
2 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not Not
3
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
4 Active Active
active active active active
2. ACTUATE TEST
NUMBER SOLENOID
1 Shift Solenoid Valve 1
2 Shift Solenoid Valve 2
3 Shift Solenoid Valve 3
4 Shift Solenoid Valve 4
5 Shift Solenoid Valve 5
6 Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Pressure adjust solenoid
7
valve
Torque converter lock
8
solenoid valve
9 Manual valve
10 Valve body
A/T ASSEMBLY 08
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
TERMINAL
VALVE 1 (SSV1) B11 - B3
VALVE 2 (SSV2) B8 - B3
VALVE 3 (SSV3) B10 - B3
VALVE 4 (SSV4) B7 - B3
VALVE 5 (SSV5) B5 - B3
VALVE 6 (SSV6) B2 - B3
RESISTANCE (23 °C) 38 - 42 (⍀)
LTSMD080041
Or using the appropriate diagnostic test tool and a digital multimeter perform the following:
• Check the EVS3 solenoid supply voltage between TCM pin 1 and TCM pin 7 when activating the EVS3 sole-
noid and deactivating the EVS3 solenoid.
Check the shift solenoid control signal. Check the voltage of the shift solenoid in each shift position.
Check the voltage of the EVS3 solenoid supply circuit between the transaxle assembly electrical connector pin B3
and pin B10.
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR
GROUND VOLTAGE
E-037
TERMINAL
B10 7 Yes
6. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080022T
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
• Shift Solenoid Valve 4
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV4)
Valve 4 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P0768 (SSV4) short the TCM detected an improper sensor circuit short to power
driving
to power voltage drop when it tries to supply)
supply operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
• Shift Solenoid Valve 4
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV4)
Valve 4 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P0768 (SSV4) open the TCM detected an improper sensor circuit is open or
driving
or short to voltage drop when it tries to shorted)
ground circuit operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
LEVER EVS
POSITION EVS1 EVS2 EVS3 EVS4 EVS5 EVS6
Not Not Not Not Not Not
R
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not
N/P Active
active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
1 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not
2 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not Not
3
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
4 Active Active
active active active active
2. ACTUATE TEST
NUMBER SOLENOID
1 Shift Solenoid Valve 1
2 Shift Solenoid Valve 2
3 Shift Solenoid Valve 3
4 Shift Solenoid Valve 4
5 Shift Solenoid Valve 5
6 Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Pressure adjust solenoid
7
valve
Torque converter lock
8
solenoid valve
9 Manual valve
10 Valve body
A/T ASSEMBLY 08
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
TERMINAL
VALVE 1 (SSV1) B11 - B3
VALVE 2 (SSV2) B8 - B3
VALVE 3 (SSV3) B10 - B3
VALVE 4 (SSV4) B7 - B3
VALVE 5 (SSV5) B5 - B3
VALVE 6 (SSV6) B2 - B3
RESISTANCE (23 °C) 38 - 42 (⍀)
LTSMD080042
Or using the appropriate diagnostic test tool and a digital multimeter perform the following:
• Check the EVS4 solenoid supply voltage between TCM pin 1 and TCM pin 8 when activating the EVS4 sole-
noid and deactivating the EVS4 solenoid.
Check the shift solenoid control signal. Check the voltage of the shift solenoid in each shift position.
Check the voltage of the EVS4 solenoid supply circuit between the transaxle assembly electrical connector pin B3
and pin B7.
A/T Assembly
connector Voltage should
Ground
E-037 terminal not exist
B7
B7 8 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080022T
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
• Solenoid (SSV5)
Shift Solenoid
• Harness or connectors (The
Valve 5
sensor circuit short to power
P0773 (SSV5) short
supply)
to power The Transaxle Control Module • Transaxle Control Module
supply (TCM) will set this DTC when
Vehicle is (TCM)
the TCM detected an improper
driving
voltage drop when it tries to • Solenoid (SSV5)
Shift Solenoid
operate the solenoid valve. • Harness or connectors (The
Valve 5
sensor circuit is open or
P0773 (SSV5) open
shorted)
or short to
• Transaxle Control Module
ground circuit
(TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
LEVER EVS
POSITION EVS1 EVS2 EVS3 EVS4 EVS5 EVS6
Not Not Not Not Not Not
R
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not
N/P Active
active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
1 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not
2 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not Not
3
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
4 Active Active
active active active active 08
2. ACTUATE TEST
NUMBER SOLENOID
1 Shift Solenoid Valve 1
2 Shift Solenoid Valve 2
3 Shift Solenoid Valve 3
4 Shift Solenoid Valve 4
5 Shift Solenoid Valve 5
6 Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Pressure adjust solenoid
7
valve
Torque converter lock
8
solenoid valve
9 Manual valve
10 Valve body
A/T ASSEMBLY
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
TERMINAL
VALVE 1 (SSV1) B11 - B3
VALVE 2 (SSV2) B8 - B3
VALVE 3 (SSV3) B10 - B3
VALVE 4 (SSV4) B7 - B3
VALVE 5 (SSV5) B5 - B3
VALVE 6 (SSV6) B2 - B3
RESISTANCE (23 °C) 38 - 42 (⍀)
LTSMD080043
Or using the appropriate diagnostic test tool and a digital multimeter perform the following:
• Check the EVS5 solenoid supply voltage between TCM pin 1 and TCM pin 13 when activating the EVS5 sole-
noid and deactivating the EVS5 solenoid.
Check the shift solenoid control signal. Check the voltage of the shift solenoid in each shift position.
Check the voltage of the EVS5 solenoid supply circuit between the transaxle assembly electrical connector pin B3
and pin B5.
A/T assembly
connector Voltage should
Ground
E-037 terminal not exist
B5
B5 13 Yes
6. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080020T
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
The EVM is modulated by
• Modulation solenoid valve
controlling the duty cycle of
Modulation (EVM)
the Solenoid. The DTC is set
solenoid • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is after the TCM detects that the
P0775 valve (EVM) sensor circuit is open or
driving duty cycle of the control
short to shorted)
current is out of the
power supply • Transaxle Control Module
acceptable range for specified
(TCM)
seconds.
The EVM is modulated by
• Modulation solenoid valve
Modulation controlling the duty cycle of
(EVM)
solenoid the Solenoid. The DTC is set
• Harness or connectors (The
valve (EVM) Vehicle is after the TCM detects that the
P0775 sensor circuit is open or
open circuit driving duty cycle of the control
shorted)
or short to current is out of the
• Transaxle Control Module
ground acceptable range for specified
(TCM)
seconds.
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
LEVER EVS
POSITION EVS1 EVS2 EVS3 EVS4 EVS5 EVS6
Not Not Not Not Not Not
R
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not
N/P Active
active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
1 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not
2 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not Not
3
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
4 Active Active
active active active active 08
2. ACTUATE TEST
LTSMD080029
TEMPERATURE RESISTANCE
23 °C 36 - 44 ⍀
LTSMD080062
MODULATION FLUID
GROUND TIME (%) PRESSURE
(×100000 PA)
0 0
10 0.32
12 0.48
15 0.67
20 0.88
30 1.17
40 1.41
50 1.69
60 1.97
70 2.26
80 2.60
88 2.87
90 2.91
92 2.95
95 3
100 3
LTSMD080057
8. CHECK DTC
08
P0795 - Torque Converter Lock Solenoid Valve (EVLU) Open Circuit Or Short To
Ground
P0795 - Torque Converter Lock Solenoid Valve (EVLU) Short To Voltage
LTSMW080021T
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
Torque • Torque converter lock
converter lock The Transaxle Control Module solenoid valve (EVLU)
solenoid (TCM) detects that the torque • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P0795 valve (EVLU) converter lock solenoid valve sensor circuit is open or
driving
open circuit (EVLU) circuit shorted to shorted)
or short to ground or open. • Transaxle Control Module
ground (TCM)
• Torque converter lock
Torque
The Transaxle Control Module solenoid valve (EVLU)
converter lock
(TCM) detects that the torque • Harness or connectors (The
solenoid Vehicle is
P0795 converter lock solenoid valve sensor circuit is open or
valve (EVLU) driving
(EVLU) circuit is shorted to shorted)
short to
voltage. • Transaxle Control Module
voltage
(TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
LEVER EVS
POSITION EVS1 EVS2 EVS3 EVS4 EVS5 EVS6
Not Not Not Not Not Not
R
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not
N/P Active
active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
1 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not
2 Active Active
active active active active
Not Not Not Not Not Not
3
active active active active active active
Not Not Not Not
4 Active Active
active active active active
2. ACTUATE TEST
LTSMD080029
Temperature Resistance
23 °C 38 - 42 ⍀
LTSMD080064
TORQUE
CONVERTER TCM
LOCK CONNECTOR
CONTINUITY
SOLENOID E-036
VALVE TERMINAL
TERMINAL
B9 20 Yes
8.
With the scan tool X-431, drive the vehicle, monitor the EVLU valve condition.
Drive the vehicle until it is fully warmed up to at least 50 ˚C. Perform the following step 3 times:
• Drive the vehicle at 80 km/h (50 mph) and allow 4th gear to engage for at least 10 seconds.
• Close the throttle, then tip back in until the throttle angle is between 20 and 30 degrees.
NOTE :
If you go over 30 degrees, you must release the throttle and retry.
Does the TCC engage during any of the attempts?
Yes >> • The system is normal.
• Reassemble the vehicle and road test to verify the customers complaint is repaired.
No >> • Replace the torque converter lock solenoid valve for a mechanical problem.
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080015T
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start vehicle and monitor the value of ⬙INPUT SPEED SENSOR⬙.
X-431 REFERENCE VALUE
DISPLAY
ITEM CONDITION
VALUE
Ignition switch
Below 0.2 bar
on, not running
Fluid Pressure
• Engine: Idle
Approximately
• TFT: 31 °C
0.05 bar
• ECT: 30 °C
08
LTSMD080054
TCM
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
C3 25 Yes
Check fluid pressure sensor resistance between sensor terminal C2 and C3 in A/T assembly connector E-037.
Approximately 20 K⍀ should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace the fluid pressure sensor.
7. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080013T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 08–105
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
The Transaxle Control Module • Shift lock solenoid valve
Shift lock
Ignition on or (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
solenoid
P1928 vehicle is the TCM detects that the shift sensor circuit is shorted)
circuit short to
driving lever lock solenoid circuit • Transaxle Control Module
power supply
shorted to power supply. (TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 REFERENCE VALUE
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
#: Operating solenoid 08
Is the check result normal and DTC not present?
Yes >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. ACTUATE TEST
Temperature Resistance
23 °C 36 - 44 ⍀
LTSMD080051
Terminal Pins 4 - 5
SHIFT LOCK
TCM
SOLENOID
CONNECTOR
VALVE CONTINUITY
E-036
CONNECTOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
5 11 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080013T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 08–111
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
Shift lock • Shift lock solenoid valve
The Transaxle Control Module
solenoid • Harness or connectors (The
Ignition switch (TCM) will set this DTC when
valve open sensor circuit is open or
P1928 on or vehicle the TCM detects that the shift
circuit or shorted)
is driving lever lock solenoid circuit
short to • Transaxle Control Module
shorted to ground or open.
ground (TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 REFERENCE VALUE
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
#: Operating solenoid 08
Is the check result normal and DTC not present?
Yes >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. ACTUATE TEST
Temperature Resistance
23 °C 36 - 44 ⍀
LTSMD080051
Terminal Pins 4 - 5
SHIFT LOCK
TCM
SOLENOID
CONNECTOR
VALVE CONTINUITY
E-036
CONNECTOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
5 11 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080022T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 08–117
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
• Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV6)
Valve 6 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P2709 (SSV6) short the TCM detected an improper sensor circuit short to power
driving
to power voltage drop when it tries to supply)
supply operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
2. ACTUATE TEST
COMPONENTS POSITION
NUMBER SOLENOID
1 Shift Solenoid Valve 1
2 Shift Solenoid Valve 2
3 Shift Solenoid Valve 3
4 Shift Solenoid Valve 4
5 Shift Solenoid Valve 5
6 Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Pressure adjust solenoid
7
valve
Torque converter lock
8
solenoid valve
9 Manual valve
10 Valve body
A/T ASSEMBLY
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
TERMINAL
VALVE 1 (SSV1) B11 - B3
VALVE 2 (SSV2) B8 - B3
VALVE 3 (SSV3) B10 - B3
VALVE 4 (SSV4) B7 - B3
VALVE 5 (SSV5) B5 - B3
VALVE 6 (SSV6) B2 - B3
RESISTANCE (23 °C) 38 - 42 (⍀)
LTSMD080044
Or using the appropriate diagnostic test tool and a digital multimeter perform the following:
• Check the EVS6 solenoid supply voltage between TCM pin 1 and TCM pin 14 when activating the EVS6 sole-
noid and deactivating the EVS6 solenoid.
Check the shift solenoid control signal. Check the voltage of the shift solenoid in each shift position.
Check the voltage of the EVS6 solenoid supply circuit between the transaxle assembly electrical connector pin B3
and pin B2.
6. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080022T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 08–123
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES
DEFINITION
CONDITION
• Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Shift Solenoid The Transaxle Control Module (SSV6)
Valve 6 (TCM) will set this DTC when • Harness or connectors (The
Vehicle is
P2709 (SSV6) open the TCM detected an improper sensor circuit is open or
driving
or short to voltage drop when it tries to shorted)
ground circuit operate the solenoid valve. • Transaxle Control Module
(TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
08
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. ACTUATE TEST
COMPONENTS POSITION
NUMBER SOLENOID
1 Shift Solenoid Valve 1
2 Shift Solenoid Valve 2
3 Shift Solenoid Valve 3
4 Shift Solenoid Valve 4
5 Shift Solenoid Valve 5
6 Shift Solenoid Valve 6
Pressure adjust solenoid
7
valve
Torque converter lock
8
solenoid valve
9 Manual valve
10 Valve body
A/T ASSEMBLY
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE
TERMINAL
VALVE 1 (SSV1) B11 - B3
VALVE 2 (SSV2) B8 - B3
VALVE 3 (SSV3) B10 - B3
VALVE 4 (SSV4) B7 - B3
VALVE 5 (SSV5) B5 - B3
VALVE 6 (SSV6) B2 - B3
RESISTANCE (23 °C) 38 - 42 (⍀)
LTSMD080044
Or using the appropriate diagnostic test tool and a digital multimeter perform the following:
• Check the EVS6 solenoid supply voltage between TCM pin 1 and TCM pin 14 when activating the EVS6 sole-
noid and deactivating the EVS6 solenoid.
Check the shift solenoid control signal. Check the voltage of the shift solenoid in each shift position.
Check the voltage of the EVS6 solenoid supply circuit between the transaxle assembly electrical connector pin B3
and pin B2.
B2 14 Yes
6. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080014T
DTC
DTC
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
DEFINITION
CONDITION
Fluid cooler The Transaxle Control Module • Fluid cooler flow control
flow control (TCM) will set this DTC when solenoid valve (EPDE)
solenoid the TCM detected the EPDE • Harness or connectors (The
P2753
(EPDE) short solenoid circuit is short to sensor circuit is shorted)
to power power supply when the TFT is • Transaxle Control Module
supply Ignition switch more than 108 °C. (TCM)
Fluid cooler on or vehicle The Transaxle Control Module • Fluid cooler flow control
flow control is driving (TCM) will set this DTC when solenoid valve (EPDE)
solenoid the TCM detected the EPDE • Harness or connectors (The
P2753 (EPDE) open solenoid circuit is short to sensor circuit is open or
circuit or ground, or open when the TFT shorted)
short to is over 108°, and the engine • Transaxle Control Module
ground speed is above 2000 RPM. (TCM)
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
P 0 - - # -
R R - - - -
N 0 - - # -
1 - - # #
2 - # - #
D
3 - - - -
4 # # - -
#: Operating solenoid 08
Is the check result normal and DTC not present?
Yes >> • The condition that caused this DTC is intermittent (See Diagnostic Help in Section 08 Transaxle &
Transfer Case).
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. ACTUATE TEST
CHECK CONDITION
SOLENOID ACTUATE CONDITION SOLENOID CONDITION
Fluid Cooler Flow Control Solenoid TFT ≥ 100 °C
Open
Valve RPM ≥ 2000 rpm
LTSMD080022
Temperature Resistance
23 °C 36 - 44 ⍀
LTSMD080048
6. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080019T
NOTE :
08
• Ensure that the battery is fully charged.
• Before performing any DTC diagnostic procedures, verify the TCM power and ground circuits are properly con-
nected.
• Before performing the diagnostic procedure, repair all other TCM DTCs first.
Diagnostic Procedure
2. CHECK DTC
With the scan tool X-431, attempt to enter all the other CAN communication modules such as ECM, CAN converter
module.
Read the CAN DTCs.
Were other modules DTCs found?
Yes >> • If all of the other modules have the same DTC ⬙CAN Communication⬙, go to the next step.
• If all of the other modules have the DTC ⬙Lost communication with TCM⬙, and do not have the
⬙CAN Communication⬙, replace and program the TCM module.
No >> • Go to step 8.
38 39 123 ⍀
TCM ECM
CAN CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
CAN-H 38 62 Yes
TCM ECM
CAN CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
CAN-L 39 81 Yes
6 (CAN-H)
Ground
14 (CAN-L)
Inspect the TCM electrical connector pins for proper fit or any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
With the X-431 scan tool, read TCM DTCs.
Is the check result normal and DTC U0001 not present?
Yes >> • The system is now operating properly.
• Reassemble the vehicle and road test to verify the customers complaint is repaired.
No >> • Replace the TCM. 08
• The problem caused by TCM internal error.
BESM080038
BESM080057
LTSM080184
15. Remove the bolts attaching the transaxle cooling lines to the transaxle.
16. Remove the starter motor (See Starter Removal & Installation in Section 05 Starting & Charging).
17. Remove the bolts (1) attaching the drive plate to
the torque converter.
(Tighten: Drive plate bolts to 75 N·m)
BESM080058
08
BESM080036
BESM080035
27. Remove the rear engine mount bolts (1) and the
rear engine mount bracket bolt (2).
(Tighten: Rear mount bolts to 40 N·m)
LTSM020188
Installation Notes:
• Refill the transaxle fluid through the fill hole (1) shown in the figure.
• To avoid fluid spills, make sure to use a funnel.
• Add 3.5 L of new automatic transaxle fluid into
the transaxle.
• Start the engine and maintain an idle.
• Connect the X-431 scan tool and establish a
connection with the TCM and monitor the trans-
axle fluid temperature.
LTSM080183
• Open the drain plug (2) when the fluid temperature reaches 60 ± 1°. Loosen the fluid limiting duct (1) if neces-
sary.
LTSM080184
• Catch any fluid that drains out with a measuring cup.
• If no fluid drains out, or the drained fluid is less than 0.1 liter perform the following:
− 1. Turn off the ignition switch.
− 2. Add 0.5 liter fluid to the transaxle.
− 3. Allow the transaxle fluid to cool down to 50°C.
− 4. Start the engine and maintain an idle.
− 5. Open the drain plug when the fluid temperature reaches 60 ± 1°C.
− 6. Catch any fluid that drains out with a measuring cup.
− 7. Repeat the above steps, until the drained fluid exceeds 0.1 liter.
− 8. Tighten the drain plug to 33 N·m. 08
WARNING!
The gearshift lever must be shifted to gear P while adding transaxle fluid.
BESM080038
LTSM080186
BESM080049
8. Apply the parking brake (apply the parking brake handle to clear lower console during removal).
9. Remove the lower console (See Lower Console Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
10. Disconnect the gearshift mechanism connector (1).
11. Remove the shift cable from the gearshift mecha-
nism.
12. Remove the four bolts (2) and then remove the
gearshift mechanism from the bracket.
13. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM020228
NOTE :
If the battery has low voltage, press the release switch (1) to move the gearshift lever.
LTSM080188
LTSM150086
08
LTSM080169
08
LTSM080158
Operation
The transaxle control is divided into the electronic and hydraulic transaxle control functions. While the electronic
transaxle control is responsible for gear selection and for matching the pressures to the torque to be transmitted, the
transaxle’s power supply control occurs via hydraulic elements in the electro-hydraulic control module. The fluid sup-
ply to the hydraulic elements, such as the torque converter, the shift elements and the hydraulic transaxle control, is
provided by way of a fluid pump connected to the torque converter.
The Transaxle Control Module (TCM) allows for the precise adaptation of pressures to the corresponding operating
conditions and to the engine output during the gearshift phase, resulting in a noticeable improvement in shift quality.
The engine speed limit can be reached in the individual gears at full throttle and kickdown. The shift range can be
changed in the forward gears while driving, but the TCM employs a downshift safeguard to prevent engine over
speed. The system offers the additional advantage of flexible adaptation to different vehicle and engine variants.
LTSM080154T
08
LTSM080165T
Specifications
Related Operating Components
DRIVE LOCK
GEARSHIFT LOW
GEAR ENGINE PARKING LOW REVERSE GEAR/
LEVER OVERSPEED GEAR ONE-WAY
RATIO START MECHANISM SPEED GEAR REVERSE
POSITION CLUTCH BRAKE CLUTCH
CLUTCH CLUTCH GEAR
(OD) (2ND) (OWC)
(UD) (REV) BRAKE
(LR)
P Parking - Enabled X - - - X - -
Reverse
R 2.480 - - - X - X - -
Gear
Neutral
N - Enabled - - - - X - -
Gear
Gear 1 2.842 - - X - - X* - X
Gear 2 1.529 - - X - - - X -
D
Gear 3 1.000 - - X - X - - -
Gear 4 0.712 - - - - X - X -
Gear 1 2.842 - - X - - X* - X
3 Gear 2 1.529 - - X - - - X -
Gear 3 1.000 - - X - X - - -
Gear 1 2.842 - - X - - X* - X
2
Gear 2 1.529 - - X - - - X -
L Gear 1 2.842 - - X - - X - -
*Low gear/reverse gear is applied when vehicle speed is lower than 10 km/h. X Operating Components
Lubrication Specifications
DESCRIPTION ITEM
Transaxle Fluid Quantity 6.5 L
Fluid Type DEXTRON III
Fluid Change Cycle 40000 Km or 3 years
Special Tools
08
Spring Compressor
MB-991625
Clearance Measurer
MB-991631
Bearing Fixer
MB-998350
Guide Rod
MB-998412
Spring Compressor
MB-998907
08
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Electrical Schematics
Automatic Transaxle (Page 1 of 5)
LTSMW080030T
08
LTSMW080026T
LTSMW080027T
08
LTSMW080028T
LTSMW080029T
Diagnostic Tools
Diagnostic Scan Tool X-431
Read the following when connecting the X-431 scan tool:
• Connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC) for communication with the vehicle.
• The DLC is located on the driver side compartment under the steering column (it is attached to the instrument 08
panel and accessible from the driver seat).
• The DLC is rectangular in design and capable of accommodating up to 16 terminals.
• The electrical connector has keying features to allow easy connection.
NOTE :
Using the TCM electrical harness test tool will help prevent electrical connector terminal damage.
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
Low Speed
1 33 -
Electromagnetic Valve
2 Relay Supply 34 Data Link Connector
3 Relay Supply 35 -
4 To Instrument Cluster 36 -
5 To Instrument Cluster 37 -
6 - 38 -
7 - 39 GND
8 - 40 TFT Sensor
9 - 41 TPS
10 A/C Relay Control 42 -
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
11 Ignition Supply 43 -
12 GND 44 -
13 GND 45 To ECM
Damper Clutch Control
14 46 To ECM
Electromagnetic Valve
Low/Reverse Gear Manual Gearshift Proof
15 47
Electromagnetic Valve Switch ⬙P⬙
Gear Electromagnetic Manual Gearshift Proof
16 48
Valve Switch ⬙N⬙
Shifter Selector-Motion
17 To Instrument Cluster 49
Vehicle Mode ⬙AUTO⬙
Shifter Selector-Gearshift
18 To Instrument Cluster 50
Switch ⬙UP⬙
19 - 51 Brake Switch
20 - 52 -
21 - 53 -
Overdrive Electromagnetic
22 - 54
Valve
23 Data Link Connector 55 Data Link Connector
24 Ignition Supply 56 -
25 GND 57 -
Manual Gearshift Proof
26 GND 58
Switch ⬙R⬙
Manual Gearshift Proof
27 Input Shaft Speed Sensor 59
Switch ⬙D⬙
Output Shaft Speed Shifter Selector-Gearshift
28 60
Sensor Switch ⬙DOWN⬙
Crankshaft Position
29 61 To Instrument Cluster
Sensor
30 - 62 -
Main Auto TM Relay
31 - 63
Control
32 - 64 GND
LTSMW080005T
Diagnostic Procedure
RESISTANCE
SENSOR CONNECTOR TERMINAL TEMPERATURE
K⍀
0 °C 16.7 - 20.5
20 °C 7.3 - 8.9
40 °C 3.4 - 4.2
A/T
E-086 1-2
sensor
60 °C 1.9 - 2.1
80 °C 1.0 - 1.2
1 40 Yes
2 39 Yes
4. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080006T
DTC
DTC POSSIBLE
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION
DEFINITION CAUSES
CONDITION
• The Transaxle Control Module
• Input shaft
(TCM) will set this DTC when the
speed sensor
TCM didn’t received pulse signal
• The retainer of
from the input shaft speed sensor
deceleration
for above 1 seconds when the
Input speed clutch
22 Vehicle is driving vehicle is driving for 30 km/h at 3 or
sensor • Harness or
4 gear.
connectors (The
• If the DTC was set for 4 times,
sensor circuit is
then the A/T will be locked in 3rd
open or shorted)
gear (D gear) or shifted to low gear
• TCM
when in sports mode.
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Vehicle start and read out the value of ⬙INPUT SPEED SENSOR⬙.
X-431 Reference Value
DISPLAY
ITEM CONDITION
VALUE
Approximately
Input speed During driving
matches the
sensor (lock-up ON)
engine speed.
LTSMD080004
Check sensor signal circuit between sensor terminal 2 and ground in the sensor electrical connector E-088 with a
multimeter.
• 5 V should exist.
LTSMD080061
INPUT SPEED
TCM
SENSOR
CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
CONNECTOR
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 39 Yes
Disassemble and inspect the A/T and replace the retainer for the deceleration clutch.
Check for a chipped and damaged signal retainer for the deceleration clutch.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace the retainer for the deceleration clutch.
• Monitor the input speed sensor signal on the X-431 or oscilloscope. 08
• If the signal pulse is not normal, repair the noise interference.
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080007T
DTC
DTC POSSIBLE
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION
DEFINITION CAUSE
CONDITION
• The Transaxle Control Module • Output shaft
(TCM) will set this DTC when the TCM speed sensor
didn’t received pulse signal from the • Harness or
output shaft speed sensor for above 1 connectors (The
Output speed seconds when the vehicle is driving sensor circuit is
23 Vehicle is driving
sensor for 30 km/h at 3 or 4 gear. open or shorted)
• If the DTC was set for 4 times, then • Transfer case
the A/T will be locked in 3rd gear (D driven and drive
gear) or shifted to low gear when in gear
sports mode. • TCM
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Vehicle start and read out the value of ⬙OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR⬙.
X-431 Reference Value
DISPLAY
ITEM CONDITION
VALUE
Approximately
Output speed matches the
During driving
sensor speedometer
reading.
LTSMD080006
Check sensor signal circuit between sensor terminal 2 and ground in the sensor electrical connector E-088 with a
multimeter.
• 5 V should exist.
LTSMD080061
OUTPUT
SPEED TCM
SENSOR CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
CONNECTOR TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 39 Yes
Disassemble and repair the A/T and replace or repair the transfer case driven gear and drive gear.
Check for a chipped and damaged signal gear of the transfer case driven and drive gear.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace or repair the transfer case driven gear and drive gear.
• Monitor the output speed sensor signal on the X-431 or oscilloscope.
• If the signal pulse is not normal, repair the noise interference.
9. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080008T
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start vehicle and read out the value of ⬙STOP LAMP SWITCH⬙.
X-431 Reference Value
DISPLAY
ITEM CONDITION
VALUE
Stop vehicle.
Check sensor power supply between sensor terminal 3 and ground in the sensor electrical connector C-005 with a
multimeter.
BRAKE SWITCH
VALUE (VOLT)
CONDITION
4. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080005T
DTC Detection
DTC No. DTC DEFINITION DTC Set Condition POSSIBLE CAUSES
Condition
• The Transaxle
Control Module
(TCM) will set this
DTC when the TCM
• Solenoid
detected an
• Harness or
improper voltage
Reverse/low (R/L) connectors (The
31 Vehicle is driving drop when it tries to
solenoid malfunction sensor circuit is open
operate the solenoid
or shorted)
valve.
• TCM
• If the DTC was
set, then the A/T will
be locked in 3rd
gear (D gear).
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
2. ACTUATE TEST
Resistance
LOW/ LOW
REVERSE OVERDRIVE 2ND GEAR
SPEED
GEAR ELECTRO- ELECTRO- ELECTRO-
ELECTRO- MAGNETIC MAGNETIC MAGNETIC
MAGNETIC VALVE VALVE VALVE
A/T VALVE (OD) (2ND) (UD)
ASSEMBLY (L/R)
TERMINAL
7 - 10 6 - 10 4-9 3-9
LTSMD080009
TCM
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
7 15 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080005T
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
2. ACTUATE TEST
Resistance
LOW/ LOW
REVERSE OVERDRIVE 2ND GEAR
SPEED
GEAR ELECTRO- ELECTRO- ELECTRO-
ELECTRO- MAGNETIC MAGNETIC
MAGNETIC
MAGNETIC VALVE VALVE
VALVE
VALVE (OD) (2ND) (UD)
A/T (L/R)
ASSEMBLY
TERMINAL
7 - 10 6 - 10 4-9 3-9
Resistance
7.3 - 0.69 ⍀
(23 °C)
LTSMD080012
TCM
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
3 1 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080005T
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
2. ACTUATE TEST
Resistance
LOW/ LOW
REVERSE OVERDRIVE 2ND GEAR
SPEED
GEAR ELECTRO- ELECTRO-
ELECTRO-
ELECTRO- MAGNETIC MAGNETIC
MAGNETIC
MAGNETIC VALVE VALVE VALVE
VALVE (OD) (2ND) (UD)
A/T (L/R)
ASSEMBLY
TERMINAL
7 - 10 6 - 10 4-9 3-9
Resistance
7.3 - 0.69 ⍀
(23 °C
LTSMD080012
TCM
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
4 16 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080005T
DTC
DTC POSSIBLE
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION
DEFINITION CAUSES
CONDITION
• The Transaxle Control Module
• Solenoid
(TCM) will set this DTC when the TCM
• Harness or
Overdrive detected an improper voltage drop
connectors (The
34 solenoid circuit Vehicle is driving when it tries to operate the solenoid
sensor circuit is
malfunction valve.
open or shorted)
• If the DTC was set, then the A/T will
• TCM
be locked in 3rd gear (D gear).
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
2. ACTUATE TEST
Resistance
LOW/ LOW
REVERSE OVERDRIVE 2ND GEAR
SPEED
GEAR ELECTRO- ELECTRO- ELECTRO-
ELECTRO- MAGNETIC MAGNETIC MAGNETIC
MAGNETIC VALVE VALVE VALVE
A/T VALVE (OD) (2ND) (UD)
ASSEMBLY (L/R)
TERMINAL
7 - 10 6 - 10 4-9 3-9
TCM
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
6 54 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080005T
DTC
DTC POSSIBLE
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION
DEFINITION CAUSES
CONDITION
• The Transaxle Control Module
(TCM) will set this DTC when the
TCM detected an improper voltage
drop when it tries to operate the
solenoid valve.
• The Transaxle Control Module • Solenoid
Damper clutch (TCM) will set this DTC when the • Harness or
system control TCM detected that the duty cycle of connectors (The
36 Vehicle is driving
(DCC) solenoid damper clutch system control sensor circuit is
malfunction solenoid is 100 % for 4 seconds, open or shorted)
and the TCM determines the • TCM
damper clutch system control
solenoid is not normal.
• If the DTC 36 was set, then the
A/T will be locked in 3rd gear (D
gear).
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
2. ACTUATE TEST
Resistance
DCC ELECTRO-
MAGNETIC VALVE
A/T ASSEMBLY
TERMINAL
5-9
RESISTANCE
7.3 - 0.69 ⍀
(23 °C)
TCM
A/T ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
5 14 Yes
7. CHECK DTC
08
LTSMW080005T
* Low gear/reverse gear is applied when vehicle speed is lower than 10 km/h.
公 Operating components
NOTE :
Checking the automatic transaxle fluid quality and fluid level is the most basic check of the automatic transaxle. The
fluid check is also an important inspection to determine if the transaxle will need to be disassembled.
CAUTION:
The burnt scent of ATF fluid indicates that the transaxle fluid is contaminated. The tiny particles in
the fluid pan indicate that the transaxle is worn out and it will be necessary to overhaul the trans-
axle.
Diagnostic Procedure
Drive the vehicle, until the ATF reaches operating temperature (70 - 80 °C).
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shift the gear selector lever to all gear positions once, then shift to gear “N”.
Clean and check the outside of the dipstick and remove the dipstick to check the fluid level.
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
Is DTC 22 or 23 present?
Yes >> • If DTC 22 present, see diagnostic procedure for DTC 22 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
• If DTC 23 present, see diagnostic procedure for DTC 23 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. HYDRAULIC TEST
08
LTSMD080018
Test Port
TEST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
PORT
L/R
RV
UD (Low (Low/ DA (Damper OD
Fluid 2ND (Gear DR (Damper (Reverse
Speed Reverse Clutch (Overdrive
pressure 2 Brake) Clutch Gear
Clutch) Gear Engagement) Clutch)
test port fluid Disengagement) Clutch)
fluid Brake) fluid fluid
name pressure fluid pressure fluid
pressure fluid pressure pressure
pressure
pressure
REVERSE LOW/
GEAR GEAR ENGINE DECELERATION OVERDRIVE REVERSE SECONDARY TORQUE
LEVER SPEED CLUTCH GEAR CLUTCH GEAR BRAKE CONVERTER
POSITION POSITION (RPM) PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE PRESSURE
PRESSURE PRESSURE
310 - 390 250 - 390
P - 2,500 - - - -
(45 - 56) (36 - 56)
Reverse 1,270 - 1,270 - 500 - 700
R 2,500 - - -
Gear 1,770 1,770 (73-101)
In accordance with the shown status of standard fluid pressure measurement table, measure the fluid pressure of
each measurement port. The measurement of each port should be within the standard range.
If some measurement values is beyond the standard range, please refer to the fluid pressure measurement and
diagnosis table for causes.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5 for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check low speed clutch system: Low speed clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when compressed
air is applied to the fluid hole.
Check reverse/low brake clutch system: Reverse/low brake clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure
when compressed air is applied to the fluid hole.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Replace damaged components and low speed clutch and reverse/low brake clutch for low pressure
burned.
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080005T
* Low gear/reverse gear is applied when vehicle speed is lower than 10 km/h.
公 Operating components
NOTE :
Checking the automatic transaxle fluid quality and fluid level is the most basic check of the automatic transaxle. The
fluid check is also an important inspection to determine if the transaxle will need to be disassembled.
CAUTION:
The burnt scent of ATF fluid indicates that the transaxle fluid is contaminated. The tiny particles in
the fluid pan indicate that the transaxle is worn out and it will be necessary to overhaul the trans-
axle.
Diagnostic Procedure
Drive the vehicle, until the ATF reaches operating temperature (70 - 80 °C).
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shift the gear selector lever to all gear positions once, then shift to gear “N”.
Clean and check the outside of the dipstick and remove the dipstick to check the fluid level.
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
Is DTC 22 or 23 present?
Yes >> • If DTC 22 present, see diagnostic procedure for DTC 22 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case
• If DTC 23 present, see diagnostic procedure for DTC 23 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. HYDRAULIC TEST
08
LTSMD080018
Test Port
TEST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
PORT
L/R
RV
UD (Low (Low/ DA (Damper OD
Fluid 2ND (Gear DR (Damper (Reverse
Speed Reverse Clutch (Overdrive
pressure 2 Brake) Clutch Gear
Clutch) Gear Engagement) Clutch)
test port fluid Disengagement) Clutch)
fluid Brake) fluid fluid
name pressure fluid pressure fluid
pressure fluid pressure pressure
pressure
pressure
REVERSE LOW/
GEAR GEAR ENGINE DECELERATION OVERDRIVE REVERSE SECONDARY TORQUE
LEVER SPEED CLUTCH GEAR CLUTCH GEAR BRAKE CONVERTER
POSITION POSITION (RPM) PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE PRESSURE
PRESSURE PRESSURE
310 - 390 250 - 390
P - 2,500 - - - -
(45-56) (36 - 56)
Reverse 1,270 - 1,270 - 500 - 700
R 2,500 - - -
Gear 1,770 1,770 (73 - 101)
In accordance with the shown status of standard fluid pressure measurement table, measure the fluid pressure of
each measurement port. The measurement of each port should be within the standard range.
If some measurement values is beyond the standard range, please refer to the fluid pressure measurement and
diagnosis table for causes.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5 for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check low speed clutch system: Low speed clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when compressed
air is applied to the fluid hole.
Check 2nd gear brake clutch system: 2nd gear brake clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when
compressed air is applied to the fluid hole.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Replace all damaged components and low speed clutch and 2nd gear brake clutch.
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080005T
* Low gear/reverse gear is applied when vehicle speed is lower than 10 km/h.
公 Operating components
NOTE :
Checking the automatic transaxle fluid quality and fluid level is the most basic check of the automatic transaxle. The
fluid check is also an important inspection to determine if the transaxle will need to be disassembled.
CAUTION:
The burnt scent of ATF fluid indicates that the transaxle fluid is contaminated. The tiny particles in
the fluid pan indicate that the transaxle is worn and it will be necessary to overhaul the transaxle.
Diagnostic Procedure
Drive the vehicle, until the ATF reaches operating temperature (70 - 80 °C).
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shift the gear selector lever to all gear positions once, then shift to gear “N”.
Clean and check the outside of the dipstick and remove the dipstick to check the fluid level.
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
Is DTC 22 or 23 present?
Yes >> • If DTC 22 present, See diagnostic procedure for DTC 22 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
• If DTC 23 present, See diagnostic procedure for DTC 23 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. HYDRAULIC TEST
08
LTSMD080018
Test Port
TEST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
PORT
L/R
RV
UD (Low (Low/ DA (Damper OD
Fluid 2ND (Gear DR (Damper (Reverse
Speed Reverse Clutch (Overdrive
pressure 2 Brake) Clutch Gear
Clutch) Gear Engagement) Clutch)
test port fluid Disengagement) Clutch)
fluid Brake) fluid fluid
name pressure fluid pressure fluid
pressure fluid pressure pressure
pressure
pressure
REVERSE LOW/
GEAR GEAR ENGINE DECELERATION OVERDRIVE REVERSE SECONDARY TORQUE
LEVER SPEED CLUTCH GEAR CLUTCH GEAR BRAKE CONVERTER
POSITION POSITION (RPM) PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE PRESSURE
PRESSURE PRESSURE
310 - 390 250 - 390
P - 2,500 - - - -
(45-56) (36 - 56)
Reverse 1,270 - 1,270 - 500 - 700
R 2,500 - - -
Gear 1,770 1,770 (73 - 101)
In accordance with the shown status of standard fluid pressure measurement table, measure the fluid pressure of
each measurement port. The measurement of each port should be within the standard range.
If some measurement values is beyond the standard range, please refer to the fluid pressure measurement and
diagnosis table for causes.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5 for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check low speed clutch system: Low speed clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when compressed
air is applied to the fluid hole.
Check overdrive clutch system: Overdrive clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when compressed air
is applied to the fluid hole.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Replace damaged components and low speed clutch and overdrive clutch for low pressure burned.
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080005T
* Low gear/reverse gear is applied when vehicle speed is lower than 10 km/h.
公 Operating components
NOTE :
Checking the automatic transaxle fluid quality and fluid level is the most basic check of the automatic transaxle. The
fluid check is also an important inspection to determine if the transaxle will need to be disassembled.
CAUTION:
The burnt scent of ATF fluid indicates that the transaxle fluid is contaminated. The tiny particles in
the fluid pan indicate that the transaxle is worn out and it will be necessary to overhaul the trans-
axle.
Diagnostic Procedure
Drive the vehicle, until the ATF reaches operating temperature (70 - 80 °C).
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shift the gear selector lever to all gear positions once, then shift to gear “N”.
Clean and check the outside of the dipstick and remove the dipstick to check the fluid level.
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
Is DTC 22 or 23 present?
Yes >> • If DTC 22 present, See diagnostic procedure for DTC 22 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
• If DTC 23 present, See diagnostic procedure for DTC 23 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. HYDRAULIC TEST
08
LTSMD080018
Test Port
TEST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
PORT
L/R
RV
UD (Low (Low/ DA (Damper OD
Fluid 2ND (Gear DR (Damper (Reverse
Speed Reverse Clutch (Overdrive
pressure 2 Brake) Clutch Gear
Clutch) Gear Engagement) Clutch)
test port fluid Disengagement) Clutch)
fluid Brake) fluid fluid
name pressure fluid pressure fluid
pressure fluid pressure pressure
pressure
pressure
REVERSE LOW/
GEAR GEAR ENGINE DECELERATION OVERDRIVE REVERSE SECONDARY TORQUE
LEVER SPEED CLUTCH GEAR CLUTCH GEAR BRAKE CONVERTER
POSITION POSITION (RPM) PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE PRESSURE
PRESSURE PRESSURE
310 - 390 250 - 390
P - 2,500 - - - -
(45-56) (36 - 56)
Reverse 1,270 - 1,270 - 500 - 700
R 2,500 - - -
Gear 1,770 1,770 (73 - 101)
In accordance with the shown status of standard fluid pressure measurement table, measure the fluid pressure of
each measurement port. The measurement of each port should be within the standard range.
If some measurement values is beyond the standard range, please refer to the fluid pressure measurement and
diagnosis table for causes.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5 for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check 2nd gear brake clutch system: 2nd gear brake clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when
compressed air is applied to the fluid hole.
Check overdrive clutch system: overdrive clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when compressed air
is applied to the fluid hole.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Replace damaged components and 2nd gear brake clutch and overdrive clutch for low pressure
burned.
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080005T
* Low gear/reverse gear is applied when vehicle speed is lower than 10 km/h.
公 Operating components
NOTE :
Checking the automatic transaxle fluid quality and fluid level is the most basic check of the automatic transaxle. The
fluid check is also an important inspection to determine if the transaxle will need to be disassembled.
CAUTION:
The burnt scent of ATF fluid indicates that the transaxle fluid is contaminated. The tiny particles in
the fluid pan indicate that the transaxle is worn and it will be necessary to overhaul the transaxle.
Diagnostic Procedure
Drive the vehicle, until the ATF reaches operating temperature (70 - 80 °C).
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shift the gear selector lever to all gear positions once, then shift to gear “N”.
Clean and check the outside of the dipstick and remove the dipstick to check the fluid level.
With the scan tool, select view DTC and data stream for A/T.
Start the engine.
Monitor the value of the gear position as indicated in the following table while driving:
X-431 Reference Value
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC VALVE
GEAR
POSITION GEAR DCC
L/R UD OD
2 (REF)
Gear 1 off on off on off
Gear 2 on off off on on
Gear 3 on off off off on
Gear 4 on off on off on
Reverse
off on on on off
gear
Neutral
gear/ off on on on off
Parking
Is DTC 22 or 23 present?
Yes >> • If DTC 22 present, See diagnostic procedure for DTC 22 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
• If DTC 23 present, See diagnostic procedure for DTC 23 in 08 - Transaxle & Transfer Case.
No >> • Go to the next step.
2. HYDRAULIC TEST
08
LTSMD080018
Test Port
TEST
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
PORT
L/R
RV
UD (Low (Low/ DA (Damper OD
Fluid 2ND (Gear DR (Damper (Reverse
Speed Reverse Clutch (Overdrive
pressure 2 Brake) Clutch Gear
Clutch) Gear Engagement) Clutch)
test port fluid Disengagement) Clutch)
fluid Brake) fluid fluid
name pressure fluid pressure fluid
pressure fluid pressure pressure
pressure
pressure
REVERSE LOW/
GEAR GEAR ENGINE DECELERATION OVERDRIVE REVERSE SECONDARY TORQUE
LEVER SPEED CLUTCH GEAR CLUTCH GEAR BRAKE CONVERTER
POSITION POSITION (RPM) PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE CLUTCH PRESSURE PRESSURE
PRESSURE PRESSURE
310 - 390 250 - 390
P - 2,500 - - - -
(45-56) (36 - 56)
Reverse 1,270 - 1,270 - 500 - 700
R 2,500 - - -
Gear 1,770 1,770 (73 - 101)
In accordance with the shown status of standard fluid pressure measurement table, measure the fluid pressure of
each measurement port. The measurement of each port should be within the standard range.
If some measurement values is beyond the standard range, please refer to the fluid pressure measurement and
diagnosis table for causes.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5 for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Check low speed clutch system: Low speed clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when compressed
air is applied to the fluid hole.
Check reverse gear clutch system: Reverse gear clutch piston should be active and maintain pressure when com-
pressed air is applied to the fluid hole.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step for disc or plate abrasion.
No >> • Replace damaged components and low speed clutch and reverse gear clutch for low pressure
burned.
7. CHECK DTC
LTSMW080003T
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD080019
LTSMD080020
Check harness continuity between TCM terminal 2, 3 and front fuse and relay box terminal H9.
Check for harness continuity between front fuse and relay box terminal H8 and G15.
Check harness connector A-102, E-105, terminal 1.
Refer to wiring diagram for circuit information. 08
• Continuity should exist.
Check the harness for short to ground.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the circuit for an open or short to ground in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK FUSE
Disconnect Fuse 10 (30A) fuse from the front fuse and relay box.
Check fuse 10 (30A).
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace fuse 10 (30A).
8. CHECK DTC
08
LTSM080153
10. Remove the starter motor (See Starter Removal & Installation in Section 05 Starting & Charging).
11. Remove the bolts (1) attaching the drive plate to
the torque converter.
(Tighten: Drive plate bolts to 75 N·m)
BESM080058
12. Support the engine using an engine support fixture or suitable jack.
13. Remove the engine to transaxle upper bolts and remove the bracket.
(Tighten: Engine to transaxle upper bolts to 80 N·m)
14. Remove transaxle mount nuts (2) and the transaxle
mount bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Transaxle mount nut to 120 N·m)
LTSM020156
LTSM080190
17. Remove both front axle shafts (See Front Axle Shaft Removal & Installation in Section 09 Driveline & Axle).
18. Remove the engine undercover and splash shields.
19. Remove the engine to transaxle lower bolts.
(Tighten: Engine to transaxle lower bolts to 80 N·m)
20. Remove the bolts that mount the side sill to vehicle body.
(Tighten: Side sill to vehicle body bolts to 120 N·m)
21. Remove the front engine mount bolts (1).
(Tighten: Front mount bolts to 60 N·m)
BESM080035
22. Remove the rear engine mount bolts (2) and the
rear engine mount bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Rear mount bolts to 40 N·m)
LTSM020188
23. Remove the sub-frame assembly (See Sub-Frame Assembly Removal & Installation in Section 10 Suspension).
24. Remove the engine to transaxle lower bolts.
(Tighten: Transaxle mount bolts to 40 N·m)
25. Separate the transaxle from the engine and remove the transaxle from the vehicle.
WARNING!
Use a suitable jack to support the transaxle during removal.
Installation Notes: 08
• Check the transaxle fluid level.
− Drive the vehicle until the ATF reaches operating temperature (70 - 80 °C).
− Park the vehicle on level ground.
− Shift the gear selector lever to all gear positions once, then shift to gear “N”.
− Clean and check the outside of the dipstick and remove the dipstick to check the fluid level.
− Check if the transmission fluid level is within the HOT marking of the dipstick. If lower than the HOT mark-
ing, refill the transaxle until the fluid level is above the HOT marking.
• After installation, check for any fluid leakage and verify the transaxle fluid level is correct. Refill the transaxle
fluid through the fill hole (1) shown in the figure.
LTSM080185
08
LTSM080167
BESM080049
8. Apply the parking brake (apply parking brake handle to clear lower console during removal).
9. Remove the lower console (See Lower Console Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
10. Disconnect the electrical connector.
11. Remove the shift cable from the gearshift mechanism.
12. Remove the four bolts (1) and then remove the
gearshift mechanism from the bracket.
LTSM080182
NOTE :
If the battery has low voltage, press the release switch (1) to move the gearshift lever.
LTSM080187
08
LTSM080020
LTSM080020
Operation
The following are the details of the manual transaxle:
Neutral
Engine power is transmitted to the input shaft via the clutch assembly and the input shaft turns. Since no synchro-
nizers are engaged on either the input or output shafts, power is not transmitted to the output shafts, power is not
transmitted to the output shaft and the differential does not turn.
1st Gear
Engine power is transmitted to the input shaft via the clutch assembly and the input shaft turns. The input shaft first
gear is integral to the input shaft, and is in constant mesh with the intermediate shaft first speed gear. Because of
this constant mesh, the output shaft first speed gear freewheels until first gear is selected. As the gearshift lever is
moved to the first gear position, the 1-2 fork moves the 1-2 synchronizer sleeve towards first gear on the output
shaft. The synchronizer sleeve engages the first gear clutch teeth, fixing the gear to the output shaft, and allowing
power to transmit through the output shaft to the differential.
2nd Gear
Engine power is transmitted to the input shaft via the clutch assembly and the input shaft turns. The input shaft
second gear is integral to the input shaft, and is in constant mesh with the output shaft second speed gear. Because
of this constant mesh, the output shaft second speed gear freewheels until second gear is selected. As the gearshift
lever is moved to the second gear position, the 1-2 fork moves the 1-2 synchronizer sleeve towards second gear on
the output shaft. The synchronizer sleeve engages the second gear clutch teeth, fixing the gear to the output shaft,
and allowing power to transmit through the output shaft to the differential.
3rd Gear
Engine power is transmitted to the input shaft via the clutch assembly and the input shaft turns. The input shaft third
speed gear is in constant mesh with the output shaft 3-4 cluster gear which is fixed to the output shaft. Because of
this constant mesh, the input shaft third speed gear freewheels until third gear is selected. As the gearshift lever is
moved to the third gear position, the 3-4 fork moves the 3-4 synchronizer sleeve towards third gear on the input
shaft. The synchronizer sleeve engages the third gear clutch teeth, fixing the gear to the input shaft, and allowing
power to transmit through the output shaft to the differential.
4th Gear
Engine power is transmitted to the input shaft via the clutch assembly and the input shaft turns. The input shaft fourth
speed gear is in constant mesh with the output shaft 3-4 cluster gear which is fixed to the output shaft. Because of
this constant mesh, the input shaft fourth speed gear freewheels until fourth gear is selected. As the gearshift lever
is moved to the fourth gear position, the 3-4 fork moves the 3-4 synchronizer sleeve towards fourth gear on the input
shaft. The synchronizer sleeve engages the fourth gear clutch teeth, fixing the gear to the input shaft, and allowing
power to transmit through the output shaft to the differential.
5th Gear
Engine power is transmitted to the input shaft via the clutch assembly and the input shaft turns. The input shaft fifth
speed gear is pressed on to the input shaft, and is in constant mesh with the output shaft fifth speed gear. Because
of this constant mesh, the output shaft fifth speed gear freewheels until fifth gear is selected. As the gearshift lever
is moved to the fifth gear position, the 5-R fork moves the 5-R synchronizer sleeve towards the output shaft fifth
speed gear. The synchronizer sleeve engages the fifth gear clutch teeth, fixing the gear to the input shaft, and allow-
ing power to transmit through the output shaft to the differential.
Reverse Gear
Engine power is transmitted to the input shaft via the clutch assembly and the input shaft turns. The input shaft
reverse gear integral to the input shaft, and is in constant mesh with the reverse idler gear. The reverse idler gear,
which reverses the rotation of the output shaft, is in constant mesh with the output shaft reverse gear. Because of
this constant mesh, the output shaft reverse gear freewheels until reverse gear is selected. As the gearshift lever is
moved to the reverse gear position, the 5-R fork moves the 5-R synchronizer sleeve towards the output shaft reverse
gear. The synchronizer sleeve engages the reverse gear clutch teeth, fixing the gear to the output shaft, and allowing
power to transmit through the output shaft to the differential.
Transaxle Identification-Number
The transaxle serial number can be found on a metal
tag (1) fastened to the transaxle case on the clutch
housing. The third row data is the transaxle serial
number.
08
LTSM020209
Specifications
Maintenance Specifications
ALLOWABLE RANGE
DESCRIPTION LIMIT VALUE (mm)
(mm)
Axial Clearance Of Input Shaft Front Bearing -0.01 - 0.21 -
Axial Clearance Of Input Shaft Rear Bearing -0.01 - 0.12 -
Axial Clearance Of Input Shaft Fifth Gear -0.01 - 0.09 -
Axial Clearance Of Output Shaft Front Bearing -0.01 - 0.12 -
Axial Clearance Of Output Shaft Rear Bearing -0.01 - 0.09 -
Axial Clearance Of Output Shaft Third Gear -0.01 - 0.09 -
Back Clearance Of Differential Case Planetary Gear 0.025 - 0.150 -
Clearance Between The Gear And The Back Of
- 0.05
Synchronizer Ring
Pretension Of Differential Case 0.05 - 0.11 -
Torque Specifications
Technical Data
Special Tools
Installer Connector
MB-990926
Installer Connector
MB-990934
08
Installer Connector
MB-990935
Handle
MB-990938
Bearing Remover
MB-998801
Installer Cap
MB-998812
Installer (100)
MB-998813
08
Bearing Remover
MB-998917
Hook
MB-999566
08
Flywheel Fixture
CH-20043
Bearing Installer
CH-30028
Bearing Extractor
09917-58010
Symptom Diagnostics
Hard Shifting
• Hard shifting may be caused by a mis-adjusted crossover cable. If hard shifting is accompanied by gear clash,
synchronizer clutch and stop rings or gear teeth may be worn or damaged.
Clutch Problems
• Worn, damaged, or misaligned clutch components can cause difficult shifting, gear clash, and noise.
• A worn or damaged clutch disc, pressure plate, or a faulty slave cylinder can cause hard shifting and gear
clash.
Abnormal Noise
• Transaxle noise is most often a result of worn or damaged components. Chipped, broken gear or synchronizer
teeth, and worn bearings all cause noise.
08
LTSM080021
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MB-990938 - Handle
• MB-990935 - Installer Connector
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the battery and battery tray (See Battery Removal & Installation in Section 05 Starting & Charging).
4. Remove air cleaner and air duct.
LTSM020226
5. Drain the cooling system if necessary (See Cooling System Draining Procedure in Section 06 Cooling System).
6. Remove the base mounting of the air cleaner housing assembly.
7. Remove the backup lamp switch (2) and vehicle
speed sensor (1).
LTSM030029
BESM080051
9. Remove the clutch master cylinder outlet pipe from the clutch slave cylinder.
(Tighten: Outlet pipe bolt to 17 ± 1 N·m)
10. Remove the starter motor (See Starter Removal & Installation in Section 05 Starting & Charging).
11. Support the engine using an engine support fixture or suitable jack.
12. Remove the engine to transaxle upper bolts and remove the bracket.
(Tighten: Engine to transaxle upper bolts to 80 N·m)
13. Remove transaxle mount nuts (2) and the transaxle
mount bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Transaxle mount nut to 120 N·m)
LTSM020156
08
VISM030007
16. Remove both front axle shafts (See Front Axle Shaft Removal & Installation in Section 09 Driveline & Axle).
17. Remove the engine undercover and splash shields.
18. Remove the front engine mount bolts (1).
(Tighten: Front mount bolts to 60 N·m)
BESM080035
19. Remove the rear engine mount bolts (2) and the
rear engine mount bracket bolts (1).
(Tighten: Rear mount bolts to 40 N·m)
LTSM020188
20. Remove the sub-frame assembly (See Sub-Frame Assembly Removal & Installation in Section 10 Suspension).
21. Remove the engine to transaxle lower bolts (1).
(Tighten: Transaxle mount bolts to 40 N·m)
22. Separate the transaxle from the engine and
remove it from the vehicle.
VISM080002
WARNING!
Support the transaxle with a suitable jack while removing the transaxle.
Installation Notes:
• Refill 2.2 L transaxle fluid through the fill hole (1) until it bleeding from the filling hole.
• After installation, check for any fluid leakage and
verify the transaxle fluid level is correct.
LTSM080189
08
LTSM080087
LTSM080087
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the air cleaner housing assembly.
3. Remove the two shift cables (1) from the transaxle.
BESM080051
VISM080017
VISM080018
8. Remove the lower console (See Lower Console Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
9. Using sharp-nose pliers remove the clip on the
gearshift mechanism and then remove the cross-
over cable and the selector cable (1) from the
gearshift mechanism.
08
BESM080054
LTSM080181
11. Remove the four bolts (1) and then remove the
gearshift mechanism from the bracket.
BESM080053
NOTE :
Selector cable can be adjusted with the adjusting bolt (1).
Disassembly
1. Drive out the locking selector finger (1) pin follow-
ing the direction as shown in the diagram.
2. Drive out the locking pin (2) reverse gear lock
assembly pin.
3. Remove all of the components from shaft.
4. Thoroughly clean and check all parts, replace any
worn parts as necessary.
LTSM080180
Assembly
1. Carefully press and fit two gear shift mechanism
(1) & (2) bearing to the corresponding position on
the gear shift mechanism housing. The bearing (1)
should be pressed to the end, both end faces of
the bearing should align with the hole end faces of
the housing bearing. The side of the bearing with
letters should be placed outwards.
LTSM080094
NOTE :
Apply transaxle fluid to the fluid lip seal.
4. Install the gearshift shaft through the fluid seal and
into the housing of gear shift mechanism.
5. Following the direction of the arrow, install the rear
neutral return spring stop, rear neutral return
spring, reverse gear lock assembly, selector finger LTSM080138
and interlock plate assembly, front neutral return
spring assembly onto the gearshift shaft (as shown
in the figure). Check the turn-down rims of rear
neutral return spring stop, and ensure they have
entered into corresponding vent groove of the
housing. One end of main body of reverse gear
lock with blind hole shall face rear neutral return
spring stop. And the small end face of front neutral
return spring assembly shall face towards selector
finger.
LTSM080139
LTSM080140
8. Install the gearshift fluid seal dust boot to the gearshift shaft fluid seal.
9. Install the gearshift lever assembly to the gearshift shaft, then press it in the pin hole of gearshift lever assembly,
finally install the pin.
NOTE :
Neither end of the pin is allowed to protrude beyond the two end surfaces of the pin holes.
10. Align the selector finger (1) and fork shaft spring
pin (2), install the spring pin of selector finger (as
shown by the arrow in the figure).
08
LTSM080094
LTSM080128
12. Check the gearshift shaft to ensure it is able to rotate and perform axial movement freely.
13. Install air duct (1) and air duct cap (2), apply seal-
ant to the surface of the inserted part of air duct.
LTSM080134
LTSM080135
Disassembly
1. Place the transaxle on a workbench.
2. Remove the clutch fork (2) and remove the release
bearing (1). 08
NOTE: The release bearing (1) is not serviceable.
LTSM020229
LTSM080119
LTSM080120
LTSM080121
LTSM080122
LTSM080123
LTSM080124
9. Remove shaft clip (3) and shaft clip (1) from the
shafts, and then remove bearing collar (2).
08
LTSM080125
LTSM080126
LTSM080022
VISM080019
LTSM080127
14. Grasp the input shaft assembly, output shaft assembly, 1st-2nd shift fork, 3rd-4th shift fork and 5th-reverse fork
shaft together and remove.
15. Remove the differential assembly (1) upward (as
shown in the figure).
NOTE: Pre-tighten the shim of the differential cone
bearing.
LTSM080129
LTSM080130
Inspection
1. Place a tin solder sheet (1) (approximately length
is 10 mm and diameter is 1.6 mm) on the specified
part of the transaxle housing, and then install the
differential outer bearing race.
2. Install the Clutch Housing, and tighten the bolts to
the specified torque.
3. Replace the tin solder sheets with thicker tin solder
sheets.
LTSM080026
08
LTSM080027
LTSM080131
LTSM080132
LTSM080133
Assembly
1. Install the input shaft together with the output shaft.
2. Install the 5th-reverse gear shifting fork/fork stalk–5th-reverse gear fork/3rd-4th gear shifting fork/fork stalk–3rd-
4th fork.
3. Move the gear bushing–3rd-4th gear (1) and the
gear bushing–5th-reverse gear (2) in this direction
shown in the left figure.
LTSM080028
4. Install the 3rd-4th gear shifting fork (2) and its fork
stalk (1) and the 5th-reverse gear shifting fork (3)
and its stalk (4).
08
LTSM080029
5. Install all gear shifting fork into the gear hub, and
at the same time, move the fork stalks (1) & (2) in
the direction shown in the figure.
LTSM080024
LTSM080030
LTSM080031
CAUTION:
The sealant line applied should be uniform and
continuous and without breaks.
LTSM080032
CAUTION:
The sealant line applied should be uniform and
continuous and without breaks.
LTSM080033
LTSM080034
08
LTSM080035
LTSM080036
16. Inspect the backup lamp switch. Inspect the switch for broken terminal or an open circuit.
Input Shaft
Specifications
Clearance Specifications
1 - Synchronizer Ring
2 - Gear
LTSM080058
Disassemble
08
LTSM080037
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MB-998801 - Bearings Remover
• MB-998812 - Installer Cap
• MB-998813 - Installer (100 mm)
• MB-998816 - Installer Connector (30 mm)
• MB-998825 - Installer Connector (52 mm)
• MB-998824 - Installer Connector (50 mm)
1. Using special tool MB-998801 (1), disassemble of
input shaft rear bearing.
LTSM080038
LTSM080039
LTSM080040
LTSM080041
Assemble
1. Install the input shaft seal.
Press the seal in until the dimension shown in the
figure is obtained.
08
LTSM080042
LTSM080043
LTSM080044
LTSM080045
LTSM080046
CAUTION:
Ensure that the synchronizer ring is not locked when installing the gear hub.
6. Using special tool MB-998801 (4), MB-998812 (1),
MB-998813 (2) and MB-998825 (3), install the gear
bushing-3rd-4th gear.
LTSM080047
LTSM080048
LTSM080049
08
LTSM080050
LTSM080051
LTSM080052
LTSM080053
LTSM080054
LTSM080055
Inspection
1. Input Shaft
• Inspect the external surface of the input shaft and
needle bearings (1) for any damage or excessive
wear.
• Inspect the input shaft spline for any damage or
excessive wear.
LTSM080056
2. Needle Bearing
Inspect the input shaft and gears for smooth operation.
3. Synchronizer Ring
• Inspect the synchronizer rings for any damage or
signs of breakage in the surface of synchronizer
rings.
08
LTSM080057
LTSM080058
LTSM080059
LTSM080085
Output Shaft
Disassemble
08
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MB-998801 - Bearing Remover
• MB-998812 - Installer Cap
• MB-998814 - Installer Connector (200 mm)
• MB-998813 - Installer (100)
• MB-998818 - Installer Connector (38 mm)
• MB-998819 - Installer Connector (40 mm)
• MB-998822 - Installer Connector (46 mm)
• MB-998825 - Installer Connector (52 mm)
1. Using special tool MB-998917 (2), disassemble the
output shaft rear bearing (1).
LTSM080061
LTSM080062
LTSM080063
LTSM080064
08
LTSM080065
LTSM080066
LTSM080067
Assemble
1. Using special tool MB-998801 (4), MB-998812 (1)
and MB-998818 (3), install the output shaft front
bearing race (3).
LTSM080068
LTSM080069
LTSM080070
LTSM080057
LTSM080079
CAUTION:
Using special tool MD-998814 (1), MD-998815
(2) and MD-998825 (3), install the synchronizer
ring (4). Ensure that the synchronizer ring is
not locked when installing the gear hub.
08
LTSM080071
LTSM080049
• Ensure that the two deep tooth spaces of the gear hub (1) are correctly aligned with the two high racks of the
gear hub during the installation of gear bushing.
LTSM080073
LTSM080074
LTSM080075
10. Install the snap ring- 3rd driven gear (1). Install the
snap ring to maintain the proper the axial clear-
ance of the output shaft 3rd driven gear.
(The Standard Value: -0.01 mm to 0.09 mm)
LTSM080076
LTSM080077
LTSM080078
08
LTSM080079
CAUTION:
Using special tool MD-998812 (1), MD-998813
(2) and MD-998819 (3), install the synchronizer
ring (4). Ensure that the synchronizer ring is
not locked when installing the gear hub-5th-re-
verse gear.
LTSM080080
LTSM080081
LTSM080082
LTSM080083
• Install the outer ring (2) and inner ring (4), and
then press them down to the gear (1) to measure
the clearance “A”. If the “A” is less than the limit
value, theses rings shall be replaced.(3): Steel
ringThe limit value: 0.5 mm
CAUTION:
The outer ring, inner ring or steel, are replaced
as a complete set.
LTSM080084
LTSM080059
LTSM080085
08
LTSM080086
Inspection
Needle Bearing
• Assemble the shaft together with the gear, and then examine that they can slide smoothly without sagging or
noise.
• Inspect the bearing cage for any damage.
1 – Fork Shaft - Fifth Reverse Gear 4 – Fork Rack - Fifth Reverse Gear Shift Fork
2 – Shift Fork - Fifth Reverse Gear 5 – Driving Block - Backup Light Switch
3 – Pin GB879 5×24 6 – Fifth Reverse Gear Shift Fork Assembly
LTSM080136
1. Remove the three spring pins.
2. Remove the driving block, fork rack and shift fork from the fork shaft in sequence.
Assemble
Assemble in the reverse order of disassembly.
NOTE :
• Check and ensure the shift fork is properly installed to the fork shaft, there should be NO axial or radial motion in
the fork shaft.
• Check and ensure the fork rack is properly installed to the fork shaft, there should be NO axial or radial motion in
the fork shaft.
• Check and ensure backup light driving block is properly installed to the fork shaft, there should be NO axial or
radial motion in the fork shaft.
• Check the fork shaft surface for any damage.
• Check the position of the three spring pins, ensure the pins are in proper alignment. The extension of both ends
of the three spring pins should not exceed 3 mm.
LTSM080137
1. Remove the two spring pins.
2. Remove the fork rack and shift fork from the fork shaft in sequence.
08
Assemble
Assemble in the reverse order of disassembly.
NOTE :
• Check and ensure the shift fork is properly installed to the fork shaft, there should be NO axial or radial motion in
the fork shaft.
• Check and ensure the fork rack is properly installed to the fork shaft, there should be NO axial or radial motion in
the fork shaft.
• Check the fork shaft surface for any damage.
• Check the position of the three spring pins, ensure the pins are in proper alignment. The extension of both ends
of the three spring pins should not exceed 3 mm.
LTSM080141
1. Remove the two spring pins.
2. Remove the shift fork and fork rack from the fork shaft in sequence.
Assembly
Assemble in the reverse order of disassembly.
NOTE :
• Check and ensure the shift fork is properly installed to the fork shaft, there should be NO axial or radial motion in
the fork shaft.
• Check and ensure the fork rack is properly installed to the fork shaft, there should be NO axial or radial motion in
the fork shaft.
• Check the fork shaft surface for any damage.
• Check the position of the three spring pins, ensure the pins are in proper alignment. The extension of both ends
of the three spring pins should not exceed 3 mm.
08
LTSM080095
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MB-998772 - Valve Spring Compressor
• MB-999566 - Hook
• MB-990938 - Handle
• MB-990935 - Installer Connector
• MB-990934 - Installer Connector
• MB-998325 - Fluid Seal Installer
• MB-990926 - Installer Connector
1. Using special tool MB-999566 (1), MB-996772
(3), and MD-998348 (4) disassemble the outer
race of the front/rear bearing (2) of the differen-
tial.
LTSM080096
Assemble
1. Install the bushing.
Press the bushing (1) into position (2), as shown
in the figure.
08
LTSM080098
LTSM080100
LTSM080102
LTSM080103
LTSM080105
08
LTSM080106
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• MD-998325 - Fluid Installer
1. Install the bearing-gear shifting mechanism (1).
Press the bearing in until it is flush with the surface
of housing.
LTSM080107
LTSM080108
08
08
LTSM080109
Operation
The differential operates through the gear mesh with the ring gear bolted to the differential case. The engine power
is transmitted to the axle shafts through the pinion mate and side gears. The side gears are connected to the axle
shafts.
Specifications
Clearance Specifications
Special Tools
Installer Cap
MD-998812
08
Bearing Remover
MD-998801
Fluid Installer
MD-998325
Disassemble
Using special tool MD-998801 (1), disassemble the dif-
ferential-front/rear shaft bearing.
LTSM080110
Inspection
1. Clean all components.
2. Inspect the following components for wear:
• Ring gear
• Adjusting washers
• Side gears
• Spherical washers
• Planetary gears
• Planetary gear shaft
Assemble
1. Install the adjustment shim-axle shaft gear/axle shaft gear/spherical washer-planetary gear/planetary gear/plan-
etary gear shaft.
2. Assemble the spherical washer on the back of axle
shaft gear, and then install the axle shaft gear on
the differential.
LTSM080111
NOTE :
The adjustment shim with intermediate thickness (0.93 to 1.00 mm) shall be assembled when a new axle shaft gear
is installed.
3. Place the spherical washer on the back of any
planetary gear to make two planetary gears
engage simultaneously with the axle shaft gear.
Turn these gears, and at the same time, install
them in their proper positions.
4. Insert and install the planetary gear shaft.
LTSM080112
LTSM080113
CAUTION:
After the lock pin is taped in, the axle shaft
gear and the planetary gear should operate
normally.
1 - Differential Housing
2 - Lock Pin
3 - Pinion Shaft
LTSM080114
LTSM080115
LTSM080116
LTSM080117
08
BESM080030
Operation
The hydraulic clutch system is responsible for engaging and disengaging the clutch. Depressing the clutch pedal
develops fluid pressure in the clutch master cylinder. This pressure is transmitted to the integral release bearing
which is in contact with the pressure plate diaphragm spring. As additional force is applied, the bearing depresses the
diaphragm spring fingers inward on the fulcrums. The action moves the pressure plate rearward, relieving clamping
force on the clutch disc.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Flywheel Fixture
CH-20043
Bearing Extractor
09917 - 58010
08
BESM080046
LTSM080145
BESM020058
LTSM080146
Inspect
• Check the input shaft bearing to ensure it is able to rotate freely, replace the bearing if necessary.
• Measure the depth of the recesses of the clutch friction lining rivet head, i.e., the distance between rivet head
and friction lining surface (as shown in the figure).
If the depth of any hole comes to the limit, replace
friction lining assembly .
(Standard: 1.2 mm)
(Limit: 0.5 mm)
08
LTSM080147
• Check clutch pressure plate diaphragm spring for irregular wear or damage.
• Check clutch pressure plate for wear or hot spots.
• If found abnormal, replace the clutch plate assembly. Never separate the clutch plate assembly into the dia-
phragm spring and clutch plate.
• Check the contact surface of the flywheel and friction lining for irregular wear or hot spots. Repair or replace if
necessary.
Installation
• Prior to assembling, check flywheel surface and clutch plate surface to ensure they are clean and dry.
• Using special tools CH-30028 (1), install the input shaft bearing to the crankshaft (as shown in the figure). Align
the clutch friction lining assembly and flywheel cen-
ter using special tools (as shown in the figure), and
then install the clutch plate assembly and bolts,
Tighten the bolts to the specified torque.
(Tighten: Clutch pressure plate bolts to 25 N·m)
LTSM080148
NOTE :
When tightening the clutch pressure plate bolts (1),
tighten by hand until the friction lining assembly is prop-
erly aligned.
• Apply a thin layer of grease to the input shaft, and
then assemble the transaxle and engine.
NOTE: Turn the splines when installing the trans-
axle input shaft into the clutch friction lining assem-
bly until the splines are engaged.
LTSM080149
LTSM080150
make sure brake master cylinder fluid level is full and the reservoir cap is installed tightly.
1. Remove the clutch master cylinder outlet pipe from
the clutch slave cylinder.
(Tighten: Outlet pipe bolt to 17 ± 1 N·m)
2. Remove the clutch slave cylinder bolts (1) from the
transaxle housing.
(Tighten: clutch slave cylinder bolts to 11 ± 1 N·m)
LTSM080143
LTSM020210
5. Actuate the clutch pedal until the brake master cylinder fluid drains from the bleed port.
6. Depress the clutch pedal, tighten the bleed port.
7. From driver’s seat, actuate the clutch pedal until the hydraulic clutch system has pressure.
8. Depress the clutch pedal, loosen the bleed port and bleed the brake master cylinder fluid.
9. Repeat steps 6 to 8 several times until there is no air in the hydraulic clutch system.
NOTE :
Do not allow clutch master cylinder to run dry while fluid exits bleed port.
10. Close the hydraulic bleed port, remove the drain hose and replace the dust cap on the bleed port.
11. Top off the brake master cylinder fluid level with DOT 4 brake fluid as necessary.
CAUTION:
During the bleeding process, make sure the brake master cylinder fluid is always full.
08
LTSM160007
Operation
The transfer case transfers the torque output from the transaxle to the ITM controller.
LTSM160011
LTSM160012
5. Remove the transaxle and transfer case assembly (See Transaxle Assembly Removal & Installation in Section
08 Transaxle).
6. Remove the transfer case from the transaxle (8 bolts).
(Tighten: Transaxle and transfer case bolts to 80 N·m)
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM160013
LTSM160014
08
LTSM160015
LTSM160017
LTSM160018
Assembly
1. Put a standard-sized 1.4 mm adjusting shim from
the front bearing driven gear axle into the transfer
case housing, press in the front outer bearing race
of the driven gear axle, then in the rear outer bear-
ing race, and press the front bearing of the driven
gear axle into the driven gear axle; then put it into
the collar and press in the rear inner bearing race.
Attach the locknut, and adjust the tightening torque
of the driven gear by adjusting the locknut until the
LTSM160019
driven gear axle can be driven with a torque of 1.0-
1.5 N·m.
2. Assemble the flange axle.
Link the drive gear ring of the transfer case to the flange axle with a mounting bolt, tighten the bolt to 110 N·m.
Install the bearing to the left of the flange axle and the bearing to the left of the right bearing seat.
3. Choose the 2.4 mm standard-sized adjusting shim for the left bearing for the flange axle, put the adjusting shim
for the right bearing for the flange axle, the outer bearing race to the left of the flange axle and the flange axle
into the transfer case.
Measure the distance (A) from the contact surface of the right bearing seat and the transfer case to the right
bearing seat and the left bearing’s right end surface.
Measure the distance (B) from the contact surface of the right bearing seat and the transfer case to the place
where the right and left bearings on the right bearing seat.
4. Calculate the thickness value of the adjusting gasket S = A - B
5. Select the adjusting gasket: S + (0.05 - 0.10) mm
6. Assembly of the right bearing seat.
Assemble the right bearing to the right bearing seat, install the retainer ring of the right bearing to the right
bearing seat, install the fluid seals to the left and right of the right bearing seat, install the O-ring and link the
right bearing seat to the transfer case housing with the bolt, tighten the bolt to 35 N·m. The subassembly should
be able to rotate with 3.0-5.0 N·m torque.
7. Adjust the hypoid gear engagement: first, spread red lead powder on the teeth of the driven bevel gear so that
there will appear red prints on both working sides of the gear teeth of the driving bevel gear when turning it by
hand. If the gear pattern prints on both engaging sides of the drive gear ring is higher than the center of the gear
height near to the small end and occupy over 60% of the gear tooth width, then the pattern is correct; and the
backlash between various gear teeth should fall between 0.13 mm and 0.18 mm.
A: If the clearance between one lateral side of a tooth and that of the adjacent tooth are not correct, choose
bearing shims to the left and right of the flange axle, repeat procedures 3, 4 and 5 to measure the clearance
between one lateral side of a tooth and that of the adjacent tooth on the hypoid gear until the adjustment is
correct.
B: If the gear pattern print leans to the tooth tip, replace the adjusting shim from the front bearing of the driven
gear to a thicker 1 mm; If the gear pattern print leans to the tooth root, then get the adjusting shim of the front
bearing of driven gear axle needs to be subtracted by 1 mm. Examine the gear pattern print, repeat procedures
3, 4, 5, 6, and 7 until the gear pattern is correct.
8. Assemble the transfer case front shell, and tighten to 35 N·m.
9. Assemble the transfer case small rear housing onto the transfer case, and tighten to 35 N·m.
10. Assemble the input clutch fluid seal, O-ring, retainer ring and the input clutch; install the transfer case onto the
transaxle and tighten to 80 N·m.
NOTE: When assembling bearings and fluid seals, it is necessary to apply lubricating grease. The sealing sur-
face of the housing must have sealant applied.
FRONT AXLE
GENERAL INFORMATION 09-2 Shudder Or Vibration During Acceleration 09-4
Description 09-2 Vibration At Highway Speeds 09-4
Operation 09-2
Specifications 09-2 ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 09-5
Special Tools 09-3
Front Hub and Bearing 09-5
Removal & Installation 09-5
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING 09-4
Vehicle Inspection 09-4 Front Axle Shaft 09-6
Noise Or Vibration On Turns 09-4 Removal & Installation 09-6
09
Clunking Noise During Acceleration 09-4
LTSM090004
This vehicle is equipped with unequal length half shafts, consisting of short left and long right half shafts. The half
shafts consist of a fixed Constant Velocity (CV) joint at the outboard end connected by a solid shaft to a plunging CV
joint on the inboard end. The inner CV joint has a splined end and is attached to the transaxle and is retained with
a snap ring. The outer joint has a splined connection to the wheel hub and is retained with a lock nut.
Operation
The front axle transmits torque from the transaxle to the wheels. In order to allow vertical and horizontal movement
of the wheels, the axle shafts have plunging CV joints on the inboard ends of the axle shafts.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Bearing Puller
NOTE :
If the CV seal boot is damaged, this will result in the loss and/or contamination of the joint grease, resulting in inad-
equate lubrication of the joint.
LTSM090006
4. Remove the front brake rotor (See Front Brake Rotor Removal & Installation in Section 12 Brakes). 09
5. Remove the wheel speed sensor mounting bolt (1),
then remove the wheel speed sensor.
LTSM100045
LTSM090003
LTSM090002
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assembly.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
3. Remove the front axle hub nut (1) from the front
knuckle.
(Tighten: Front axle hub nut to 135 N·m)
LTSM090006
LTSM100045
CAUTION:
When removing the front axle shaft, do not
subject the constant velocity joint to an exces-
sive angle. Also, be careful not to excessively
extend the slide joint.
8. Remove the front axle shaft from the transaxle
using a suitable tool.
9. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
LTSM100041
• Rotate the joint up/down, left/right, and in axial
direction, check for any rough movement or significant looseness.
• Check boot for cracks or other damage, and for grease leakage.
• If damaged, disassemble axle shaft to verify damage, and repair or replace as necessary.
09
LTSM090005
The rear axle utilizes an independent design. This suspension system incorporates a separate wheel knuckle for
each wheel and allows the wheels to react to road imperfections independent of each other. This independent action
offers improved isolation from the effects of jounce and rebound.
The rear axle consists of the following components:
• Wheel Hub
• Wheel Studs
• Wheel Bearing
• Rear Trailing Arm
Operation
The rear axle utilizes a sealed wheel bearing housed in the rear knuckle assembly.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Bearing Puller
Vehicle Inspection
Inspect the following for leaks or damage:
• Check for grease in the vicinity of the inboard tripod joint and outboard CV joint (4x4).
• Check the inner or outer joint seal boot or seal boot clamp for damage (4x4).
NOTE :
If the CV seal boot is damaged, this will result in the loss and/or contamination of the joint grease, resulting in inad-
equate lubrication of the joint.
LTSM090001
09
LTSM160009
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 09–13
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE
Operation
The axle receives power from the transaxle through the rear intermediate drive shaft. The drive shaft is connected to
the pinion gear which rotates the differential through the gear mesh with the ring gear bolted to the differential case.
The engine power is transmitted to the axle shafts through the pinion mate and side gears.
LTSM160024
5. Remove the bolts (1) from the right rear half shaft
to the rear axle output flange.
(Tighten: Rear half shaft to rear axle output flange
bolts to 40 N·m)
6. Remove the right rear half shaft.
LTSM160029
LTSM160025
LTSM160026
09
09
LTSM160027
The Tiggo 4WD is the first 4WD vehicle produced by Chery. The 4WD system is equipped with a QR523T transaxle
manufactured by Chery.
An active torque transfer system is used, and an interactive torque management system (ITM) is equipped to make
it possible to intelligently distribute the drive force for the front wheels and rear wheels according to different road
conditions. For example, on a smooth road, the vehicle utilizes front-wheel drive. When road conditions worsen, the
ITM will automatically switch to 4WD. The use of ITM allows the Tiggo vehicle to be more economical and more
efficient than the common 4WD system.
Operation
The intelligent 4WD system is controlled by an interactive torque management system (ITM) module. The ITM mod-
ule communicates with the Engine Control Module (ECM) and the Antilock Brake System (ABS) controller through the
CAN network. The ITM module collects data from sensors on the vehicle body to determine the condition of the drive
wheels. Based on the sensor inputs, the ITM module controls the ITM controller. The ITM controller will then distrib-
ute a portion of the torque to the rear drive axle as needed. The ITM controller works as an electromagnetic clutch.
Different torque can be transferred by changing the electric current of the ITM controller. The ITM controller will be
able to distribute the torque of the front drive axle and the rear drive axle at different ratios according to the various
dynamic conditions of the vehicle.
Specification
Transaxle Specifications
Torque Specifications
Fluid Specifications
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
LTSM160008
NOTE :
Under normal vehicle usage, the ITM Controller requires no maintenance
09
Operation
The ITM Controller transfers the torque output from the transaxle to the rear drive axle.
LTSM160005T
LTSM160022
LTSM160023
NOTE :
The ITM Controller assembly is a precision component, be careful to avoid dropping or mis-handling the ITM Con-
troller during removal.
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Operation
The ITM control module collects signals from the Engine Control Module (ECM) and Antilock Brake System (ABS)
controller, judges the vehicle driving state, controls the working electric current of the ITM controller and distributes
the torque of the front axle and the rear axle intelligently according to such signals.
09
LTSM160028
Operation
The drive shafts transfer the torque from the transaxle to the rear axle.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
09
LTSM160020
LTSM160021
FRONT SUSPENSION
GENERAL INFORMATION 10-2 Removal & Installation 10-10
Description 10-2 Front Stabilizer Bar 10-11
Operation 10-4 Removal & Installation 10-11
Specifications 10-4
Special Tools 10-5 Front Strut Assembly 10-12
Description 10-12
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING 10-6 Operation 10-13
Vehicle Suspension Troubleshooting Chart 10-6 Diagnosis & Testing 10-13
Removal & Installation 10-13
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 10-7 Front Coil Spring 10-14
Front Steering Knuckle 10-7 Description 10-14 10
Description 10-7 Operation 10-14
Operation 10-7 Removal & Installation 10-15
Removal & Installation 10-7 Front Sub-Frame Assembly 10-16
Front Lower Control Arm 10-9 Removal & Installation 10-16
Description 10-9
Operation 10-9 UNIT REPAIR 10-19
Diagnosis & Testing 10-9 Front Strut 10-19
Removal & Installation 10-9 Disassemble 10-19
Front Lower Control Arm Inspection 10-10 Inspection 10-20
Front Stabilizer Bar Link 10-10 Assemble 10-21
10
1 - Front Lower Control Arm Ball Joint 6 - Front Stabilizer Bar Bracket
2 - Front Lower Control Arm 7 - Front Stabilizer Bar Link
3 - Steering Knuckle 8 - Front Sub-Frame Assembly
4 - Front Strut Assembly 9 - Side Member Assembly
5 - Front Stabilizer Bar
LTSM100008
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 10–3
GENERAL INFORMATION
WARNING!
Do not remove the strut rod nut while the strut assembly is installed in the vehicle, or before the coil spring is
compressed with a spring compressor. The spring is held under high pressure and must be compressed before
the strut rod nut can be removed.
CAUTION:
At no time when servicing a vehicle can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal fastener be
installed in the shock tower to replace the original plastic clip. It may come in contact with the
strut or coil spring.
CAUTION:
Wheel bearing damage will result if the vehicle is rolled or the weight of the vehicle is allowed to
be supported by the tires for any length of time with the axle hub nut loose.
Operation
The front suspension utilizes a MacPherson strut system. This suspension system incorporates a strut assembly that
takes the place of the upper arm and ball joint. The strut performs the function of a shock absorber and is encom-
passed by a coil spring.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
10
Operation
The steering knuckle supports the hub and bearing. The front suspension steering knuckle is not a repairable com-
ponent of the front suspension. It must be replaced if found to be damaged in any way. If it is determined that the
steering knuckle is bent when servicing the vehicle, no attempt should be made to straighten the steering knuckle.
10
LTSM090006
4. Access and remove the front brake rotor (See Front Brake Rotor Remove & Installation in Section 12 Brakes).
5. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor (1) and set it
aside.
LTSM100045
LTSM100006
7. Remove the nut (1) attaching the outer tie rod end
to the steering knuckle.
(Tighten: Outer tie rod end nut to 32 - 38 N·m)
8. Using special tool CH-10002, remove the outer tie
rod end from the steering knuckle.
LTSM110034
LTSM100041
NOTE :
Do not allow the half shaft to hang by the inner C/V joint; it must be supported to keep the joint from separating
during this operation.
10. Pull the knuckle off the half shaft outer C/V joint splines and remove the knuckle from the vehicle.
11. If required, remove the screws fastening the shield to the knuckle.
12. If required, use a suitable tool to press the hub and bearing out of the knuckle.
13. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Operation
The front lower control arm supports the lower ball joint. The ball joint carries the weight of the vehicle, and provide
a pivot for the wheel to turn. The lower control arm also allows vertical movement of the vehicle suspension when the
vehicle travels over bumps in the road.
NOTE :
Do not attempt to repair or straighten a broken or bent lower control arm. If damaged, the lower control arm is ser-
viced only as a complete component.
LTSM100055
LTSM100006
LTSM100057
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
LTSM100064
LTSM100010
LTSM100046
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
LTSM100058
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
LTSM100009
Operation
The strut assembly cushions the ride of the vehicle, controlling vibration, jounce and rebound of the suspension. The
coil spring controls ride quality and maintains proper ride height. The spring isolators isolate the coil spring at the top
and bottom from coming into metal-to-metal contact with the upper mounting seat and the strut. The strut dampens
jounce and rebound motions of the coil spring and suspension.
10
LTSM100034
LTSM100010
LTSM100041
LTSM100002
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
• Four-wheel alignment inspection is required after the installation.
Operation
Coil springs are designed to store energy and subsequently release it and to absorb shock and maintain a force
between contacting surfaces. Coil springs are rated for specific vehicle applications.
NOTE :
Each component is serviced by removing the strut assembly from the vehicle and disassembling it. Coil springs are
rated separately for each corner or side of the vehicle depending on optional equipment and type of vehicle service.
If a coil spring requires replacement, be sure that it is replaced with a spring meeting the correct load rating for the
vehicle and its specific options.
LTSM100014
5. Once the spring is sufficiently compressed, install the strut nut wrench on the strut rod nut. 10
6. Install a deep socket on the end of the strut rod.
7. While holding the strut rod, remove the nut using
the strut nut wrench.
(Tighten: Strut rod nut to 100 - 120 N·m)
LTSM100015
LTSM100006
6. Remove the left and right front stabilizer bar links (See Front Stabilizer Bar Link Removal & Installation in Sec-
tion 10 Suspension).
7. Remove the nut (1) attaching the outer tie rod ends
to the steering knuckle on each side of the steering
rack.
(Tighten: Outer tie rod end nut to 35 N·m)
LTSM110034
LTSM100024
LTSM100056
10. Remove the bolts between the radiator lower seat and side member assembly, then remove the side member
assembly.
11. Remove the front engine mount and rear engine mount (See Engine Mounts Removal & Installation in Section 02
Engine).
12. Remove the four bolts (1) between the sub-frame
assembly and the vehicle body.
(Tighten: Sub-frame assembly to vehicle body bolts
to 180 ± 15 N·m)
LTSM100044
10
LTSM100013
LTSM100014
6. Compress the coil spring until all coil spring tension is removed from the upper mount and bearing.
CAUTION:
Never use impact or high speed tools to remove the strut rod nut. Damage to the strut internal
bearings can occur.
LTSM100015
Inspection
Inspect the strut assembly for damage and evidence of fluid running from the upper end of the fluid reservoir (actual
leakage will be a stream of fluid running down the side of the reservoir tube and dripping off lower end of unit).
Inspect the strut assembly components for the following and replace as necessary:
• Inspect the strut (damper) for shaft binding over the
full stroke of the shaft.
• Inspect the jounce bumper for cracks and signs of
deterioration.
• Inspect the dust shield for cracks and tears.
• Check the upper mount for cracks and distortion
and its retaining studs for any sign of damage.
• Check the bearing and upper spring seat for any
binding.
• Inspect the upper and lower spring isolators for
material deterioration and distortion.
• Inspect the coil spring for any sign of damage to
the coating.
LTSM100011
NOTE :
Follow the procedure below to properly dispose of the strut assembly.
• Pull the strut rod to extend the strut rod out as far as possible.
• Drill a hole to discharge the gas in the strut assembly cylinder (Drill a hole in the cylinder body according to
the figure to discharge the gas).
LTSM100012
Assemble
1. Replace all necessary parts prior to reassembly:
1. Cushion Pad
2. Dust Boot
3. Cushion Block
4. Strut Support
5. Bearing and Stop
10
LTSM100016
LTSM100017
LTSM100018
LTSM100019
6. Install the cushion block and pull the piston rod to the bottom.
7. Align the coil spring on the bottom spring holder (1)
(the end of the spring should be indexed in the
spring pocket).
LTSM100020
LTSM100021
10
LTSM100035
LTSM100035
WARNING!
Only frame contact or wheel lift hoisting equipment can be used on this vehicle. It cannot be hoisted using
equipment designed to lift a vehicle by the rear axle. If this type of hoisting equipment is used, damage to rear
suspension components will occur.
CAUTION:
If a rear suspension component becomes bent, damaged or fails, no attempt should be made to
straighten or repair it. Always replace it with a new component.
Operation
The rear suspension utilizes an independent multi-link arm design. This suspension system allows the wheels to 10
react to road imperfections independent of each other. This independent action offers improved isolation from the
effects of jounce and rebound.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
10
LTSM100061
LTSM100066
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
LTSM100068 10
3. Remove the retaining bolt (1) connecting the upper
control arm and rear sub-frame assembly.
(Tighten: Upper control arm to rear sub-frame
assembly bolt to 80 - 100 N·m)
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM100065
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
LTSM100032
3. Remove the connecting bolt from the rear stabilizer bar link to the rear stabilizer bar.
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
Operation
The shock absorber assembly cushions the ride of the vehicle, controls vibration, jounce and rebound of the sus-
pension. The shock absorber dampens jounce and rebound motions of the coil spring and suspension.
LTSM100004
LTSM100047
LTSM100061
LTSM100047
LTSM100060
LTSM100059
LTSM100054
LTSM100067
12. Remove the rear brake rotor (See Rear Brake Rotor Removal & Installation in Section 10 Brakes).
13. Remove the rear hub and bearing (See Rear Hub and Bearing Removal & Installation in Section 09 Driveline &
Axle).
14. Remove the rear trailing arm.
15. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• After installation, each bolt must be tightened to the required tightening torque.
10
Front
• Camber
• Toe-in
• Caster
Rear
• Camber
• Toe-in
Check the wheel alignment and make all wheel alignment adjustments with the vehicle standing at its proper curb
height specification. Curb height is the normal riding height of the vehicle. It is measured from a certain point on the
vehicle to the ground or a designated area while the vehicle is sitting on a flat, level surface.
Operation
Curb Height Measurement
The wheel alignment is to be checked and all alignment adjustments made with the vehicle at its required curb height
specification.
• Vehicle height is to be checked with the vehicle on a flat, level surface, preferably a vehicle alignment rack.
• The tires are to be inflated to the recommended pressure.
• All tires are to be the same size as standard equipment.
• Vehicle height is checked with the fuel tank full of fuel, and no passenger or luggage compartment load.
• Vehicle height is not adjustable.
• If the measurement is not within specifications, inspect the vehicle for bent or weak suspension components.
• Compare the parts tag on the suspect coil spring(s) to the parts book and the vehicle sales code, checking for
a match.
• Once removed from the vehicle, compare the coil spring height to a new or known good coil spring. The
heights should vary if the suspect spring is weak.
NOTE :
Prior to reading the curb height measurement, the front and rear of the vehicle must be jounced to settle the sus-
pension. Induce jounce by pushing down on the center of the bumper (fascia), using care not to damage the vehicle,
moving the vehicle up and down, gradually increasing the suspension travel with each stroke. Release the bumper at
the bottom of each stroke, repeating this action several times. Perform this to both front and rear suspensions an
equal amount of times.
11. Check the tires on the vehicle. The tires are to be inflated to the recommended air pressure. All tires must be
the same size and in good condition with approxi-
mately the same tread wear.
LTSM100027
12. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for excessive radial runout.
13. Inspect all suspension component fasteners for looseness and proper torque.
14. Inspect all ball joints and all steering linkage for looseness and any sign of wear or damage.
15. Inspect the rubber bushings on all the suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any bush-
ings show signs of wear or deterioration, they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
16. Check vehicle curb height.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Tire Wear
Inspect the following for accurate tire wear:
• Check the depth of tire remaining tread.
• Standard tire: not less than 1.6 mm.
• Snow tire: 50% tire tread.
If the tread is below the specifications, the tire should be replaced.
10
BESM100022
Operation
CAUTION:
Do not twist the inner tie rod-to-steering gear boot (bellows) while turning the inner tie rod during
front Toe-in adjustment. It may be necessary to remove the clamp where the boot meets the inner
tie rod.
10
BESM100031
• Make sure the inner tie rod-to-steering gear boot is not twisted. If removed, reinstall the clamp where the boot
meets the inner tie rod.
• Remove the alignment equipment.
• Road test the vehicle to verify the steering wheel is straight and the vehicle does not pull or wander.
Operation
Rear Wheel Toe-in Adjustment
• While holding the cam bolt stationary, loosen the
lower control arm mounting cam nut (1).
• Rotate the cam bolt head left or right until the
rear wheel Toe-in for that rear wheel is set to the
preferred specification.
• While holding the cam bolt head stationary,
tighten the Toe-in link mounting cam bolt to the
specified torque.
LTSM100063
LTSM100062
10
Tire Identification
• Tire type, size, load index and speed rating are encoded in the letters and numbers imprinted on the side wall
of the tire.
Spare Tire
• A full size spare tire and wheel assembly is standard equipment on this vehicle. The original tire should be
repaired or replaced at the first opportunity, then reinstalled.
Operation
Driving habits have more effect on tire life than any other factor. Careful drivers will obtain, in most cases, much
greater mileage than severe use or careless drivers. A few of the driving habits which will shorten the life of any tire
are:
• Rapid acceleration
• Severe application of brakes
• High-speed driving
• Taking turns at excessive speeds
• Striking curbs and other obstacles
• Operating vehicle with over or under inflated tire pressures
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Tire Specifications
NOTE :
Balance equipment must be calibrated and maintained per equipment manufacturer’s specifications.
NOTE :
Tread wear indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread grooves. When tread depth is 1.6 mm, the tread wear
indicators will appear as a band. Tire replacement is necessary when indicators appear in two or more grooves or if
localized balding occurs.
Replacement Procedure
Note the following guidelines when replacing a tire:
• It is recommended that tires equivalent to the original equipment tires be used when replacement is needed.
• Failure to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the safety and handling of the vehicle.
• The use of tires smaller than the minimum tire size approved for the vehicle can result in tire overloading and
failure.
• Use tires that have the approved load rating for the vehicle and never overload them.
• Failure to equip the vehicle with tires having adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire failure and
loss of vehicle control.
• The use of oversize tires may cause interference with vehicle components. Under extremes of suspension and
steering travel, interference with vehicle components may cause tire damage.
Perform the following when replacing a tire: 10
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assembly.
3. Deflate the tire completely before removing the tire from the wheel.
4. Use lubrication such as a mild soap solution when dismounting or mounting tire.
5. Replace the tire with a tire approved for the vehicle.
6. Use tools free of burrs or sharp edges which could damage the tire or wheel rim.
7. Before mounting tire on wheel, make sure all rust is removed from the rim bead and repaint if necessary.
8. Install the tire and wheel assembly and install the wheel mounting nuts.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
Repair Procedure
Note the following guidelines when performing a tire repair:
• For proper repairing, a radial tire must be removed from the wheel.
• Repairs should only be made if the defect, or puncture, is in the tread area.
• The tire should be replaced if the puncture is located in the sidewall.
Perform the following when repairing a tire:
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assembly.
3. Deflate the tire completely before removing the tire from the wheel.
4. Use lubrication such as a mild soap solution when dismounting or mounting tire.
5. Repair the tire only if the defect, or puncture, is in the tread area.
6. Use tools free of burrs or sharp edges which could damage the tire or wheel rim.
7. Before mounting tire on wheel, make sure all rust is removed from the rim bead and repaint if necessary.
8. Install the tire and wheel assembly and install the wheel mounting nuts.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
Wheel Assembly
Description
Original equipment wheels are designed for operation up to the specified maximum vehicle capacity.
Inspect wheels for the following:
• Dents or cracks
• Damaged wheel bolt holes
• Air leaks from any area or surface of the rim
• Excessive run out
NOTE :
Do not attempt to repair a wheel by hammering, heating or welding.
NOTE :
The wheel nuts are designed for specific applications. Do not use replacement bolts with a different design or lesser
quality.
LTSM100053
Wheel Balance
Description
Balance the tire and wheel assembly as necessary following the wheel balancer manufacturer’s instructions.
• Road test the vehicle for at least 5 miles.
• If the vibration persists, continue with Diagnosis & Testing procedure.
NOTE :
• Balance equipment must be calibrated and maintained per equipment manufacturer’s specifications.
• Wheel weight must fit the rim.
CAUTION:
Use caution not to damage wheel weights dur-
ing tire and wheel installation.
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly and install the
wheel mounting nuts.
10
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
Tire Rotation
Description
Tires on the front and rear operate at different loads
and perform different steering, driving, and braking BESM100020
functions. For these reasons they wear at unequal rates and tend to develop irregular wear patterns. These effects
can be reduced by rotating the tires at regular intervals.
The benefits of tire rotation are:
• Increase tread life
• Maintain traction levels
• A smooth, quiet ride
Non-Directional Tires
BESM100021
The suggested method of tire rotation is shown. Other rotation methods can be used, but they will not provide all the
tire longevity benefits.
NOTE : 10
Only the four-tire rotation method may be used if the vehicle is equipped with a compact or temporary spare tire.
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assembly.
3. Rotate the tire to the desired location.
CAUTION:
Use caution not to damage wheel weights during tire and wheel installation.
4. Install the tire and wheel assembly and install the wheel mounting nuts.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
Directional Tires
Some vehicles may be fitted with special high-performance tires having a directional tread pattern. These tires are
designed to improve traction on wet pavement. To obtain the full benefits of this design, the tires must be installed so
that they rotate in the correct direction. This is indicated by arrows on the tire sidewalls. When being installed, extra
care is needed to ensure that this direction of rotation is maintained.
1. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assembly.
2. Rotate the tire to the desired location.
CAUTION:
Use caution not to damage wheel weights during tire and wheel installation.
3. Install the tire and wheel assembly and install the wheel mounting nuts.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
STEERING SYSTEM
GENERAL INFORMATION 11-2 Fluid Troubleshooting Chart 11-5
Description 11-2
Operation 11-2 ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 11-6
Specifications 11-3
Power Steering Filling and Flushing 11-6
Special Tools 11-3
Filling 11-6
Flushing 11-6
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING 11-4
Inspection 11-7
Power Steering Troubleshooting Chart 11-4
11
LTSM110003
The power steering pump is a constant flow rate and displacement vane type pump. The pump reservoir supplies
fluid to the pump body. The pump is connected to the steering by the pressure and return hoses. The steering gear
used is a rack and pinion type gear.
The power steering system consists of these major components:
• Power steering fluid reservoir (1)
• Power steering fluid pressure hose bracket (2)
• Power steering fluid pressure hose (3)
• Power steering gear assembly (4)
• Power steering fluid return hose (5)
• Power steering pump (6)
Operation
Turning of the steering wheel is converted into linear travel through the meshing of the helical pinion teeth with the
rack teeth within the steering gear. The lateral travel pushes and pulls the tie rods to change the direction of the
vehicle’s front wheels.
Power assist steering is provided by a belt driven rotary type pump. It directs fluid through power steering fluid hoses
to the power steering gear where it is used to assist the driver’s turning effort.
Manual steering control of the vehicle can be maintained if power steering assist is lost. However, under this condi-
tion, steering effort is significantly increased.
WARNING!
Power steering fluid, engine parts and exhaust system may be extremely hot if engine has been running. Do not
start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses. Do not allow hoses to touch hot exhaust manifold or cata-
lyst. Fluid level should be checked with the engine off to prevent personal injury from moving parts.
Specifications
Fluid Specifications
Special Tools
11
NOTE :
If the steering fluid is extremely foamy or milky looking, allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat the
procedure.
Flushing
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Siphon out the contaminated power steering fluid from the power steering liquid reservoir.
3. Remove the return hose clamp (1) from the steer-
ing liquid reservoir and insert the end of the hose
into a container.
LTSM110042
4. Insert the power steering fluid return hose into a container for the discharged power steering fluid.
5. Start the engine and idle.
6. Fill the power steering fluid reservoir.
7. When the return hose discharges the clean steering fluid. Stop engine and install the return hose.
8. Slowly turn the steering wheel right and left, lightly contacting the wheel stops for several times.
9. Approximately 1.1 L of power steering fluid should be needed until the liquid reservoir is rinsed clean.
Inspection
1. If the power steering fluid level is low, inspect the entire power steering system for potential leaks.
CAUTION:
DO NOT run a vehicle with foamy steering fluid for an extended period. This may cause pump dam-
age.
2. Inspection of Liquid Level
• Park the vehicle at a horizontal and level road, and then start the engine. After that, turn the steering wheel for
several times to heat the steering fluid to 50 - 60°C.
• When the engine is running, turn the steering wheel left and right to the limit position and repeat this operation
for several times.
• Check the steering fluid reservoir to see whether there are foams or presents milk-like material and check the
liquid level difference when the engine is off (2)
and running (1). If liquid level variation exceeds
over 5 mm, the air shall be exhausted.
LTSM110030
11
11
LTSM110004
Operation
The steering column is the mechanical linkage between the steering wheel and the steering gear. The steering col-
umn shaft then connects the steering column to the steering gear. The tilt function of the steering column is con-
trolled by a mechanical lever on the underside of the steering column, which uses a cam to lock and unlock the
steering column.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tool
11
NOTE :
When reconnecting spiral cable, fix cable with a tape so that fixing case and rotating part keep aligned. this will omit
neutral position alignment procedure during spiral cable installation.
1. Set the front wheels to straight-ahead position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the driver airbag (See Driver Airbag Removal & Installation in Section 14 Restraints).
4. Disconnect the spiral cable electrical connector.
5. Remove the steering wheel lock nut.
(Tighten: Steering wheel lock nut to 25 - 30 N·m)
6. Using the steering wheel puller, remove the steer-
ing wheel.
LTSM110037
Installation Notes:
• The spiral cable could be damaged if installed in an improper position.
• Do not rotate the spiral cable quickly or beyond the limit of turns (this can cause the cable to snap).
• Verify the airbag system is operating properly after the repair is complete.
Inspection
1. Inspection of Steering Wheel Play
• Keep the front wheel straightly facing forward when the engine is working (hydraulic system is working).
• Slightly turn steering wheel to the right and left, and before the steering wheel begins turning, measure the free
play of steering wheel circle.Limit value: 40 mm.
LTSM110025
• If the free play exceeds limit value, inspect the gap of steering shaft joint and steering linkage, finally rectify or
replace related spare parts according to certain circumstances. If the free play still exceeds limit value, turn
steering wheel right ahead when engine stops, finally apply 5 N·m load to the steering wheel circle and inspect
the free play again.(Standard value (steering wheel free play when engine stops) : less than 15 mm.)
• If free play exceeds standard value, dismount steering gear housing and inspect the gross torque of pinion
gear.
2. Inspection of Static Steering Force
• Park the vehicle at a level road, and turn the steering wheel right ahead. Start the engine, adjust engine speed
to 1000 ± 100 r/min.
CAUTION:
After examining the engine speed, by all means return it back to standard idle speed.
• Connect a spring balance to the outer circle of steering wheel, then measure the steering force required when
turning the steering wheel leftward and rightward (within 1.5 circles) at dead-ahead position. Additionally, the
required steering force shall also be inspected to see whether there exists obvious fluctuation.(Standard steering
force: less than 34 N·m)(Fluctuation tolerance: less than 5.9 N·m) 11
• If the measured force exceeds standard value, please refer to trouble shooting section for inspection and
adjustment.
3. Inspection of the Performance of Steering Wheel Returning Back to the Center
NOTE: This test shall be performed during road performance test and inspect the following contents:
• Make smooth turn and sharp turn, then check the driving ⬙sense⬙ to ensure there is no difference between left
and right turning in terms of steering force and steering wheel returning center.
• When vehicle speed is between 20 to 30 km/h, turn the steering wheel by 90°, after 1 or 2 seconds and
release the steering wheel. If steering wheel subse-
quently returns over 70°, the returning function can
be deemed as all right.
LTSM110029
NOTE :
Remark: when rapidly turning the steering wheel, there will be a transient sense of “heavy”, however, this does not
indicate it is abnormal (this is because of insufficient steering fluid supply of steering fluid pump during the period of
idle speed).
NOTE :
To help maintain alignment of the spiral cable connector during reassembly, apply a small piece of tape to the spiral
cable and the steering column to keep them in alignment.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the driver airbag (See Driver Airbag Removal & Installation in Section 14 Restraints).
3. Remove steering wheel (See Steering Wheel Removal & Installation in Section 11 Steering).
4. Remove 3 steering shroud retaining bolts (1).
(Tighten: Steering shroud bolts to 8 N·m)
LTSM110031
Installation Notes:
• Verify the airbag system is operating properly after the repair is complete.
Steering Column
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the Steering shroud (See Steering Shroud Removal & Installation in Section 11 Steering).
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connect and remove the multi-function switch.
4. Disconnect the wiper and washer switch electrical connect and remove the wiper and washer switch.
LTSM110041
LTSM110046
11
LTSM150088
LTSM110020
LTSM110033
LTSM110021
LTSM110008
Installation Notes:
• Check the steering shaft and universal joint for damage or wear. Check the clearance of universal joint and
replace if necessary.
• Check the steering column seal cover. The distance to the groove button should be less than 1.00 mm, replace
if necessary.
• Verify the airbag system is operating properly after the repair is complete.
11
NOTE :
The power steering gear should not be serviced or adjusted. If a malfunction or steering fluid leak occurs with the
steering gear, the complete steering gear needs to be replaced.
Operation
The steering wheel turns the pinion. The rack is a ling, flat bar teeth on one side. The rack teeth mesh with the teeth
on the pinion. Rotation of the pinion moves the rack from left to right and right to left. The tie rod then causes the
wheels to turn to the left or right.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tool
LTSM110036
WARNING!
Before servicing the steering system, the airbag system must be disarmed. Failure to do so may result in acci-
dental deployment of the airbag and possible personal injury (See Airbag System Disarming Procedure in Sec-
tion 14 Restraints).
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-10002 - Ball Joint Separator
1. Siphon out as much power steering fluid as possible from the reservoir.
2. Raise and support the vehicle.
3. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assembly from both sides.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
4. Remove the return hose clamp (1) from the steer-
ing liquid reservoir and insert the end of the hose
into a container.
LTSM110042
5. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock until all power steering fluid has been drained from
the system.
6. Stop the engine.
LTSM110007
11
LTSM110008
LTSM110034
LTSM100024
LTSM100044
14. Using a jack, slowly lower the sub-frame enough to access the intermediate shaft coupling at the steering gear
pinion shaft.
15. Remove the steering gear assembly.
16. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• After install the steering gear complete the wheel alignment.
LTSM110022
WARNING!
Before servicing the steering system, the airbag system must be disarmed. Failure to do so may result in acci-
dental deployment of the airbag and possible personal injury (See Airbag System Disarming Procedure in Sec-
tion 14 Restraints).
NOTE :
The following special tools are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-10002 - Ball Joint Separator 11
1. Siphon out as much power steering fluid as possible from the reservoir.
2. Raise and support the vehicle.
3. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assemblies from both sides.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
4. Remove the return hose clamp (1) from the steer-
ing liquid reservoir and insert the end of the hose
into a container.
LTSM110042
5. Start the engine, and turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock until all power steering fluid has been drained
from the system.
6. Stop the engine.
LTSM110007
LTSM110008
LTSM110034
LTSM110040
11
LTSM100044
14. Using a jack, slowly lower the sub-frame enough to access the intermediate shaft coupling at the steering gear
pinion shaft.
15. Remove the steering gear assembly.
16. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• After install the steering gear complete the wheel alignment.
Tie Rod
Removal & Installation
NOTE :
The following special tool are required to perform the repair procedure:
• CH-10002 - Ball Joint Separator
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the tire and wheel assembly.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
3. Loosen the tie rod jam nut (1).
(Tighten: Tie rod jam nut to 15 N·m)
4. Remove the nut attaching the outer tie rod end to
the steering knuckle.
(Tighten: Outer tie rod end nut to 32 - 38 N·m)
5. Using special tool CH-10002, separate the outer tie
rod end from the steering knuckle.
LTSM110034
6. Remove the outer tie rod end from the steering rack.
NOTE :
When removing the outer tie rod end, count the number of revolutions when removing. This will aid in installation,
getting the toe setting close to where it needs to be when setting the final toe-in wheel alignment.
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• After installing the new tie rod end, perform a front end alignment procedure to reset the toe-in (See Front
Wheel Alignment in Section 10 Suspension).
Inspection
1. Apply special tool CH - 10002 to disconnect steer-
ing tie rod and knuckle.
LTSM110027
LTSM110028
11
Operation
The power steering pump is mounted to the engine and driven by the engine accessory drive belt. Power steering
fluid enters the pump from the reservoir. The power steering fluid is then trapped between the pump vanes and
moved to the high-pressure side of the pump creating a flow of steering fluid. The restriction of this flow by the
steering gear creates the pressure that provides the steering assist.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Fluid Specifications
11
CAUTION:
Low steering fluid level will damage to power steering system.
CAUTION:
Do not excessive turn the steering wheel more than 3s. It will damage to power steering system.
BESM110011
11
LTSM110045
LTSM110042
4. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock until all power steering fluid has been drained from
the system.
5. Stop the engine.
6. Remove the engine lower shield.
7. Loosen the power steering pump belt adjustment
bolt (1).
LTSM020185
LTSM110032
LTSM110009
11. Remove the two bolts (1) on the other side of the
power steering pump.
(Tighten: Power steering pump bolts to 20 - 30
N·m)
LTSM110010
Installation Notes:
• Fill the power steering reservoir to the proper level.
• Check the system for leaks. 11
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Removal & Installation
1. Siphon as much steering fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir.
2. Remove the hose clamps (1) securing the return
hose and the supply hose to the steering fluid res-
ervoir fitting.
LTSM110038
LTSM110039
Installation Notes:
• Fill the power steering reservoir to the proper level.
• Check the system for leaks.
Power Steering Pressure and Return Hoses - 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L
Removal & Installation
1. Siphon as much steering fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir.
2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the hose clamps securing the return hose and the supply hose to the steering fluid reservoir fitting.
4. Remove the high pressure (1) and low pressure
lines (2) from the power steering pump (drain
steering fluid from lines).
(Tighten: High pressure line to power steering
pump 40 - 50 N·m)
(Tighten: Low pressure line to power steering pump
40 - 50 N·m)
BESM110011
LTSM110007
11
BESM110013
Installation Notes:
• Fill the power steering reservoir to the proper level.
• Check the system for leaks.
LTSM110038
LTSM110032
LTSM110007
Installation Notes:
• Fill the power steering reservoir to the proper level.
• Check the system for leaks.
11
BASE BRAKES
GENERAL INFORMATION 12-2 Front Brake Caliper 12-18
Description 12-2 Description 12-18
Operation 12-3 Operation 12-19
Specifications 12-4 Removal & Installation 12-19
Special Tools 12-5 Rear Brake Caliper 12-20
Electrical Schematics 12-6 Description 12-20
Operation 12-20
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING 12-7 Removal & Installation 12-20
Diagnostic Help 12-7
Brake Noise 12-7 Front Brake Rotor 12-21
Braking Concerns 12-8 Removal & Installation 12-21
Inspection 12-21
ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 12-9 Rear Brake Rotor 12-22
Brake Bleeding Procedure 12-9 Removal & Installation 12-22
Brake Bleeding Information 12-9 Inspection 12-22
Brake Bleeding Procedure 12-9 Rear Brake Backing Plate 12-23
Manual Bleeding 12-9 Removal & Installation 12-23
Pressure Bleeding 12-10 12
Front Brake Pads 12-24
Master Cylinder - LHD 12-11 Removal & Installation 12-24
Description 12-11 Inspection 12-25
Operation 12-11
Removal & Installation 12-11 Rear Brake Pads 12-25
Removal & Installation 12-25
Master Cylinder - RHD 12-12 Inspection 12-26
Description 12-12
Operation 12-13 UNIT REPAIR 12-27
Removal & Installation 12-13
Front Brake Caliper 12-27
Power Brake Booster - LHD 12-14 Disassemble 12-27
Description 12-14 Inspection 12-28
Operation 12-14 Assemble 12-28
Removal & Installation 12-14
Rear Brake Caliper 12-30
Power Brake Booster - RHD 12-16 Disassemble 12-30
Description 12-16 Inspection 12-31
Operation 12-16 Assemble 12-32
Removal & Installation 12-16
LTSM120001
The front disc brake assembly consists of the following major components:
• Caliper
• Caliper adapter bracket
• Brake pads
• Rotor
LTSM120002
The rear disc brake assembly consists of the following major components:
• Caliper
• Caliper adapter bracket
• Brake pads
• Rotor
• Parking brake shoes
CAUTION:
• Use DOT 4 brake fluid or equivalent from a tightly sealed container. Do not use petroleum-based
12
fluids, which would cause seal damage in the brake system.
• Brake fluid will damage painted surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled on any painted surfaces, wash
it off immediately with water.
• Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, motor oil, transmission fluid, or any fluid containing min-
eral oil to clean system components. These fluids damage rubber cups and seals.
• During service procedures, grease or any other foreign material must be kept off the caliper
assembly, brake linings, brake rotor and external surfaces of the hub.
• When handling the brake rotor and caliper, be careful to avoid damaging the brake rotor and
caliper, and scratching or nicking the brake shoe lining.
Operation
Applying the brake pedal uses lever action to push a rod into the brake booster, which through the use of vacuum,
boosts the force of the rod and then transmits this force into the master cylinder. This produces hydraulic pressure in
the master cylinder. On vehicles not equipped with ABS, the hydraulic pressure is transmitted by brake fluid through
the brake tubes to the individual brake calipers or wheel cylinders. On vehicles equipped with ABS, the hydraulic
pressure is transmitted by brake fluid through the brake tubes to the ABS hydraulic control unit (HCU), which then
distributes that pressure to the individual brake calipers and wheel cylinders. The brake calipers use hydraulic pres-
sure to apply the brake pads. The application of the brake pads or shoes will cause the rotation of the wheels to slow
or stop depending on how much brake pressure is applied. The parking brakes carry out the same function except
that they are mechanically actuated by a cable that connects only to the rear brakes.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Rotor Specifications
Front Brake
APPLICATION SPECIFICATION
Piston Diameter Of Brake Caliper 57 mm
Brake Rotor Diameter 265 mm
Min. Thickness Of Brake Rotor 23 mm
Brake Disc Thickness (New) 25 mm
Maximum Jump 0.1 mm
Thickness Of Front Brake Lining 17.8 mm
Thickness Of Rear Brake Pad 14 mm
Rear Brake
APPLICATION SPECIFICATION
Nominal Brake Rotor Diameter 303 mm
Brake Rotor Thickness 9 mm
Min. Thickness Of Brake Rotor 7 mm
Thickness Of Brake Pad 15 mm
Min. Thickness Of Brake Pad 7 mm
Thickness Of Brake Lining 2.5 mm
Min. Thickness Of Brake Lining 1.5 mm
Special Tools
Dial Indicator
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
12
Electrical Schematics
Brake System (Page 1 of 1)
LTSMW120017T
NOTE :
The brake reservoir fluid level will decrease in proportion to normal lining wear.
NOTE :
Brake fluid tends to darken over time. This is normal and should not be mistaken for contamination.
Preliminary Brake Check:
• Check the condition of the tires and wheels. Damaged wheels and worn, damaged or under inflated tires can
cause a pull, shudder, vibration and a condition similar to brake grab.
• If a complaint was based on noise while braking, check the suspension components. Jounce the front and the
rear of vehicle and listen for anything that might be caused by a loose, worn or damaged suspension or steer-
ing component.
• Inspect the brake fluid level and condition.
1. If the fluid level is abnormally low, look for any evidence of leaks at the calipers, brake lines, master cyl-
inder and at the Antilock Brake System (ABS) Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU).
2. If the fluid appears to be contaminated, drain a sample to examine.
• The system will have to be flushed if the fluid is separated into layers, or contains a substance other than
brake fluid. The system seals, cups, hoses, master cylinder and HCU will also have to be replaced after flush-
ing. Use clean brake fluid to flush the system.
• Check the parking brake operation. Verify free movement and full release of the cables and the lever. Also note
if the vehicle was being operated with the parking brake partially applied.
• Check the brake pedal operation. Verify that the pedal does not bind and has adequate free play. If the pedal
lacks free play, check the pedal and the power booster for looseness or for a binding condition. DO NOT road
test the vehicle until the condition is located and corrected.
• Check the vacuum booster check valve and vacuum supply hose.
• If the preliminary checks appear to be OK, road test the vehicle.
Brake Noise
Braking Concerns
CAUTION:
Before removing the master cylinder cap, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter
from dropping into the master cylinder reservoir. Use brake fluid or an equivalent from a fresh,
tightly sealed container. Brake fluid must conform to DOT 4 specifications.
NOTE :
During the brake bleeding procedure, be sure the brake fluid level remains close to the ⬙MAX⬙ level in the master
cylinder fluid reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add brake fluid as
required.
NOTE :
Do not pump the brake pedal at any time while having a bleeder screw open during the bleeding process. This will
only increase the amount of air in the system and make additional bleeding necessary. Do not allow the master
cylinder reservoir to run out of brake fluid while bleeding the system. An empty reservoir will allow additional air into
the brake system. Check the fluid level frequently and add fluid as needed. The following wheel circuit sequence for
bleeding the brake hydraulic system should be used to ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic
system.
Manual Bleeding
NOTE :
To bleed the brakes manually, the aid of a helper will be required.
Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the proper level with brake fluid.
NOTE :
Never allow the brake master cylinder to empty of brake fluid while bleeding the brake system.
Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and
feed the hose into a clear jar containing enough fresh
brake fluid to submerge the end of the hose.
BESM120001
1. Turn the ignition switch off.
2. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position.
3. With the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least one full turn.
4. Once the brake pedal has dropped, close the bleeder screw. After the bleeder screw is closed, release the
brake pedal.
5. Repeat the above steps until all trapped air is removed from that wheel circuit (usually four or five times).
6. Bleed the remaining wheel circuits in the same manner until all air is removed from the brake system. Monitor
the fluid level in the master cylinder reservoir to make sure it does not go dry.
7. Check and adjust brake fluid level to the ⬙MAX⬙ mark.
8. Check the brake pedal travel. If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air may still be
trapped in the system. Re-bleed the brakes as necessary.
9. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Pressure Bleeding
NOTE :
Follow pressure bleeder manufacturer’s instructions for use of pressure bleeding equipment.
Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the proper level with brake fluid.
Attach the pressure bleeding equipment to the master cylinder.
NOTE :
Never allow the brake master cylinder to empty of brake fluid while bleeding the brake system.
Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and
feed the hose into a clear jar containing enough fresh
brake fluid to submerge the end of the hose.
BESM120001
1. Turn the ignition switch off.
2. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain a steady stream of brake fluid.
3. After approximately 120–240 ml of fluid have been bled through the brake circuit and an air-free flow is main-
tained in the clear plastic hose and jar, close the bleeder screw.
4. Repeat this procedure at all the remaining bleeder screws.
5. Check and adjust brake fluid level to the ⬙MAX⬙ mark on the reservoir.
6. Check the brake pedal travel. If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air may still be
trapped in the system. Re-bleed the brakes as necessary.
7. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Operation
When the brake pedal is pressed, the master cylinder pistons apply brake pressure through the chassis brake tubes
to each brake assembly. The brake fluid reservoir supplies the brake hydraulic system with the necessary fluid to
operate properly.
BESM120006
BESM120007
8. Clean the area around where the master cylinder attaches to the power brake booster using a suitable brake
cleaner such as Brake Parts Cleaner or an equivalent.
9. Disconnect the brake tubes (1) and remove the
nuts (2) attaching the master cylinder to the power
brake booster.
(Tighten: Master cylinder mounting nuts to 23 N·m)
LTSM120041
LTSM120005
NOTE :
After installation, bleed the master cylinder or bleed the entire brake system as necessary.
Operation
When the brake pedal is pressed, the master cylinder pistons apply brake pressure through the chassis brake tubes
to each brake assembly. The brake fluid reservoir supplies the brake hydraulic system with the necessary fluid to
operate properly.
BESM120006
BESM120007
8. Clean the area around where the master cylinder attaches to the power brake booster using a suitable brake
cleaner such as Brake Parts Cleaner or an equivalent.
LTSM120041
LTSM120005
NOTE :
After installation, bleed the master cylinder or bleed the entire brake system as necessary.
Operation
A vacuum line connects the check valve to engine source vacuum. The booster input rod extends through the dash
panel and connects to the brake pedal.
BESM120009
LTSM120006
12
LTSM120004
BESM120028
Operation
A vacuum line connects the check value to engine source vacuum. The booster input rod extends through the dash
panel and connects to the brake pedal.
BESM120009
LTSM120006
LTSM120004
6. Slide the power brake booster forward until its mounting studs clear the dash panel, then remove it through the
engine compartment.
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
12
LTSM120007
LTSM100008
The calipers are a single piston type. The calipers are free to slide laterally on the anchor, this allows continuous
compensation for lining wear. The calipers are directly bolted to the wheel hub with mounting bolts. The disc brake
rotor dust shield is mounted to the hub.
Operation
When the brakes are applied, fluid pressure is exerted against the caliper piston. The fluid pressure is exerted
equally and in all directions. This means pressure exerted against the caliper piston and within the caliper bores will
be equal. Fluid pressure applied to the pistons is transmitted directly to the inboard brake pad. This forces the pad
lining against the inner surface of the disc brake rotor. At the same time, fluid pressure within the piston bores forces
the caliper to slide inward on the slide pins. This action brings the outboard brake pad lining into contact with the
outer surface of the disc brake rotor.
LTSM120009
5. Remove the front brake hose from the front brake caliper.
(Tighten: Front caliper brake hose to 19 N·m)
6. Remove the front caliper guide pin bolts (1). 12
(Tighten: Front caliper guide pin bolts to 23 N·m)
LTSM120008
7. Slide the front brake caliper from the disc brake adapter bracket and remove.
8. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper.
• After installation bleed the caliper as necessary.
Operation
When the brakes are applied, fluid pressure is exerted against the caliper piston. The fluid pressure is exerted
equally and in all directions. This means pressure exerted against the caliper piston and within the caliper bores will
be equal. Fluid pressure applied to the pistons is transmitted directly to the inboard brake pad. This forces the pad
lining against the inner surface of the disc brake rotor. At the same time, fluid pressure within the piston bores forces
the caliper to slide inward on the slide pins. This action brings the outboard brake pad lining into contact with the
outer surface of the disc brake rotor.
LTSM120017
Installation Notes:
• Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper.
• After installation bleed the caliper as necessary.
LTSM120022
Inspection
Excessive runout or wobble in a rotor can increase pedal travel due to piston knock-back. This increases guide pin
sleeve wear due to the tendency of the caliper to follow the rotor wobble.
BESM120004
CAUTION:
Do not machine the rotor if it will cause the rotor to fall below minimum thickness.
Rotor Runout
1. Install standard wheel mounting nuts, flat side to
rotor, on all the wheel studs (2). Progressively
tighten the nuts in a crisscross pattern to 110 N·m.
2. Mount a dial indicator (1), with wheel, or equiva-
lent, to the knuckle. Position the dial indicator
wheel to contact the rotor braking surface approxi-
mately 10 mm from the outer edge of the rotor.
3. Slowly rotate the brake rotor (3) checking lateral
runout, marking the low and high spots. Record
these measurements.
4. Check and record the runout on the opposite side
of the rotor in the same fashion, marking the low
and high spots.
5. Compare runout measurement to specification.
6. If runout is in excess of specifications, check the
LTSM120042
lateral runout of the hub face.
LTSM120043
Inspection
Excessive runout or wobble in a rotor can increase pedal travel due to piston knock-back. This increases guide pin
sleeve wear due to the tendency of the caliper to follow the rotor wobble.
BESM120004
CAUTION:
Do not machine the rotor if it will cause the rotor to fall below minimum thickness.
Rotor Runout
1. Install standard wheel mounting nuts, flat side to rotor, on all the wheel studs. Progressively tighten the nuts in
a crisscross pattern to 110 N·m.
2. Mount a dial indicator, with wheel, or equivalent, to
the knuckle. Position the dial indicator wheel to
contact the rotor braking surface approximately 10
mm from the outer edge of the rotor.
3. Slowly rotate the brake rotor checking lateral
runout, marking the low and high spots. Record
these measurements.
4. Check and record the runout on the opposite side
of the rotor in the same fashion, marking the low
and high spots.
5. Compare runout measurement to specification.
6. If runout is in excess of specifications, check the
lateral runout of the hub face.
LTSM120036
12
MINIMUM ROTOR
BRAKE ROTOR ROTOR THICKNESS ROTOR DIAMETER
THICKNESS
Rear Rotor 9 mm 7 mm 303 mm
LTSM120024
BESM120034
NOTE :
In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the cal-
iper piston in its bore a small amount in order to pro-
vide sufficient clearance between the pads and the
rotor.
3. Remove the front caliper guide pin bolts (1) and
(3).
(Tighten: Front caliper guide pin bolts to 23 N·m)
4. Remove the disc brake caliper (2) from the disc
brake adapter bracket and hang it out of the way
using wire. Use care not to over extend the brake
hose when doing this.
BESM120031
5. Remove the inboard brake pad from the caliper adapter bracket.
6. Remove the outboard brake pad from the caliper by prying the brake pad retaining clip over the raised area on
the caliper. Slide the brake pad off of the brake caliper.
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Before installing brake pads, completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper.
• After installation and before moving the vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times to set the pads to the
brake rotor.
• Check and adjust the brake fluid level in the reservoir as necessary.
• Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the
brake pads.
• After installation and before moving the vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times to set the pads to the
brake rotor.
Inspection
Visually inspect brake pads for uneven lining wear. Also inspect for excessive lining deterioration. Check the clear-
ance between the tips of the wear indicators (if equipped) on the pads and the brake rotors. If a visual inspection
does not adequately determine the condition of the lining, a physical check will be necessary. To check the amount
of lining wear, remove the disc brake pads from the vehicle. Measure the brake pad minimum thickness. Brake pads
must be replaced when usable material on a brake pad lining measured at its thinnest point measures one millimeter
or less. Replace both disc brake pads (inboard and outboard) at each caliper. It is also necessary to replace the pads
on the opposite side of the vehicle as well as the pads failing inspection to maintain proper braking characteristics.
If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement, be sure to reinstall the brake pads in the original position
from which they were removed.
NOTE :
In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount in order to provide suf-
ficient clearance between the pads and the rotor.
3. Remove the lower rear caliper guide pin bolt (2).
(Tighten: Rear caliper guide pin bolt to 23 N·m)
CAUTION:When moving rear brake caliper
upward, use extreme care not to damage or
overextend the flex hose.
4. Rotate the caliper (1) upward hinging off the upper
12
guide pin bolt. Rotate the caliper upward just
enough to allow brake pad removal.
LTSM120044
LTSM120018
Inspection
Visually inspect brake pads for uneven lining wear. Also inspect for excessive lining deterioration. Check the clear-
ance between the tips of the wear indicators (if equipped) on the pads and the brake rotors. If a visual inspection
does not adequately determine the condition of the lining, a physical check will be necessary. To check the amount
of lining wear, remove the disc brake pads from the vehicle. Measure the brake pad minimum thickness. Brake pads
must be replaced when usable material on a brake pad lining measured at its thinnest point measures one millimeter
or less. Replace both disc brake pads (inboard and outboard) at each caliper. It is also necessary to replace the pads
on the opposite side of the vehicle as well as the pads failing inspection to maintain proper braking characteristics.
If the brake pad assemblies do not require replacement, be sure to reinstall the brake pads in the original position
from which they were removed.
• Under no condition should high pressure air ever be used to remove a piston from a caliper bore. Personal
injury could result from such a practice.
• Do not place face or hands near caliper and piston if using compressed air pressure to remove piston. Do not
use high pressure.
LTSM120011
CAUTION:
Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool
for seal removal. Using such tools can scratch
the bore or leave burrs on the seal groove 12
edges.
LTSM120010
BESM120003
LTSM120021
Inspection
1. Inspect both the piston and bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can usually
be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion using crocus cloth.
2. Remove deposits on the piston using a soft brass wire brush or a rough shop towel. Do not clean piston with a
polishing or emery cloth because this will damage the chrome-plated surface. Replace the piston if the chrome
plated surface is damaged. If the piston is jammed or if the cylinder bores are scored or rusted, replace the
complete brake caliper. Remove small, light rust spots in the cylinder bore with a polishing cloth.
3. Inspect the caliper guide sleeves for smooth oper-
ation. Repair and grease caliper sleeves as
necessary.
LTSM120012
Assemble
NOTE :
• Always have clean hands when assembling a brake caliper.
• Always use fresh, clean brake fluid when assembling a brake caliper.
• Never use an old piston seal.
• Bleed the brakes as necessary.
Perform the following procedure to assemble the brake caliper:
1. Lubricate the caliper piston, piston seals and piston
bore with clean brake fluid.
2. Install the new piston seal into the seal groove.
LTSM120014
NOTE :
Verify seal is fully seated into seal groove and not twisted.
3. Install the new dust boot on the caliper piston and
seat the dust boot lip into the piston groove.
4. Stretch the dust boot rearward to straighten the
boot folds, then move the boot forward until the
fold snaps into place.
LTSM120015
5. Install the piston into the caliper bore and press the
piston down to the bottom of the caliper bore by
hand or with the handle of a hammer.
CAUTION:
When assembling, the force applied to the pis-
ton to seat it in the bore, must be applied uni-
formly to avoid cocking and binding of the
piston.
6. Seat the dust boot in caliper.
7. Install the new caliper bleed screw.
8. Install the caliper (See Front Brake Caliper
Removal & Installation in Section 12 Brakes). LTSM120016
12
• Under no condition should high pressure air ever be used to remove a piston from a caliper bore. Personal
injury could result from such a practice.
• Do not place face or hands near caliper and piston if using compressed air pressure to remove piston. Do not
use high pressure.
LTSM120011
LTSM120010
CAUTION:
Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool for seal removal. Using such tools can scratch the
bore or leave burrs on the seal groove edges.
BESM120003
LTSM120021
Inspection
1. Inspect both the piston and bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can usually
be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion using crocus cloth.
2. Remove deposits on the piston using a soft brass wire brush or a rough shop towel. Do not clean piston with a
polishing or emery cloth because this will damage the chrome-plated surface. Replace the piston if the chrome
plated surface is damaged. If the piston is jammed or if the cylinder bores are scored or rusted, replace the
complete brake caliper. Remove small, light rust spots in the cylinder bore with a polishing cloth. Remove heavy
rust spots in front of the groove for the piston seal using fine-grit emery paper (grit size 380 to 500). 12
3. Inspect the caliper seal rings. Repair the seal rings
as necessary.
LTSM120012
Assemble
NOTE :
• Always have clean hands when assembling a brake caliper.
• Always use fresh, clean brake fluid when assembling a brake caliper.
• Never use an old piston seal.
• Bleed the brakes as necessary.
Perform the following procedure to assemble the brake caliper:
1. Lubricate the caliper piston, piston seals and piston
bore with clean brake fluid.
2. Install the new piston seal into the seal groove.
NOTE :
Verify seal is fully seated into seal groove and not
twisted.
LTSM120014
3. Install the new dust boot on the caliper piston (3)
and seat the dust boot lip into the piston groove.
4. Stretch the dust boot rearward to straighten the
boot folds, then move the boot forward until the
fold snaps into place.
LTSM120015
5. Install the piston into the caliper bore and press the
piston down to the bottom of the caliper bore by
hand or with the handle of a hammer.
LTSM120016
CAUTION:
When assembling, the force applied to the piston to seat it in the bore must be applied uniformly
to avoid cocking and binding of the piston.
6. Seat the dust boot in caliper.
7. Install the new caliper bleed screw.
8. Install the caliper (See Front Brake Caliper Removal & Installation in Section 12 Brakes).
12
LTSM120040
This Antilock Brake System (ABS) uses components of the base brake system, but also features the following com-
ponents:
• Hydraulic Control Unit and Antilock Brake System Module (ABS module)
• Wheel Speed Sensors (wheel speed sensor) - Four sensors (one sensor at each wheel making it a four-chan-
nel system)
The purpose of the ABS is to prevent wheel lockup under braking conditions on virtually any type of road surface.
Antilock braking is desirable because a vehicle that is stopped without locking the wheels retains directional stability
and some steering capability. This allows the driver to retain greater control of the vehicle during braking.
Operation
ABS Braking
• ABS operation is available at all vehicle speeds above 20 km/h. If a wheel locking tendency is detected during
a brake application, the brake system enters the ABS mode. During ABS braking, hydraulic pressure in the four
wheel circuits is modulated to prevent any wheel from locking. Each wheel circuit is designed with a set of
electric solenoids to allow modulation. The system can build and release pressure at each wheel, depending on
signals generated by the wheel speed sensors at each wheel and received at the ABS Module.
• There are a few performance characteristics of the ABS that may at first seem abnormal, but in fact are nor-
mal. These characteristics are described below.
− If the electrical system malfunctions, the Fail-Safe function is activated, the ABS becomes inoperative and
the ABS warning lamp turns on.
− During ABS operation, the brake pedal may vibrate lightly and a mechanical noise may be heard. This is
normal.
− Stopping distance may be longer than that of vehicles without ABS when vehicle drives on rough, gravel, or
snow-covered (fresh, deep snow) roads.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
12
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Electrical Schematics
Antilock Brake System - 1.6L / 1.8L (Page 1 of 3)
LTSMW120019T
12
LTSMW120020T
LTSMW120021T
12
LTSMW120022T
LTSMW120023T
12
LTSMW120024T
Ground Inspection
Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits. Ground connec-
tions are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The corrosion (rust) can become an unwanted
resistance. This added resistance can alter the way a circuit works.
Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground can drastically
affect an electronically controlled circuit. A poor or corroded ground can effect the circuit. Perform the following when
inspecting a ground connection:
1. Remove the ground bolt or screw.
2. Inspect all mating surface for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
3. Clean as required to assure good contact.
4. Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
5. Inspect for ⬙add-on⬙ accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
6. If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure all of the wires
are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are crimped to one eyelet, make
sure no excess wire insulation has been crimped creating a bad ground.
Diagnostic Tools
Diagnostic Scan Tool X-431
Read the following when connecting the X-431 scan tool:
• Connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC) for communication with the vehicle.
• The DLC is located on the driver side compartment under the steering column (it is attached to the instrument
panel and accessible from the driver seat).
• The DLC is rectangular in design and capable of accommodating up to 16 terminals.
• The electrical connector has keying features to allow easy connection.
ABS Hydraulic Control Module Connector Pin-Out Table
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
Front Wheel Speed
1 14 -
Sensor LH +
Front Wheel Speed
2 15 Decelerator Sensor (GND)
Sensor LH -
3 - 16 ABS Lamp
4 Ignition Switch 17 -
Rear Wheel Speed
5 18 Brake Switch
Sensor LH +
Rear Wheel Speed Front Wheel Speed
6 19
Sensor LH - Sensor RH +
Front Wheel Speed
7 Diagnosis Link K 20
Sensor RH -
8 GND (Power) 21 -
Continuous Supply Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
9 22
Voltage (Motor) RH +
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
10 - 23
RH -
11 - 24 GND (Motor)
12 - 25 Continuous Supply Voltage
13 Decelerator Sensor (G) - -
12
12
LTSMW120010T
LTSMW120011T
12
LTSMW120002T
LTSMW120003T
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD120001
Start the engine, raise the speed over 1000 rpm for a few minutes.
Turn ignition switch off.
Measure the voltage drop with the voltmeter at battery positive and negative while crank engine.
Battery voltage should be more than approximate 9 V.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5.
No >> • Charge or replace the battery.
Measure the resistance between ABS module terminal 4 and battery positive.
Continuity should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check fuse.
• Check the harness.
• Check correlative components.
7. CHECK DTC
12
LTSMW120012T
12
LTSMW120004T
NOTE :
Vehicle must be driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for fault setting conditions to be met.
• With the scan tool select: View ABS Data Stream and DTC.
• If the DTC is detected, the DTC condition is current. Go to Diagnostic Procedure Step 1.
• If the DTC is not detected, the DTC condition is intermittent (See DIAGNOSIS & TESTING Diagnostic Help in
Section 12 Brakes).
• Erase all codes and test drive the vehicle to verify the repair is complete.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD120003
Is 2 - 4 V present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace open circuit or short to ground or short to sensor ground.
12
LTSMD120005
LTSMD120004
5. CHECK DTC
12
LTSMW120013T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 12–57
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
LTSMW120005T
NOTE :
Vehicle must be driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for fault setting conditions to be met.
• With the scan tool select: View ABS Data Stream and DTC.
• If the DTC is detected, the DTC condition is current. Go to Diagnostic Procedure Step 1.
• If the DTC is not detected, the DTC condition is intermittent (See DIAGNOSIS & TESTING Diagnostic Help in
Section 12 Brakes).
• Erase all codes and test drive the vehicle to verify the repair is complete.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD120003
Is 2 - 4 V present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace open circuit or short to ground or short to sensor ground.
LTSMD120005
LTSMD120006
5. CHECK DTC
12
LTSMW120014T
12
LTSMW120006T
NOTE :
Vehicle must be driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for fault setting conditions to be met.
• With the scan tool select: View ABS Data Stream and DTC.
• If the DTC is detected, the DTC condition is current. Go to Diagnostic Procedure Step 1.
• If the DTC is not detected, the DTC condition is intermittent (See DIAGNOSIS & TESTING Diagnostic Help in
Section 12 Brakes).
• Erase all codes and test drive the vehicle to verify the repair is complete.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD120003
Is 2 - 4 V present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace open circuit or short to ground or short to sensor ground.
12
LTSMD120005
LTSMD120007
5. CHECK DTC
12
LTSMW120015T
LTSMW120007T
NOTE :
Vehicle must be driven above 40 km/h (25 mph) for fault setting conditions to be met.
• With the scan tool select: View ABS Data Stream and DTC.
• If the DTC is detected, the DTC condition is current. Go to Diagnostic Procedure Step 1.
• If the DTC is not detected, the DTC condition is intermittent (See DIAGNOSIS & TESTING Diagnostic Help in
Section 12 Brakes).
• Erase all codes and test drive the vehicle to verify the repair is complete.
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
12
With the scan tool select: View ABS Data Stream.
With an assistant driving the vehicle, check the following data stream list items while driving the vehicle over 40 km/h
(25 mph).
• Left Front Wheel Speed.
• Right Front Wheel Speed.
• Left Rear Wheel Speed.
• Right Rear Wheel Speed.
With the scan tool, read DTCs in the ABS module.
Does the scan tool display: C1209 - RR WHEEL SENSOR-OPEN OR SHORT TO GROUND?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 4.
LTSMD120003
Is 2 - 4 V present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace open circuit or short to ground or short to sensor ground.
LTSMD120005
LTSMD120008
5. CHECK DTC
12
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check if the ABS module supply voltage circuit, ground circuit open, high resistance or short circuits existing.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair circuit for open or short in harness and connectors.
3. CHECK DTC
CAUTION:
Before removing the master cylinder cap, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter
from dropping into the master cylinder reservoir. Use brake fluid or an equivalent from a fresh,
tightly sealed container. Brake fluid must conform to DOT 4 specifications.
NOTE :
During the brake bleeding procedure, be sure the brake fluid level remains close to the ⬙MAX⬙ level in the master
cylinder fluid reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add brake fluid as
required.
NOTE :
Do not pump the brake pedal at any time while having a bleeder screw open during the bleeding process. This will
only increase the amount of air in the system and make additional bleeding necessary. Do not allow the master
cylinder reservoir to run out of brake fluid while bleeding the system. An empty reservoir will allow additional air into
the brake system. Check the fluid level frequently and add fluid as needed. The following wheel circuit sequence for
bleeding the brake hydraulic system should be used to ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic
system.
NOTE :
Pressure bleeding is recommended to bleed the base brake system to ensure all air is removed from the brake
system.
5. Using the scan tool, access ⬙ABS bleeding⬙ function. Follow the instructions displayed. When finished, discon-
nect the scan tool and proceed.
6. Bleed the base brake system a second time. Check brake fluid level in the reservoir periodically to prevent
emptying, causing air to enter the hydraulic system.
7. Fill the master cylinder fluid reservoir to the ⬙MAX⬙ level.
8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure the brakes are operating correctly and that the brake pedal does not feel
spongy.
NOTE :
The ABS hydraulic control module is comprised of the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) and the Electronic Control Unit
(ECU). These are serviced as a complete unit and cannot be serviced separately.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Turn the ignition switch off.
3. Using a brake pedal holding tool, depress the brake pedal past its first 25 mm of travel and hold it in this posi-
tion. This will isolate the master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to
drain out of the master cylinder reservoir while the lines are disconnected.
4. Remove the brake tubes (1) at the hydraulic con-
trol unit.
(Tighten: Brake tube nuts to 10 N·m)
5. Disconnect the ABS hydraulic control module elec-
trical connector.
6. Remove the mounting bolts attaching the HCU
mounting bracket to vehicle.
(Tighten: ABS mounting bracket bolts to 20 N·m)
LTSM120025
Installation Notes:
• After installation connect the X-431 scan tool to initialize the ABS hydraulic control module and bleed the brake
system (See Antilock Brake System (ABS) Bleeding Procedure in Section 12 Brakes).
LTSM120026
LTSM120027
LTSM120028
5. Remove the rear hub and bearing assembly (See Rear Hub and Bearing Removal & Installation in Section 09
Axle).
6. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor with the rear hub and bearing.
NOTE: The rear wheel speed sensor is integrated into the rear hub and bearing assembly and a one piece
sealed unit.
Operation
All vehicles are equipped with a center-mounted, hand-operated parking brake lever mounted between the front
seats. A tensioner is built into the equalizer mounted on the end of the lever’s output cable. There is an individual
parking brake cable for each rear wheel that joins a parking brake cable equalizer, attached to the parking brake
lever, to the rear parking brakes. The parking brake cables are made of flexible steel cable.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Electrical Schematics
Parking Brake System (Page 1 of 1)
LTSMW120018T
NOTE :
Excessive parking brake lever travel (sometimes described as a loose lever or too loose condition), could be the
result of worn brake shoes, improper brake shoe adjustment, or improperly assembled brake parts. A too loose con-
dition can also be caused by inoperative or improperly assembled parking brake components. Always confirm that the
parking brake components are assembled properly. Perform the following procedure to adjust the parking brake:
1. Verify the parking brake lever is in the released (down) position.
2. Raise and support the vehicle.
3. Remove the wheel mounting nuts and the rear tire and wheel assemblies.
4. Utilizing the access hole in the rotors, adjust the parking brake shoes.
5. Reach inside the vehicle and fully apply and release the parking brake. 12
6. With the parking brake lever in the fully applied (up) position, attempt to rotate the rear rotors by hand (to ensure
that the parking brake shoes are working properly).
7. With the parking brake lever in the released (down) position, attempt to rotate the rear rotors by hand (to ensure
that the parking brake shoes are not dragging).
8. Install both rear tire and wheel assemblies and the wheel mounting nuts.
(Tighten: Wheel mounting nuts to 110 N·m)
9. Tighten or loosen the parking brake adjustment nut
(1) to adjust the parking brake.
LTSM120045
LTSM120031
Installation Notes:
• After installation, adjust the parking brake cable as necessary (See Parking Brake Adjustment in Section 12
Brakes).
12
LTSM120029
1. Remove the handrail case (2).
2. Remove the adjusting bolt (1) of hand brake.
3. Loosen the fixing bolts of right and left cable bracket (3).
4. Remove the hand brake cable (4).
5. Remove the fixing bolts of right and left hand brake cable.
NOTE :
The parking brake shall be adjusted after replacing
brake shoes or hand brake cable.
• Loosen the parking brake handle.
• Forcibly step on brake pedal once.
• Pull the parking brake handle up by four teeth.
• After completing the above procedures, loosen the
parking brake to inspect the two rear wheels to see
whether they can be turned freely. Otherwise the LTSM120030
above process of adjustment shall be repeated.
LTSM120037
BESM120021
Installation Notes:
• Perform the following to measure and adjust parking brake shoes:
1. Using a brake measuring gauge or equivalent, measure the inside diameter of parking brake drum (1).
2. Place the brake measuring gauge over the
parking brake shoes at their widest point.
BESM120024
3. Using the adjuster wheel, adjust the parking brake shoes until the linings on both parking brake shoes just
touch the jaws on the brake measuring gauge.
• After installation, adjust the parking brake cable as
necessary (See Parking Brake Adjustment in Sec-
tion 12 Brakes).
LTSM120039
13
NOTE :
To maintain the performance level of the heating, ventilation and air conditioning (HVAC) system, the engine cooling
system must be properly maintained. Any obstructions in front of the radiator or A/C condenser will reduce the per-
formance of the A/C and engine cooling systems.
LTSM130021
Operation
Outside fresh air enters the vehicle through the cowl top opening at the base of the windshield, and passes through
a plenum chamber to the HVAC housing. Air flow can be adjusted by the blower motor speed switch on the A/C
heater control panel. The fresh air then travels through the evaporator and the heater core then out into the vehicle
through the side and floor vents. It is important to keep the air intake openings clear of debris such as leaf particles
which are small enough to pass through the cowl plenum screen and can accumulate within the HVAC housing. The
A/C compressor can be engaged by pressing the A/C (snowflake) button on the A/C-Heater control panel. It will
automatically engage when the mode control is set in any Mix to Defrost position. This will remove heat and humidity
from the air before it is directed through or around the heater core. The mode control on the A/C-Heater control panel
is used to direct the conditioned air to the selected system outlets.
13
LTSM130020T
Specifications
Torque Specifications
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE A/C HIGH SIDE PRESSURE A/C LOW SIDE PRESSURE
8.4 - 11.9 kgf/cm2 1.9 - 2.1 kgf/cm2
15.5 °C
120 - 170 psi 28 - 31 psi
10.5 - 17.5 kgf/cm2 1.9 - 2.1 kgf/cm2
21.1 °C
150 - 250 psi 28 - 31 psi
12.6 - 19.3 kgf/cm2 1.9 - 2.1 kgf/cm2
26.6 °C
180 - 275 psi 28 - 31 psi
14.0 - 21.8 kgf/cm2 1.9 - 2.1 kgf/cm2
32.2 °C
200 - 310 psi 28 - 31 psi
16.1 - 23 kgf/cm2 1.9 - 2.4 kgf/cm2
37.7 °C
230 - 330 psi 28 - 35 psi
18.9 - 25.3 kgf/cm2 1.9 - 2.6 kgf/cm2
43.3 °C
270 - 360 psi 28 - 38 psi
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
13
Electrical Schematics
Air Conditioner Control - 2.0L & 2.4L (Page 1 of 3)
LTSMW130001T
13
LTSMW130002T
LTSMW130003T
13
LTSMW130004T
LTSMW130005T
13
LTSMW130006T
NOTE :
The discharge air temperatures will be lower if the humidity is less than the percentages shown.
Heater Performance
Engine coolant is delivered to the heater core through heater hoses. With the engine idling at normal operating tem-
perature, set the temperature control knob in the full hot position, the mode control switch knob in the floor heat
position, and the blower motor switch knob in the highest speed position. Using a test thermometer, check the tem-
perature of the air being discharged at the HVAC housing floor outlets. Compare the test thermometer reading to the
heater performance chart.
HEATER PERFORMANCE
Ambient Air
15.5 °C (60 °F) 21.1 °C (70 °F) 26.6 °C (80 °F) 32.2 °C (90 °F)
Temperature
Minimum Air
Temperature at Floor 62.2 °C (144 °F) 63.8 °C (147 °F) 65.5 °C (150 °F) 67.2 °C (153 °F)
Outlet
Both of the heater hoses should be hot to the touch. The coolant return heater hose should be slightly cooler than
the coolant supply heater hose. If the return hose is much cooler than the supply hose, locate and repair the engine
coolant flow obstruction in the cooling system.
Mechanical Problems
Possible locations or causes of insufficient heat:
• An obstructed cowl air intake.
• Obstructed heater system outlets.
• A blend door not functioning properly.
• Trapped air in system.
Temperature Control
If the heater outlet air temperature cannot be adjusted with the temperature control knob(s) on the A/C Heater control
panel, the following could require service:
• The A/C heater control panel.
• The blend door.
• The blend door cable.
• Improper engine coolant temperature.
LTSM130013
LTSM130001
CAUTION:
DONⴕT operate the blower motor with the blower motor resistor removed from the circuit. Failure to
take this precaution can result in vehicle damage.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the glove box (See Instrument Panel Removal & Installation In Section 15 Body & Accessories).
3. Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector.
4. Remove the two bolts (1) attaching the blower
motor resistor to the evaporator housing.
LTSM130002
13
LTSM130019
LTSM130019
13
Operation
The A/C heater control module panel is located on the instrument panel inboard of the steering column and above
the radio. The A/C heater control panel contains a rotary-type temperature control dial (1), a rotary-type mode control
switch dial (3), a rotary-type blower motor speed control switch (2) and an air conditioning compressor push button
switch (6).
LTSM130009
Temperature Control Dial
Increases or decreases the set temperature.
Recirculation Switch
• When the recirculation switch is ON, the switch indicator turns ON, and air inlet is set to recirculation.
• When recirculation switch is OFF, air inlet is set to fresh. The recirculation mode can be re-entered by pressing
the recirculation switch again.
A/C Switch
Controls the A/C compressor ON and OFF function.
13
Air comes from the outlets in Air comes from the floor,
the instrument panel. Each defrost and side window
1. Panel Mode of these outlets can be 4. Defrost & Floor Mode demister outlets. This mode
individually adjusted to direct works best in cold or snowy
the flow of air. conditions.
Air comes from both the Air comes from the
2. Bi-Level Mode instrument panel outlets and windshield and side window
the floor outlets. 5. Defrost Mode demister outlets. Use this
setting when necessary to
Air comes from the floor defrost your windshield and
outlets. A slight amount of air side windows.
3. Floor Mode is directed through the
defrost and side window
demister outlets.
LTSM130012
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
LTSM130003
13
Operation
The A/C system is designed for the use of a non-CFC, R-134a refrigerant and uses an A/C evaporator to cool and
dehumidify the incoming air prior to blending it with the heated air. A temperature control determines the discharge air
temperature by operating the temperature control cable, which moves the blend-air door. This allows an almost
immediate control of the output air temperature of the system. The mode door cable operates the mode-air doors
which direct the flow of the conditioned air out the various air outlets, depending on the mode selected. When
equipped with A/C, the recirculation door actuator operates the recirculation-air door which closes off the fresh air
intake and recirculates the air already inside the vehicle. The electric recirculation door actuator and the blower motor
are connected to the vehicle electrical system by the instrument panel wire harness. The blower motor controls the
velocity of air flowing through the HVAC housing assembly by spinning the blower wheel within the HVAC housing at
the selected speed by use of the blower motor resistor, which is around the blower motor.
The air distribution housing must be removed from the HVAC housing and disassembled for service of the blend-air
and mode-air doors. The air inlet housing must be removed from HVAC housing and disassembled for service of the
recirculation-air door. The HVAC housing must be removed from the vehicle and disassembled for service of the A/C
evaporator.
13
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
13
LTSM130010
3. Remove the instrument panel (See Instrument Panel Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body).
4. Remove the evaporator assembly upper retaining bolts (1).
LTSM130014
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
Blower Motor
Description
The blower motor is mounted in the HVAC housing. The following are blower motor functions:
• The blower motor will operate whenever the ignition switch is in the ON position and the blower motor control
is in any position except Off.
• The blower motor can be accessed for service from underneath the instrument panel.
• The blower motor and blower motor wheel are factory balanced as an assembly and cannot be adjusted or
repaired and must be replaced if found inoperative or damaged.
Operation
The blower motor is used to control the velocity of air moving through the HVAC housing by spinning the blower
wheel within the HVAC air inlet housing at the selected speed. The blower motor is a 12-volt, direct current (DC)
motor mounted within a plastic housing with an integral wire harness connector. The blower wheel is secured to the
blower motor shaft and is positioned within the air inlet housing on the passenger side of the HVAC housing.
13
LTSM130004
13
Operation
High pressure is produced in a refrigerant system when the A/C compressor is operating. Extreme care must be
exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant system connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good
practice to inspect all flexible hose refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and
properly routed. Depending on vehicle, model and market application, refrigerant lines are connected to each other or
other A/C system components with block-type or quick-connect type fittings. To ensure the integrity of the refrigerant
system, O-rings and/or gaskets may be used to seal the refrigerant system connections. The refrigerant lines and
hoses cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
WARNING!
The A/C system contains refrigerant under high pressure. Repairs should only be performed by qualified service
personnel. Serious or fatal injury may result from improper service procedures.
If accidental A/C system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming service. Large amounts of
refrigerant released in a closed work area will displace the oxygen and cause suffocation and serious or fatal
injury.
CAUTION:
Never add R-12 to a refrigerant system designed to use R-134a. Do not use R-12 equipment or
parts on an R-134a A/C system. These refrigerants are not compatible and damage to the A/C sys-
tem will result.
CAUTION:
Never use R-12 refrigerant oil in an A/C system designed to use R-134a refrigerant oil. These refrig-
erant oils are not compatible and damage to the A/C system will result.
CAUTION:
Do not run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present within the A/C
system. Failure to follow this caution will result in serious A/C compressor damage.
CAUTION:
Do not overcharge the refrigerant system. Overcharging will cause excessive compressor head
pressure and can cause compressor noise and A/C system failure.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
13
Temperature Control
If the heater outlet air temperature cannot be adjusted with the temperature control knob(s) on the A/C Heater control
panel, the following could require service:
• The A/C heater control.
• The blend door actuator(s).
• The wire harness circuits for the A/C heater control or the blend door actuator(s).
• The blend door(s).
• Improper engine coolant temperature.
NOTE :
The A/C compressor must be replaced if any unusual noise is heard from the compressor itself.
NOTE :
Drive belts are speed sensitive. At different engine speeds and depending upon drive belt tension, drive belts can
develop noises that are mistaken for an A/C compressor noise. Improper drive belt tension can cause a misleading
noise when the compressor is operating at maximum displacement, which may not occur when the compressor is at
minimum displacement.
1. Select a quiet area for testing.
2. Duplicate the complaint conditions as much as possible.
3. Turn the A/C system On and Off several times to clearly identify any compressor noise.
4. Listen to the A/C compressor while it is operating at maximum and minimum displacement.
5. Probe the A/C compressor with an engine stethoscope or a long screwdriver with the handle held to your ear to
better localize the source of the noise.
6. To duplicate high-ambient temperature conditions (high head pressure), restrict the air flow through the A/C con-
denser. Install a manifold gauge set or a scan tool to be certain that the discharge pressure does not exceed
2600 kPa .
7. Check the condition of the accessory drive belt.
NOTE: The A/C compressor must be replaced if the drive hub is broken or if the compressor shaft does not
rotate smoothly.
8. Check the compressor hub and pulley and bearing assembly. Be certain that the hub and pulley are properly
aligned and that the pulley bearing is mounted securely to the A/C compressor. .
9. Check the refrigerant system plumbing for incorrect routing, rubbing or interference, which can cause unusual
noises. Also check the refrigerant lines and hoses for kinks or sharp bends that will restrict refrigerant flow, which
can cause noises.
10. Loosen all of the compressor mounting hardware and retighten.
CAUTION:Do not run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present within the
A/C system. Failure to follow this caution will result in serious A/C compressor damage.
11. If the noise is from opening and closing of the high pressure relief valve, recover, evacuate and recharge the
refrigerant system, If the high pressure relief valve still does not seat properly, replace the A/C compressor.
12. If the noise is from liquid refrigerant slugging in the A/C suction line, replace the A/C accumulator and check the
refrigerant oil level and the refrigerant system charge.
13. If a slugging condition still exists after replacing the A/C accumulator, then replace the A/C compressor.
NOTE :
If the A/C refrigerant system charge is empty or low, a leak in the A/C system is likely. Inspect all A/C lines, fittings
and components for an oily residue. Oil residue can be an indicator of an A/C system leak location.
NOTE :
The only way to correctly determine if the refrigerant system is fully charged with R-134a is to completely evacuate
and recharge the A/C system.
NOTE :
Special effort must be used to prevent moisture from entering the A/C system oil. Moisture in the oil is very difficult
to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the A/C compressor.
If the refrigerant system has been open to the atmosphere, it must be evacuated before the system can be filled.
Moisture and air mixed with the refrigerant will raise the compressor high pressure above acceptable operating lev-
els. This will reduce the performance of the A/C system and damage the A/C compressor. Moisture will boil at near
room temperature when exposed to vacuum. To evacuate the refrigerant system:
NOTE :
When connecting the service equipment coupling to the line fitting, verify that the valve of the coupling is fully closed.
This will reduce the amount of effort required to make the connection.
1. With the engine OFF, connect a suitable charging station, refrigerant recovery machine or a manifold gauge set
with vacuum pump and refrigerant recovery equipment. Do not operate the engine with a vacuum on the A/C
system.
2. Open the suction and discharge valves and start the vacuum pump. The vacuum pump should run a minimum
of 45 minutes prior to charge to eliminate all moisture in system. When the suction gauge reads to the lowest
degree of vacuum possible for 30 minutes, close all valves and turn off vacuum pump. If the system fails to
reach specified vacuum, the refrigerant system likely has a leak that must be corrected. If the refrigerant system
maintains specified vacuum for at least 30 minutes, start the vacuum pump, open the suction and discharge
valves. Then allow the system to evacuate an additional 10 minutes.
3. Close all valves. Turn off and disconnect the vacuum pump.
4. Charge the refrigerant system.
CAUTION:
A small amount of refrigerant oil is removed from the A/C system each time the refrigerant system
is recovered and evacuated. Before charging the A/C system, you MUST replenish any oil lost dur-
ing the recovery process.
1. With a manifold gauge set and an R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets SAE stan-
dard J2210 connected to the refrigerant system.
2. Open both the suction and discharge valves, then open the charge valve to allow the refrigerant to flow into the
system.
3. When the transfer of refrigerant has stopped, close both the suction and discharge valves.
4. If all of the refrigerant charge did not transfer from the dispensing device, open all of the windows in the vehicle
and set the heating-A/C system controls so that the A/C compressor is operating and the blower motor is running
at its lowest speed setting. Run the engine at a steady high idle (about 1400 RPM).
5. Open the low-side valve to allow the remaining refrigerant to transfer to the refrigerant system.
WARNING!
Take care not to open the discharge (high pressure) valve at this time. Failure to follow this warning could result
in possible personal injury or death.
6. Disconnect the charging station and manifold gauge set from the refrigerant system service ports.
7. Reinstall the caps onto the refrigerant system service ports.
Compressor
Description
Vehicles equipped with the 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L engine use a SD7V16 clutch-less compressor. The 2.4L equipped
vehicles use a V5 clutch-less compressor. The compressor is a variable displacement compressor. The largest dis-
placement is 161.3 ml/r, displacement range of 5% to 100%.
CAUTION:
DONⴕT run the engine with a vacuum pump in operation or with a vacuum present within the A/C
system. Failure to follow this caution will result in serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE :
The compressor drive hub and the pulley and bearing assembly cannot be serviced separately from the A/C com-
pressor. In the event of drive hub or pulley and bearing assembly damage or failure, the A/C compressor, drive hub
and pulley and bearing must be replaced as an assembly.
Operation
The A/C compressor is controlled by the Engine Control Module (ECM), depending on engine application. The ECM
calculates compressor displacement required by A/C system load and demand by monitoring vehicle speed, A/C high
side pressure, engine speed, evaporator temperature, accelerator pedal position, ambient temperature and A/C-
Heater request signals. The ECM then sends a pulse width modulated signal to the A/C compressor control solenoid
to increase or decrease refrigerant flow through an orifice located within the compressor housing. The amount of
refrigerant allowed to pass through the orifice in the compressor determines the head pressure which controls the
angle of the swash plate, which in turn, determines the amount of compressor displacement. When there is no
demand for A/C, the swashplate is adjusted to nearly a zero degree angle, which removes compressor torque drag
from the engine.
NOTE :
The A/C compressor cannot be repaired and it must be replaced if found inoperative or damaged. If an internal fail-
ure of the A/C compressor has occurred, the A/C accumulator and the A/C liquid line must also be replaced.
CAUTION:
The A/C accumulator and the A/C liquid line must be replaced if an internal failure of the A/C com-
pressor has occurred. Failure to replace the A/C accumulator and the A/C liquid line can cause
serious damage to the replacement A/C compressor.
NOTE :
When replacing multiple A/C system components, determine how much oil should be removed from the new A/C
compressor.
NOTE :
Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a refrigerant line is opened. Failure
to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result in a refrigerant system leak.
1. Evacuate the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
2. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
BESM130016
4. Remove the intake manifold (See Intake Manifold Removal & Installation in Section 02 Engine).
5. Remove the A/C compressor line bolt (1) from the
A/C compressor.
(Tighten: A/C compressor line bolts to 20 N·m)
BESM130017
BESM130018
NOTE: After removing the A/C lines, plug the A/C lines to prevent any debris from entering the A/C system.
7. Remove the four A/C compressor bracket bolts.
(Tighten: A/C compressor bracket bolts to 40 N·m)
8. Carefully remove the A/C compressor and bracket assembly.
9. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
LTSM130008
LTSM130006
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
Evaporator
Description
The evaporator core is located in the HVAC housing, under the instrument panel. The evaporator coil is positioned in
the HVAC housing so that all air that enters the housing must pass over the fins of the evaporator before it is dis-
tributed through the system ducts and outlets. However, air passing over the evaporator core fins will only be con-
ditioned when the compressor is engaged and circulating refrigerant through the evaporator coil tubes.
Operation
Refrigerant enters the evaporator from the orifice tube as a low-temperature, low-pressure liquid. As air flows over
the fins of the evaporator, the humidity in the air condenses on the fins, and the heat from the air is absorbed by the
refrigerant. Heat absorption causes the refrigerant to boil and vaporize. The refrigerant becomes a low-pressure gas
before it leaves the evaporator. The evaporator core housing directs airflow from the blower motor through the evap-
orator core and heater core. All airflow from the blower motor passes through the evaporator core. The airflow is then
directed through or around the heater core by the temperature blend door(s).
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
13
Condenser
Description
The condenser is located in the air flow in front of the engine cooling radiator. The condenser transforms the refrig-
erant from a gas into a liquid. It is attached to the vehicle with bolts and the A/C lines with fittings.
Operation
When the heat is removed from the refrigerant, it condenses. When the refrigerant leaves the condenser, it has
become a high-pressure liquid refrigerant. The volume of air flowing over the condenser fins is critical to the proper
cooling performance of the air conditioning system. Therefore, it is important that there are no objects placed in front
of the radiator grille openings in the front of the vehicle or foreign material on the condenser fins that might obstruct
proper air flow. Also, any factory-installed air seals or shrouds must be properly reinstalled following radiator or con-
denser service.
LTSM130005
Installation Notes: 13
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
Accumulator
Description
The accumulator is connected directly between the condenser and the expansion valve. Accumulator is used on sys-
tems that use an orifice tube to meter refrigerants into the evaporator.
Operation
The primary function of the accumulator is to isolate the compressor from any damaging liquid refrigerant. The accu-
mulator removes debris and moisture from the air conditioning system.
LTSM130017
3. Remove the nuts (2) connecting the suction lines to the accumulator.
4. Remove the accumulator mounting bolts (1).
5. Remove the accumulator. Remove and discard the O-ring seals and gaskets.
NOTE: After removing the A/C lines, plug the A/C lines to prevent any debris from entering the A/C system.
6. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
Liquid Line
Description
The A/C liquid line connects the A/C condenser to the A/C evaporator.
Operation
The high pressure A/C liquid line is the refrigerant line that carries refrigerant from the A/C condenser to the A/C
accumulator. Air conditioning hoses are designed to control liquid and gas at high pressures and temperatures. The
hoses are usually flexible and terminated with special metal fittings at the ends to prevent leaks and provide a sure
seal and connection between components.
LTSM130007
3. Remove the bolt (2) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve.
4. Remove the lines retaining bolts (1).
5. Remove the A/C liquid line assembly from the A/C evaporator to compressor and remove and discard the seals.
13
6. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant line fittings and the evaporator ports.
7. Remove the A/C liquid line assembly from accumulator to condenser and from accumulator to evaporator.
8. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
Suction Line
Description
The A/C suction line connects the A/C compressor to the A/C accumulator.
Operation
The low pressure A/C suction line is the refrigerant line that carries refrigerant from the A/C accumulator to the A/C
compressor. Air conditioning hoses are designed to control liquid and gas at high pressures and temperatures. The
hoses are usually flexible and terminated with special metal fittings at the ends to prevent leaks and provide a sure
seal and connection between components.
LTSM130016
3. Remove the bolt (2) that secures the A/C liquid and suction line assembly to the A/C expansion valve.
4. Remove the nuts (1) that connect the suction lines to the A/C accumulator.
5. Remove the lines retaining bolts (3).
6. Remove the nut (1) that connect the suction line to
the A/C compressor.
LTSM130015
7. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant line fittings and the evaporator ports.
8. Remove the A/C suction line assembly from evaporator to compressor.
9. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the refriger-
ant line fittings.
• Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system.
• Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
• Recharge the A/C system (See A/C System Evacuation and Recharge in Section 13 Heating and Air Condition-
ing).
Heater Core
Description
The heater core is located in the HVAC housing. The heater core is a heat exchanger made of rows of tubes with
fins and is positioned within the air distribution housing so that only the selected amount of air entering the housing
passes through the heater core before it is distributed through the heating-A/C system ducts and outlets. One end of
the heater core is fitted with a tank that includes the fittings for the heater core tubes . The heater core can only be
serviced by removing the HVAC housing from the vehicle.
Operation
Engine coolant is circulated through the heater hoses to the heater core at all times. As the coolant flows through the
heater core, heat is removed from the engine and is transferred to the heater core tubes and fins. Air directed
through the heater core picks up the heat from the heater core fins. The blend-air door allows control of the heater
output air temperature by regulating the amount of air flowing through the heater core. The blower motor speed con-
trols the volume of air flowing through the HVAC housing.
Installation Notes:
• Verify the cooling system is filled to proper specifications.
13
AIRBAG SYSTEM
GENERAL INFORMATION 14-2 B1352 - Passenger Airbag Resistance
Description 14-2 Too High Or Open (1St Stage) 14-22
Operation 14-2 B2501 - Warning Lamp Fault-Open 14-28
Specifications 14-2 B2503 - Warning Lamp Fault-Short To
Special Tools 14-3 Ground 14-32
Electrical Schematics 14-4 B2504 - Warning Lamp Fault-Short To
Battery 14-36
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING 14-7 B1620 - Internal Fault - Replace ECU 14-40
Diagnostic Help 14-7
Intermittent DTC Troubleshooting 14-7 ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 14-41
Diagnostic Tools 14-7 Airbag System Disarming Procedure 14-41
Airbag Control Module Connector Pin-Out Description 14-41
Table 14-8
Driver Side Airbag 14-41
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List 14-8 Removal & Installation 14-41
Restraints Control Module DTC List 14-8
Front Passenger Side Airbag 14-42
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests 14-10 Removal & Installation 14-42
B1102 - Battery Voltage Low 14-10
B1346 - Driver Airbag Resistance Too Restraints Control Module 14-43
High Or Open (1St Stage) 14-15 Removal & Installation 14-43
14
Active Restraints
• Front Seat Belts
• Rear Seat Belts
Passive Restraints
• Driver Airbag
• Passenger Airbag
• Seat Belt Tensioners
Operation
Active Restraints
The primary passenger restraints are the seat belts. Seat belts are referred to as an active restraint because the
vehicle occupants are required to physically fasten and properly adjust these restraints in order to benefit from them.
Passive Restraints
The passive restraints are referred to as a supplemental restraint system because they were designed and are
intended to enhance the protection for the occupants of the vehicle only when used in conjunction with the seat belts.
They are referred to as passive restraints because the vehicle occupants are not required to do anything to make
them operate; however, the vehicle occupants must be wearing their seat belts in order to obtain the maximum safety
benefit from the supplemental restraint system.
The supplemental restraint system electrical circuits are continuously monitored and controlled by a microprocessor
and software contained within the Restraints Control Module (RCM). An airbag indicator in the instrument cluster
illuminates for about seven seconds as a bulb test each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON or START posi-
tions. Following the bulb test, the airbag indicator is turned ON or OFF by the RCM to indicate the status of the
supplemental restraint system. If the airbag indicator comes ON at any time other than during the bulb test, it indi-
cates that there is a problem in the supplemental restraint system electrical circuits. Such a problem may cause
airbags not to deploy when required, or to deploy when not required.
Deployment of the supplemental restraints depends upon the angle and severity of an impact. When an impact is
severe enough, the microprocessor in the RCM signals the inflator of the appropriate airbag units to deploy their
airbag cushions. The front seat belt tensioners are provided with a deployment signal by the RCM in conjunction with
the front airbags.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Electrical Schematics
Airbag Control System (Page 1 of 3)
LTSMW140011T
14
LTSMW140009T
LTSMW140010T
Diagnostic Tools
Diagnostic Scan Tool X-431
Read the following when connecting the X-431 scan tool:
• Connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC) for communication with the vehicle.
• The DLC is located on the driver side compartment under the steering column (it is attached to the instrument
panel and accessible from the driver seat).
• The DLC is rectangular in design and capable of accommodating up to 16 terminals.
• The electrical connector has keying features to allow easy connection.
NOTE :
Using the airbag special load tools will help prevent other airbag DTCs from being set while troubleshooting the
system.
Digital Multimeter
Read the following when using the digital multimeter:
• Troubleshoot electrical problems and wiring systems.
• Use a multimeter for basic fault finding and bench testing.
• Use a multimeter to measure voltage, current and resistance.
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
Driver Seatbelt Pre-
1 14 Front Passenger Airbag Lo
tensioner Lo
Driver Seatbelt Pre-
2 15 -
tensioner Hi
Front Passenger Seatbelt
3 16 -
Pre-tensioner Hi
Front Passenger Seatbelt
4 17 -
Pre-tensioner Lo
5 Ignition Switch 18 -
6 GND 19 -
7 Airbag Lamp 20 -
8 - 21 -
9 Diagnostic Link K 22 -
10 Driver Airbag Lo 23 -
11 Driver Airbag Hi 24 -
12 - 25 -
13 Front Passenger Airbag Hi
14
LTSMW140002T
14
LTSMW140003T
NOTE :
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) ground pin must be connected to the vehicle chassis in the immediate location
of the RCM mounting area.
NOTE :
• Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
• If the warning lamp is flashes 6 times (approximately 1 second for each flash) then shuts off for 1 second, and
then turns on continuously, this indicates that the system has an error. The fault can be caused by the following
events:
• A collision has happened (Sometimes, it maybe caused by the power operation on the RCM).
• The same history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A different history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A current DTC that is present in the RCM.
• In the course of troubleshooting the airbag system, make sure the system power supply is shut off, and wait two
minutes for the system capacitor to discharge.
• The following tools are required to perform the following test:
• X-431 Scan Tool
• Airbag Special Load Tool
• Digital Multimeter
• The squib circuit connectors integrate a ⬙shorting⬙ spring (which prevents the airbag from deploying unintentionally
due to static electricity by shorting the positive wire to the negative wire in the squib circuit when the connectors
are disconnected). Therefore, if the airbag electrical connector or spiral cable electrical connector is damaged or
improperly connected, the shorting spring may not be released when the electrical connector is connected.
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSM140006
LTSMD140001
Start the engine, raise the engine speed over 1000 rpm.
Measure the charging voltage with a voltmeter at the battery positive and negative terminals.
Is the voltage less than 9 V?
Yes >> • Inspect the charging system.
No >> • Go to the next step.
Start the engine, raise the engine speed over 1000 rpm for a few minutes.
Turn ignition switch off.
Measure the voltage drop with a voltmeter at the battery positive and negative terminals while cranking the engine.
Battery voltage should be more than approximate 9.0 V.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to step 5.
No >> • Charge or replace the battery.
Measure the resistance between RCM terminal 5 and the battery negative connector.
Continuity should exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Check fuse.
• Inspect and replace the harness for an open.
• Check harness connector C-106, J-100.
• Check correlative components.
6. CHECK DTC
14
LTSMW140006T
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd. 14–15
DIAGNOSIS & TESTING
NOTE :
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) ground pin must be connected to the vehicle chassis in the immediate location
of the RCM mounting area.
WARNING!
After installing the Restraints Control Module (RCM), make sure all of the connectors are firmly connected, and
the harness is routed properly. The resistance between the RCM module housing and the vehicle body should
be less than 100 m⍀.
NOTE :
• Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
• If the warming lamp is flashes 6 times (approximately 1 second for each flash) then shuts off for 1 second, and
then turns on continuously, this indicates that the system has an error. The fault can be caused by the following
events:
• A collision has happened (Sometimes, it maybe caused by the power operation on the RCM).
• The same history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A different history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A current DTC that is present in the RCM.
• In the course of troubleshooting the airbag system, make sure the system power supply is shut off, and wait two
minutes for the system capacitor to discharge.
• The following tools are required to perform the following test:
• X-431 Scan Tool
• Airbag Special Load Tool
• Digital Multimeter
• The squib circuit connectors integrate a ⬙shorting⬙ spring (which prevents the airbag from deploying unintentionally
due to static electricity by shorting the positive wire to the negative wire in the squib circuit when the connectors
are disconnected). Therefore, if the airbag electrical connector or spiral cable electrical connector is damaged or
improperly connected, the shorting spring may not be released when the electrical connector is connected.
14
Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
Connect the airbag special load tool to the spiral cable side of the vehicle harness (connect the special tool resistor
(2 ohms) in place of the passenger airbag module).
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, the driver airbag module should not be checked with a multimeter.
NOTE :
If the airbag special load tool is not available, connect a known good driver airbag module.
Connect the negative battery cable.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, reconnect the battery, then turn ignition switch on.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, turn the ignition switch off, disconnect the negative battery cable and wait two
minutes before proceeding.
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
Check the harness for continuity of the driver airbag cir-
cuit between terminal 10 in the RCM electrical connec-
tor J-001 terminal side and terminal 1 in the spiral
cable electrical connector J-005 terminal side.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
LTSM140006
Continuity should exist.
CHECK CONTINUITY
SPIRAL
RCM
CABLE CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 10 Yes
Check the harness for continuity of the driver airbag circuit between terminal 11 in the RCM electrical connector
J-001 and terminal 2 in the spiral cable electrical connector J-005 terminal side.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. 14
• Continuity should exist.
CHECK CONTINUITY
SPIRAL
RCM
CABLE CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
2 11 Yes
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, turn the ignition switch off, disconnect the negative battery cable and wait two
minutes before proceeding.
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
Check the harness for continuity of the driver airbag circuit between terminal 1 in the driver airbag module electrical
connector J-003 and terminal 1 in the spiral cable electrical connector J-005 terminal side.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
• Continuity should exist.
CHECK CONTINUITY
DRIVER
SPIRAL
AIRBAG
CABLE CONTINUITY
MODULE
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 1 Yes
Check the harness for continuity of the driver airbag circuit between the driver airbag module electrical connector
terminal 2 and the spiral cable electrical connector terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
• Continuity should exist.
CHECK CONTINUITY
DRIVER
SPIRAL
AIRBAG
CABLE CONTINUITY
MODULE
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
2 2 Yes
5. CHECK CONNECTORS
NOTE :
Diagnose and repair all active codes before diagnosing stored codes (See Restraints Control Module DTC List in
Section 14 Restraints).
With the scan tool, record and erase all RCM DTCs.
Using the electrical schematic as a guide, inspect the following:
• Inspect the wiring and connectors of the related airbag system.
• Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
• Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
• Verify that there is good pin to terminal contact in the related connectors.
Were any problems found?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • Go to the next step.
6. CHECK DTC
LTSMW140007T
NOTE :
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) ground pin must be connected to the vehicle chassis in the immediate location
of the RCM mounting area.
WARNING!
After installing the Restraints Control Module (RCM), make sure all of the connectors are firmly connected, and
the harness is routed properly. The resistance between the RCM module housing and the vehicle body should
be less than 100 m⍀.
DTC
DTC DTC SET
DTC NO. DETECTION POSSIBLE CAUSE
DEFINITION CONDITION
CONDITION
Restraints
Control Module
• Passenger airbag module
(RCM) detected
Passenger • Spiral cable
that the
Airbag • Passenger airbag module
Ignition switch: resistance of
B1352 Resistance Too connector
ON RCM connector
High Or Open • Harness is open between
terminals is out
(1st Stage) passenger airbag module and RCM
of the
• RCM
specification
range.
NOTE :
• Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
• If the warming lamp is flashes 6 times (approximately 1 second for each flash) then shuts off for 1 second, and
then turns on continuously, this indicates that the system has an error. The fault can be caused by the following
events:
• A collision has happened (Sometimes, it maybe caused by the power operation on the RCM).
• The same history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A different history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A current DTC that is present in the RCM.
• In the course of troubleshooting the airbag system, make sure the system power supply is shut off, and wait two
minutes for the system capacitor to discharge.
• The following tools are required to perform the following test:
• X-431 Scan Tool
• Airbag Special Load Tool
• Digital Multimeter
• The squib circuit connectors integrate a ⬙shorting⬙ spring (which prevents the airbag from deploying unintentionally
due to static electricity by shorting the positive wire to the negative wire in the squib circuit when the connectors
are disconnected). Therefore, if the airbag electrical connector or spiral cable electrical connector is damaged or
improperly connected, the shorting spring may not be released when the electrical connector is connected.
Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
Connect the airbag special load tool to the spiral cable side of the vehicle harness (connect the special tool resistor
(2 ⍀) in place of the passenger airbag module).
Connect the negative battery cable.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, the passenger airbag module should not be check by multimeter.
NOTE :
If the airbag special load tool is not available, connect a known good passenger airbag module.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, reconnect the battery, then turn ignition switch on.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, turn ignition switch off, disconnect the negative battery cable and wait two min-
utes before proceeding.
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
Check the harness for continuity of the passenger air-
bag circuit between terminal 13 in the RCM electrical
connector J-001 terminal side and terminal 1 in the
passenger airbag electrical connector J-002 terminal
side.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
• Continuity should exist. LTSM140006
CHECK CONTINUITY
FRONT
PASSENGER RCM
CONTINUITY
AIRBAG TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 13 Yes
Check the harness for continuity of the passenger airbag circuit between terminal 14 in the RCM electrical connector
J-001 terminal side and terminal 2 in the passenger airbag electrical connector J-002 terminal side.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
• Continuity should exist.
CHECK CONTINUITY
FRONT
PASSENGER RCM
CONTINUITY
AIRBAG TERMINAL
TERMINAL
2 14 Yes
4. CHECK CONNECTORS
NOTE :
Diagnose and repair all active codes before diagnosing stored codes (See Restraints Control Module DTC List in
Section 14 Restraints).
With the scan tool, record and erase all RCM DTCs.
Using the electrical schematic as a guide, inspect the following:
• Inspect the wiring and connectors of the related airbag system.
• Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
• Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
• Verify that there is good pin to terminal contact in the related connectors.
Were any problems found?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • Go to the next step.
5. CHECK DTC
LTSMW140008T
NOTE :
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) ground pin must be connected to the vehicle chassis in the immediate location
of the RCM mounting area.
WARNING!
After installing the Restraints Control Module (RCM), make sure all of the connectors are firmly connected, and
the harness is routed properly. The resistance between the RCM module housing and the vehicle body should
be less than 100 m⍀.
NOTE :
• Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
• If the warming lamp is flashes 6 times (approximately 1 second for each flash) then shuts off for 1 second, and
then turns on continuously, this indicates that the system has an error. The fault can be caused by the following
events:
14
• A collision has happened (Sometimes, it maybe caused by the power operation on the RCM).
• The same history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A different history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A current DTC that is present in the RCM.
• In the course of troubleshooting the airbag system, make sure the system power supply is shut off, and wait two
minutes for the system capacitor to discharge.
• The following tools are required to perform the following test:
• X-431 Scan Tool
• Airbag Special Load Tool
• Digital Multimeter
• The squib circuit connectors integrate a ⬙shorting⬙ spring (which prevents the airbag from deploying unintentionally
due to static electricity by shorting the positive wire to the negative wire in the squib circuit when the connectors
are disconnected). Therefore, if the airbag electrical connector or spiral cable electrical connector is damaged or
improperly connected, the shorting spring may not be released when the electrical connector is connected.
Diagnostic Procedure
Connect the X-431 scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC) - use the most current software available.
Turn the ignition switch on, with the scan tool, view and erase stored DTCs in the RCM.
Turn the ignition switch off, and wait a few seconds, then turn the ignition switch on.
Wait one minute, and with the scan tool, view active DTCs in the RCM.
Is DTC B2501 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 5.
Turn ignition switch off, and wait a few seconds, then turn ignition switch on.
Observe the airbag warning lamp.
Is the airbag warning lamp not illuminated with the ignition switch ON?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 4.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, turn ignition switch off, disconnect the negative battery cable and wait two min-
utes before proceeding.
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
• Check fuse F6.
Measure the following circuits with a digital multimeter:
• Measure the harness for an open between the front
LTSM140006
fuse and relay box electrical connector (terminal
B4, B14 ) and instrument cluster C-001 (terminal 11 and 13).
• Harness connector C-106, J-100.
• Measure the harness for open between the instrument cluster C-001 (terminal 17) and RCM electrical connector
J-001 (terminal 7).
Check the harness for continuity.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. CHECK CONNECTORS
NOTE :
Diagnose and repair all active codes before diagnosing stored codes (See Restraints Control Module DTC List in
Section 14 Restraints).
With the scan tool, record and erase all RCM DTCs.
Using the electrical schematic as a guide, inspect the following:
• Inspect the wiring and connectors of the related airbag system.
• Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
• Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
• Verify that there is good pin to terminal contact in the related connectors.
Were any problems found?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • Go to the next step.
5. CHECK DTC
14
LTSMW140008T
NOTE :
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) ground pin must be connected to the vehicle chassis in the immediate location
of the RCM mounting area.
WARNING!
After installing the Restraints Control Module (RCM), make sure all of the connectors are firmly connected, and
the harness is routed properly. The resistance between the RCM module housing and the vehicle body should
be less than 100 m⍀.
NOTE :
• Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
• If the warming lamp is flashes 6 times (approximately 1 second for each flash) then shuts off for 1 second, and
then turns on continuously, this indicates that the system has an error. The fault can be caused by the following
events:
14
• A collision has happened (Sometimes, it maybe caused by the power operation on the RCM).
• The same history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A different history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A current DTC that is present in the RCM.
• In the course of troubleshooting the airbag system, make sure the system power supply is shut off, and wait two
minutes for the system capacitor to discharge.
• The following tools are required to perform the following test:
• X-431 Scan Tool
• Airbag Special Load Tool
• Digital Multimeter
• The squib circuit connectors integrate a ⬙shorting⬙ spring (which prevents the airbag from deploying unintentionally
due to static electricity by shorting the positive wire to the negative wire in the squib circuit when the connectors
are disconnected). Therefore, if the airbag electrical connector or spiral cable electrical connector is damaged or
improperly connected, the shorting spring may not be released when the electrical connector is connected.
Diagnostic Procedure
Connect the X-431 scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC) - use the most current software available.
Turn the ignition switch on, with the scan tool, view and erase stored DTCs in the RCM.
Turn the ignition switch off, and wait a few seconds, then turn the ignition switch on.
Wait one minute, and with the scan tool, view active DTCs in the RCM.
Is DTC B2503 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 5.
Turn ignition switch off, and wait a few seconds, then turn ignition switch on.
Observe the airbag warning lamp.
Is the airbag warning lamp illuminated constantly with the ignition ON?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 4.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, turn ignition switch off, disconnect the negative battery cable and wait two min-
utes before proceeding.
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
• Check fuse F6.
Measure the following circuits with a digital multimeter:
• Measure the harness for a short to ground between
LTSM140006
the front fuse and relay box electrical connector
(terminal B14) and instrument cluster C-001 (terminal 13).
• Measure the harness for a short to ground between the instrument cluster C-001 (terminal 17) and RCM electri-
cal connector J-001 (terminal 7).
• Harness connector C-106, J-100.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
The harness continuity between the front fuse and relay box electrical connector (terminal B14 ) and RCM electrical
connector J-001 (terminal 7) should not exists.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Replace the instrument cluster.
• If DTC is still present, Go the next step.
No >> • Repair the harness between the RCM electrical connector J-001 (terminal 7) and instrument cluster
C-001 (terminal 17) and the harness between combination meter C-001 (terminal 13) and front fuse
and relay box electrical connector (terminal B14) for an short to ground.
4. CHECK CONNECTORS
NOTE :
Diagnose and repair all active codes before diagnosing stored codes (See Restraints Control Module DTC List in
Section 14 Restraints).
With the scan tool, record and erase all RCM DTCs.
Using the electrical schematic as a guide, inspect the following:
• Inspect the wiring and connectors of the related airbag system.
• Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
• Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
• Verify that there is good pin to terminal contact in the related connectors.
Were any problems found?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • Go to the next step.
5. CHECK DTC
14
LTSMW140008T
NOTE :
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) ground pin must be connected to the vehicle chassis in the immediate location
of the RCM mounting area.
WARNING!
After installing the Restraints Control Module (RCM), make sure all of the connectors are firmly connected, and
the harness is routed properly. The resistance between the RCM module housing and the vehicle body should
be less than 100 m⍀.
NOTE :
• Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
• If the warming lamp is flashes 6 times (approximately 1 second for each flash) then shuts off for 1 second, and
then turns on continuously, this indicates that the system has an error. The fault can be caused by the following
events:
14
• A collision has happened (Sometimes, it maybe caused by the power operation on the RCM).
• The same history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A different history DTC is repeated more than 10 times.
• A current DTC that is present in the RCM.
• In the course of troubleshooting the airbag system, make sure the system power supply is shut off, and wait two
minutes for the system capacitor to discharge.
• The following tools are required to perform the following test:
• X-431 Scan Tool
• Airbag Special Load Tool
• Digital Multimeter
• The squib circuit connectors integrate a ⬙shorting⬙ spring (which prevents the airbag from deploying unintentionally
due to static electricity by shorting the positive wire to the negative wire in the squib circuit when the connectors
are disconnected). Therefore, if the airbag electrical connector or spiral cable electrical connector is damaged or
improperly connected, the shorting spring may not be released when the electrical connector is connected.
Diagnostic Procedure
Turn ignition switch off, and wait a few seconds, then turn ignition switch on.
Observe SRS warning lamp.
Is the SRS warning lamp not illuminated with ignition switch ON?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Go to step 4.
WARNING!
To avoid serious or fatal injury, turn ignition switch off, disconnect the negative battery cable and wait two min-
utes before proceeding.
NOTE :
Check connectors - Clean and repair as necessary.
• Check fuse F6.
Measure the following circuits with a digital multimeter:
• Harness connector C-106, J-100.
• Measure the harness for short to battery between LTSM140006
the instrument cluster C-001 (terminal 17) and RCM electrical connector J-001 (terminal 7).
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Is the voltage present?
Yes >> • Repair the harness wires between the RCM electrical connector J-001 (terminal 7) and instrument
cluster C-001 (terminal 17) and the harness wires between combination meter C-001 (terminal 13)
and front fuse and relay box electrical connector (terminal B14) for an short to battery.
No >> • Replace the instrument cluster.
• If DTC is still present, Go to the next step.
4. CHECK CONNECTORS
NOTE :
Diagnose and repair all active codes before diagnosing stored codes (See Restraints Control Module DTC List in
Section 14 Restraints).
With the scan tool, record and erase all RCM DTCs.
Using the electrical schematic as a guide, inspect the following:
• Inspect the wiring and connectors of the related airbag system.
• Look for any chafed, pierced, pinched, or partially broken wires.
• Look for broken, bent, pushed out or corroded terminals.
• Verify that there is good pin to terminal contact in the related connectors.
Were any problems found?
Yes >> • Repair as necessary.
No >> • Go to the next step.
5. CHECK DTC
14
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check if the RCM supply voltage circuit, ground circuit open, high resistance or short circuits existing.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Replace the circuit for open or short in harness and connectors.
3. CHECK DTC
14
LTSM140001
4. Remove the driver side airbag and disconnect the airbag squib electrical connector.
5. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150086
LTSM140002
3. Remove the center console (See Center Console Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
4. Disconnect the Restraints Control Module (RCM)
electrical connector (1).
5. Remove the RCM retaining bolts (2).
(Tighten: RCM retaining bolts to 7-9 N·m)
LTSM140006
14
Operation
The primary passenger restraints are the seat belts. Seat belts are referred to as an active restraint because the
vehicle occupants are required to physically fasten and properly adjust these restraints in order to benefit from them.
The passive restraints are referred to as a supplemental restraint system because they were designed and are
intended to enhance the protection for the occupants of the vehicle only when used in conjunction with the seat belts.
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
14
LTSM150077
LTSM150076
LTSM140004
(Tighten: Front seat belt retaining bolt to 50 N·m)
7. Remove the front seat belt and pre-tensioner.
8. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150077
BESM140006
14
LTSM140005
LTSM140003
BODY INTERIOR
AUDIO SYSTEM 15-3 CAN VEHICLE COMMUNICATIONS 15-13
Description 15-3 Description 15-13
Operation 15-3 Operation 15-13
Electrical Schematics 15-4 Electrical Schematics 15-14
Radio 15-7
Removal & Installation 15-7
CHIME 15-16
Description 15-16
6 CD Changer 15-7 Operation 15-16
Removal & Installation 15-7 Electrical Schematics 15-17
Antenna 15-8
Removal & Installation 15-8 DOOR LOCKS 15-26
Description 15-26
BODY INTERIOR TRIM 15-9 Operation 15-26
Electrical Schematics 15-27
A-Pillar Trim Panel 15-9
Removal & Installation 15-9 Door Lock Switch 15-32
Removal & Installation 15-32
B-Pillar Lower Trim Panel 15-9
Removal & Installation 15-9 Door Lock Assembly 15-32
Removal & Installation 15-32
B-Pillar Upper Trim Panel 15-10 Door Lock Assembly Inspection 15-34
Removal & Installation 15-10
C-Pillar Lower Trim Panel 15-10 BODY CONTROL MODULE - BCM 15-35
Removal & Installation 15-10 Description 15-35
Operation 15-35
C-Pillar Upper Trim Panel 15-11 Electrical Schematics 15-36
Removal & Installation 15-11
Assist Handle 15-11 ON-VEHICLE SERVICE 15-41
Removal & Installation 15-11 Body Control Module (BCM) 15-41 15
Scuff Plate 15-11 Removal & Installation 15-41
Removal & Installation 15-11
INSTRUMENT PANEL 15-42
Pedal Pad 15-12 Removal & Installation 15-42
Removal & Installation 15-12
Lower Console 15-44
Sun Visor 15-12 Removal & Installation 15-44
Removal & Installation 15-12
Headliner 15-12 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER 15-47
Removal & Installation 15-12 Description 15-47
Operation 15-48
Electrical Schematics 15-49
Operation
With the audio system on, radio signals are received by the window antenna, the audio unit then sends audio signals
to front speakers and rear speakers.
15
Electrical Schematics
Audio System (Page 1 of 3)
LTSMW150001T
15
LTSMW150002T
LTSMW150085T
Radio
Removal & Installation
1. Lift one corner of the radio trim cover with a trim
stick, and remove the radio trim cover.
LTSM150070
LTSM150071
6 CD Changer
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the passenger seat.
2. Remove the CD changer 4 mounting bolts (1).
(Tighten: CD changer mounting bolts to 9 ± 3 N·m)
3. Disconnect the CD changer electrical connector
(2). 15
LTSM150072
Antenna
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Pull the rear edge of the headliner down.
3. Disconnect the antenna electrical connector.
4. Remove the antenna mounting nut (1).
LTSM150073
BESM150123
Installation Notes:
• The A-pillar trim panel retaining clips should be installed to allow the trim panel to fit tightly between the head-
liner and the weatherstrip.
LTSM150076
2. Using a trim stick, remove the lower trim panel from the B-pillar.
3. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
15
LTSM150077
LTSM150078
LTSM140005
Assist Handle
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the assist handle mounting screws trim
covers from the assist handles.
2. Remove the mounting screws.
(Tighten: Assist handle screws to 2 N·m)
3. Remove the assist handle.
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150079
Scuff Plate
Removal & Installation
1. Grasp the scuff plate and gently pull it away to
release the retaining clips. 15
2. Using a trim stick, remove the scuff plate from the
front door sill.
3. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
BESM150124
Pedal Pad
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the pedal pad mounting screws.
2. Remove the pedal pad.
3. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Sun Visor
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the two sun visor mounting screws (1).
(Tighten: Sun visor screws to 2 N·m)
LTSM150080
Headliner
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the assist handles (See Assist Handle Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
2. Remove the courtesy lamps.
3. Remove the air discharge cover.
4. Remove the trim panels from the A, B and C pillars.
5. Pry the headliner retainer clips from the mounting brackets.
6. Remove the headliner (1).
LTSM150081
Operation
The CAN network uses a twisted pair of circuits to transmit data (+) and data (-). The data (+) and the data (-)
circuits are each regulated to approximately 2.5 volts during neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are
sent on the data (+) circuit, voltage is increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is reduced by
approximately 1.0 volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be sent over the CAN circuits allow-
ing multiple modules to communicate with each other.
15
Electrical Schematics
CAN Vehicle Communications (Page 1 of 2)
LTSMW150031T
15
LTSMW150032T
CHIME
Description
The chime is located in the Instrument Cluster (IC). The chime warning system is an audible notification to the driver.
The chime warning system is designed to alert the driver of a vehicle problem or condition.
Operation
The Instrument Cluster (IC) uses hard wired inputs from various sensors and switches to activate the chime. The
sensors and switches are located throughout the vehicle. The following conditions will cause the chime to operate:
• Turn signal on
• Hazard warning flashers on
• Seat belt unbuckled
• Low fuel level
• Low oil pressure
• Low brake fluid
• Doors unlocked
Electrical Schematics
Chime (Page 1 of 9)
15
LTSMW150068T
Chime (Page 2 of 9)
LTSMW150069T
Chime (Page 3 of 9)
15
LTSMW150070T
Chime (Page 4 of 9)
LTSMW150071T
Chime (Page 5 of 9)
15
LTSMW150072T
Chime (Page 6 of 9)
LTSMW150073T
Chime (Page 7 of 9)
15
LTSMW150074T
Chime (Page 8 of 9)
LTSMW150075T
Chime (Page 9 of 9)
15
LTSMW150076T
Operation
The power lock system receives non-switched battery current, so that the power locks remain operational, regardless
of the ignition switch position. The power lock system is controlled by BCM.
Electrical Schematics
Power Door Lock System (Page 1 of 5)
15
LTSMW150051T
LTSMW150052T
15
LTSMW150053T
LTSMW150054T
15
LTSMW150055T
LTSM150097
3. Using a trim stick, pry out the power window and door lock/unlock switch assembly from the front door.
4. Disconnect the power window and door lock/unlock switch electrical connectors.
5. Remove the power window and door lock/unlock switch retaining screws to remove the power window and door
lock/unlock switch.
6. Installation is in the reverse order of removal
LTSM150139
LTSM150134
LTSM150140
7. Carefully pry the door trim panel clips from the door.
8. Disconnect the power window switch and the door lamp electrical connector.
9. Remove the door trim panel.
10. Disconnect the speaker connector (1).
11. Remove the inner door handle assembly mount-
ing screw (2).
12. Disconnect the inner door handle cables (3).
13. Remove the protective film (4).
15
LTSM150135
LTSM150098
Operation
The Body Control Module (BCM) uses hard wired inputs from various sensors and switches. The sensors and
switches are located throughout the vehicle.
The following components are inputs to the BCM:
• Key switch
• Rear defroster switch
• Hazard lamp switch
• Power window switches
• Power door lock switches
• Seat belt switch
• Vehicle speed
• Door ajar switches
• Turn signal switch
The following components are outputs from the BCM:
• Key lamp
• Stop lamp relay
• Rear defroster grid
• Courtesy lamps
• Power window motor
• Power door lock motor
• Turn signal lamps
15
LTSM150130
Electrical Schematics
Body Control Module (Page 1 of 5)
LTSMW150056T
15
LTSMW150057T
15
LTSMW150058T
LTSMW150059T
15
LTSMW150060T
LTSM150086
LTSM150109
LTSM150131
LTSM150086
15
LTSM150087
LTSM150088
LTSM150089
LTSM150090
LTSM150091
LTSM150092
15. Remove the A-pillar trim panel (See A-Pillar Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
16. Remove the lower console (See Lower Console Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
17. Carefully remove the instrument panel.
18. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Lower Console
Removal & Installation
1. Gently pry the gearshift knob bezel off of the con-
sole cover.
15
LTSM150093
LTSM150094
LTSM150095
LTSM150096
15
LTSM150129
The IC functions and indicator lamps are listed below:
• Tachometer (1)
• Maintenance Indicator Light (2)
• Cruise Indicator Light (3)
• Parking Brake System Warning Light (4)
• Parking Light (5)
• Malfunction Indicator Light (6)
• Left-Turn Light (7)
• Door/Trunk Lid Open Warning Display (8)
• Charging System Light (9)
• Front Fog Light Indicator Light (10)
• Brake System Warning Light (11)
• High Beam Indicator Light (12)
• Speedometer (13)
• Airbag Light (14)
• Rear Fog Light Indicator Light (15)
• 4WD Warning Light (If Equipped) (16)
• Right-turn Light (17)
• Low Fuel Warning Light (18)
• ABS Warning Light (19)
• Oil Pressure Warning Light (20)
• Fuel Gauge (21)
• Temperature Gauge (22)
• Electronic Throttle Control Indicator Light (23)
• Km/h Light (24)
• Transaxle Range Indicator (If Equipped) (25)
• Odometer/Trip Odometer (26)
• Digital Clock (27)
• Adjust Button (28)
• Seat Belt Reminder Light (29)
• Coolant Temperature Warning Light (30)
Operation
The Instrument Cluster (IC) uses hard wired inputs from various sensors and switches. The sensors and switches are
located throughout the vehicle. The IC displays the following gauges:
• Speedometer - The IC displays the vehicle speed as determined by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
• Tachometer - The IC displays the engine speed as determined by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
• Temperature Gauge - The IC displays the engine coolant temperature as determined by the Engine Control
Module (ECM).
• Fuel Gauge - The IC displays the amount of fuel in the fuel tank as determined by the fuel level sensor.
15
Electrical Schematics
Instrument Cluster (Page 1 of 8)
LTSMW150100T
15
LTSMW150101T
LTSMW150102T
15
LTSMW150103T
LTSMW150104T
15
LTSMW150105T
LTSMW150106T
15
LTSMW150107T
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter
Fluke 15B & 17B
Diagnostic Help
1. The X-431 scan tool connects to the Data Link Connector (DLC) and communicates with the vehicle electronic
modules through the data network.
2. Confirm that the malfunction is current and then carry-out the diagnostic tests and repair procedures.
3. If the DTC cannot be deleted, it is a current fault.
4. Use a digital multimeter to perform voltage readings on electronic systems.
5. Refer to TECHNICAL BULLETINS that were issued by Chery.
6. Visually inspect the related wiring harness.
7. Inspect and clean all Instrument Cluster (IC) grounds that are related to the DTC.
8. If numerous trouble codes were set, use a wiring schematic and look for any common ground circuits or voltage
supply circuits.
Diagnostic Tools
• Diagnostic Scan Tool X-431
• Digital Multimeter
• Jumper Wire
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
N/A (With ACTECO
Engine)
1 Door Lamp 33
P (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
N/A (With ACTECO N/A (With ACTECO
Engine) Engine)
2 34
GNE (With MITSUBISHI R (With MITSUBISHI
Engine) Engine)
N/A (With ACTECO
35
Engine)
3 GND (Power)
N (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
N/A (With ACTECO
36
Engine)
4 PWM Gear Mode
Auto Mode (With
MITSUBISHI Engine)
N/A (With ACTECO
37
Engine)
5 GND (Sensor)
4 (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
N/A (With ACTECO
38
Engine)
6 Front Fog Lamp
3 (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
N/A (With ACTECO
39
Engine)
7 —
2 (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
N/A (With ACTECO
40
Engine)
8 Cruise Lamp
1 (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
9 Low Oil Pressure Lamp 41 —
10 Speed Input 42 Rear Fog Lamp
Continuous Supply 15
11 43 —
Voltage
12 Illumination Lamp 44 —
13 Ignition Switch 45 —
14 ABS Lamp 46 —
Sport Mode (With
ACTECO Engine)
15 Diagnostic Link K 47
N/A (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
Winter Mode (With
ACTECO Engine)
16 Charge Lamp 48
N/A (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
TCM Failure (With
ACTECO Engine)
17 Airbag Lamp 49
N/A (With MITSUBISHI
Engine)
18 Parking Brake Lamp 50 —
19 Seatbelt Lamp 51 —
20 MIL Lamp 52 —
21 Low Fuel Level Lamp 53 —
22 Left Turn Lamp 54 —
23 Coolant Temperature Input 55 —
24 Right Turn Lamp 56 —
25 High Beam Lamp 57 —
Low Brake Fluid Level
26 58 —
Lamp
27 Vehicle Speed Input 59 —
28 Parking Lamp 60 —
29 EPC Lamp 61 —
30 — 62 —
31 Fuel Consumption Input 63 —
32 — 64 —
15
LTSMW150037T
LTSMW150038T
DTC
DTC POSSIBLE
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION
DEFINITION CAUSE
CONDITION
Instrument Cluster (IC) detected that • Charge system
Battery over
U029C the battery voltage is excessively • Instrument
voltage error
high. Cluster (IC)
Turn ignition • Battery
switch on • Charge system
Instrument Cluster (IC) detected that
Battery under • Harness or
U029C the battery voltage is excessively
voltage error connector
low.
• Instrument
Cluster (IC)
NOTE :
• Inspect the vehicle for aftermarket accessories that may exceed the Generator System output.
• Inspect the fuses. If an open fuse is found, use the wiring schematics as a guide and inspect the wiring and
connectors for damage.
• Troubleshoot any Engine Control Module (ECM) charging/cranking DTCs before proceeding.
15
Diagnostic Procedure
LTSMD150007
LTSMD150008
Start the engine, raise the speed over 1000 rpm for a few minutes.
Turn ignition switch off.
Measure the voltage drop with the voltmeter at the battery positive and negative terminals while cranking the engine.
Battery voltage should be more than approximate 9 V.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Charge or replace the battery.
15
7. CHECK DTC
15
LTSMW150039T
NOTE :
• Before performing any DTC diagnostic procedures, verify the IC power and ground circuits are properly connected.
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Turn ignition switch on, with the scan tool, view and erase stored DTCs in the IC module.
Turn ignition switch off, and wait a few seconds, then turn ignition switch on.
With the scan tool, view active DTCs in the IC module.
Is DTC U040F present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • The condition that caused this DTC is currently not present (See Diagnostic Help in Section 15
Body & Accessories).
LTSM030002
LTSMD150004
COOLANT
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR (FOR
GROUND
INSTRUMENT
CLUSTER)
TERMINAL
1 Ground
COOLANT
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR (FOR IC
CONTINUITY
INSTRUMENT TERMINAL
CLUSTER)
TERMINAL
1 31 Yes
5. CHECK DTC
15
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
Instrument Cluster (IC)
U050F EEPROM checksum error • Instrument Cluster (IC)
detected an internal failure
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check the Instrument Cluster (IC) supply voltage circuit and ground circuits for open, high resistance or short circuits.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair the circuit for an open or short in harness and connectors.
3. CHECK DTC
With the X-431 scan tool, read Instrument Cluster (IC) DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC U050F present?
Yes >> • The system is now operating properly.
No >> • Replace Instrument Cluster (IC).
15
LTSMW150040T
NOTE :
Before performing any DTC diagnostic procedures, verify the IC power and ground circuits are properly connected.
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Turn ignition switch on, with the scan tool, view and erase stored DTCs in the IC.
Turn ignition switch off, and wait a few seconds, then turn ignition switch on.
With the scan tool, view DTCs in the IC.
Is DTC U0303 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • The condition that caused the DTC is currently not present (See Diagnosis & Testing Diagnostic
Help in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
LTSM040002
LTSMD150001
FUEL LEVEL
SENSOR GROUND
TERMINAL
1 Ground
FUEL LEVEL
IC
SENSOR CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
1 21 Yes
Using a 12 V test light connected to battery (+), probe fuel level sensor ground circuit.
Does the test light illuminate brightly?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair or replace the fuel level sensor ground circuit for an open.
6. CHECK DTC
15
LTSM150085
Operation
The key hole lamp and front/middle/rear courtesy lamps are controlled by the BCM. Front step lamps are controlled
by the door lock switch. When the door is open, the front step lamp will light up automatically. Other lamps are
controlled by the lighting and turn signal switch.
15
Electrical Schematics
Interior Lamps (Page 1 of 5)
LTSMW150061T
15
LTSMW150062T
LTSMW150063T
15
LTSMW150064T
LTSMW150086T
LTSM150042
3. Carefully remove the front room lamp and disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
15
LTSM150043
LTSM150044
NOTE :
The rear courtesy/dome lamp is similar to the middle courtesy/dome lamp.
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM110031
CAUTION:
This power outlet is designed for 12 V (120W) only. Do not use any type of accessory above this
voltage.
Operation
The power outlets are powered at all times.
15
Electrical Schematics
Power Outlet (Page 1 of 1)
LTSMW150005T
LTSM150099
15
Operation
The front and rear power window motors are permanent magnet type. A battery positive and negative connection to
either of the two motor terminals will cause the motor to rotate in one direction. Reversing current through these
same two connections will cause the motor to rotate in the opposite direction. Each individual motor is grounded
through the BCM.
Electrical Schematics
Power Window System (Page 1 of 3)
15
LTSMW150046T
LTSMW150047T
15
LTSMW150048T
LTSM150097
3. Using a trim stick, pry out the power window and door lock/unlock switch assembly from the front door.
4. Disconnect the power window and door lock/unlock switch electrical connectors.
5. Remove the power window and door lock/unlock switch retaining screws to remove the power window and door
lock/unlock switch.
6. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150139
LTSM150134
LTSM150140
6. Carefully pry the door trim panel clips from the door.
7. Disconnect the power window switch and the door lamp electrical connector.
8. Remove the door trim panel.
9. Disconnect the speaker connector (1).
10. Remove the inner door handle assembly mount-
ing screw (2).
11. Disconnect the inner door handle cables (3).
12. Remove the protective film (4).
15
LTSM150135
LTSM150116
LTSM150137
LTSM150117
MEASURING OPERATIONAL
INSPECTION DIAGRAM
CONDITION DIRECTION
15
Operation
The manual seat adjustment bar is at the front of the seat, near the floor. Pull the bar upward and slide the seat
forward or rearward. Release the bar once the seat is in the desired position. To confirm the seat is locked into place,
attempt to move the seat forward and rearward after adjusting the seat. The heated seat controls for each seat
heater are located near the bottom center of the instrument panel. After turning the ignition ON, the seat heater can
be activated to High or Low heat settings. When the switch is in the middle position, the seat heater is OFF. Each
switch is equipped with LED lights to indicate the level of heat at which each seat is set.
Electrical Schematics
Heated Seat (Page 1 of 1)
15
LTSMW150004T
Front Seat
Removal & Installation
1. Move the seat to the furthest forward position
and remove the protective cover from the seat
guide rail.
LTSM150065
LTSM150066
LTSM150067
Rear Seats
Removal & Installation
1. Open the back door.
2. Pull the seat release (1) upward to fold the rear
seat.
15
LTSM150133
LTSM150068
LTSM150069
LTSM150127
1. Using a trim stick, carefully remove the switch (1) from the mounting bezel.
2. Disconnect the heated seat switch electrical connector.
3. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
15
Operation
When an incorrect key is inserted into the ignition switch, the vehicle security system senses the incorrect key and
sends a signal to the Immobilizer. The Engine Control Module (ECM) receives the signal from Immobilizer via the
R-Line. The ECM then disables the engine from starting.
Electrical Schematics
Immobilizer (Page 1 of 1)
15
LTSMW150081T
Diagnostic Tools
• Diagnostic Scan Tool X-431
• Digital Multimeter
• Jumper Wire
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
PIN PIN
IDENTIFICATION IDENTIFICATION
Continuous Supply
1 7 Diagnostic Link K
Voltage
2 GND 8 W-Line
3 — 9 Coil (GND)
4 Ignition Switch 10 Coil (ANT B)
5 R-Line 11 Coil (ANT A)
6 - — -
15
1. CHECK BATTERY
LTSMD150020T
Press the lock button on the RKE transmitter for less than 2 seconds.
Pull out the ignition switch.
Try to operate the RKE transmitter.
Does the RKE transmitter operate properly?
Yes >> • Erase all codes before returning the vehicle to the customer.
• The concern was caused by the RKE transmitter.
No >> • Replace the FBCM (See FBCM Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
• Refer to the RKE transmitter match procedure with X-431 as the description.
• Perform match between the RKE transmitter and FBCM with X-431.
15
LTSMW150081T
DTC DETECTION
DTC NO. DTC DEFINITION POSSIBLE CAUSE
CONDITION
ECU Defect, Internal Immobilizer detects an
B1000 • Immobilizer
Errors internal failure.
Diagnostic Procedure
1. CHECK DTC
Check the Immobilizer supply voltage circuit and ground circuit for an open, high resistance or short circuits.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • Repair the circuit for an open or short in harness and connectors.
3. CHECK DTC
15
With the X-431 scan tool, read the Immobilizer DTCs.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC B1000 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program the Immobilizer.
• Refer to DTC B3077 Diagnostic Procedure.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
LTSMW150081T
15
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, view DTCs in the Immobilizer. Refer to DTC confirmation procedure.
Is the warning light flashing and DTC B3042 or B3043 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • The condition that caused the DTC to set is currently not present (See Diagnosis & Testing Diag-
nostic Help in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
LTSMD030077
LTSMD150019
For DTC B3042, check the resistance of W-Line between the Immobilizer connector C-025, pin 8 and ground.
IMMOBILIZER
TERMINAL RESULT
TERMINAL
Continuity
8 Ground
should not exist
For DTC B3043, turn ignition switch on, check voltage between the Immobilizer connector C-025, pin 8 and ground.
IMMOBILIZER
TERMINAL RESULT
TERMINAL
12 V should not
8 Ground
exist
B3050 - Relay External Line Short Circuit To Ground Or Open Circuit, Relay External
Line Malfunction
B3053 - Relay External Line Short Circuit To Battery
15
LTSMW150081T
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, view DTCs in the Immobilizer. Refer to DTC confirmation procedure.
Is DTC B3050 or B3053 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • The condition that caused the DTC to set is currently not present (See Diagnosis & Testing Diag-
nostic Help in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
15
LTSMD150019
Turn ignition switch on.
Check if voltage is present on the Immobilizer connector C-025, pin 4,1 and ground.
Ground
Is 12 V present?
Yes >> • Replace and program the Immobilizer. Refer to DTC B3077 Diagnostic Procedure.
No >> • For DTC B3050, Go to the next step.
• For DTC B3053, Go to the step 5.
BODY FUSE
IMMOBILIZER
AND RELAY CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
BOX TERMINAL
A2 1 Yes
BODY FUSE
IMMOBILIZER
AND RELAY CONTINUITY
TERMINAL
BOX TERMINAL
A6 4 Yes
15
Check harness for a short to ground.
Continuity between Immobilizer power supply and ground should not exist.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the step 6.
No >> • Repair or replace the open or high resistance circuit or short to ground in harness or connectors.
IMMOBILIZER IMMOBILIZER
CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
1 4 No
Check resistance between Immobilizer ignition switch circuit and other power circuits.
Refer to wiring diagram for more information.
Is the check result normal?
Yes >> • Go to the step 7.
No >> • Repair or replace short to power circuits in harness or connectors.
With the X-431 Scan Tool, view active DTCs in the immobilizer.
Refer to ⬙DTC Confirmation Procedure⬙.
Is DTC B3050 or B3053 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and program immobilizer.
No >> • The system is now operating properly.
15
LTSMW150081T
DTC
DTC POSSIBLE
DTC NO. DETECTION DTC SET CONDITION
DEFINITION CAUSE
CONDITION
• Transponder
No transponder The Immobilizer detects no
Ignition switch: • Harness or
B3055 modulation or no transponder or no transponder
ON connectors
transponder modulation condition.
• Immobilizer
• Transponder
No transponder
Ignition switch: The Immobilizer detects that the • Harness or
B3056 fixed code
ON transponder is not programmed. connectors
programmed
• Immobilizer
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, view DTCs in the Immobilizer. Refer to DTC confirmation procedure.
Is DTC B3055 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • The condition that caused the DTC to set is currently not present (See Diagnosis & Testing Diag-
nostic Help in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
LTSMD150019
Check the resistance of the immobilizer coil between the Immobilizer coil connector C-026, pin 9 and pin 11.
15
9 11
Check the resistance of the Immobilizer coil between the Immobilizer coil connector C-026, pin 9 and pin 10.Check
the resistance of the Immobilizer coil between the Immobilizer coil connector C-026, pin 11 and pin 10.
IMMOBILIZER IMMOBILIZER
COIL COIL CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
9 10
No
11 10
VISMD150018
Turn ignition switch on.
VISMD150019T
VISMD150020T
LTSMW150081T
15
Diagnostic Procedure
With the scan tool, view DTCs in the Immobilizer. Refer to DTC confirmation procedure.
Is DTC B3060, B3061 or B3077 present?
Yes >> • For DTC B3060, Go to step 5.
• For DTC B3061, Go to the next step.
• For DTC B3077, Go to step 6.
No >> • The condition that caused the DTC is currently not present. Monitor the scan tool data relative to
this circuit while wiggle testing the wiring and connectors and looking for the DTC to reset.
− Using the wiring schematic as a guide, inspect the related wiring and connectors of the Immobilizer.
− Verify that there is good terminal contact in the related connectors.
LTSMD150019
Check the resistance of the Immobilizer coil between the Immobilizer coil connector C-026, pin 9 and pin 11.
9 11
Check the resistance between the Immobilizer coil connector C-026, pin 9 and pin 10.
Check the resistance between the Immobilizer coil connector C-026, pin 11 and pin 10.
IMMOBILIZER IMMOBILIZER
COIL COIL CONTINUITY
TERMINAL TERMINAL
9 10
No
11 10
VISMD150019T
Try to start the engine.
With the X-431 scan tool, view active DTCs in the Immobilizer.
Is DTC B3060, B3061 or B3077 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • No problem found at this time.
• This concern may have been caused by the not programmed transponder.
• Erase all codes before returning the vehicle to the customer.
VISMD150018
VISMD150019T
Try to start the engine.
With the X-431 scan tool, view DTCs in the Immobilizer.
Is DTC B3060, B3061 or B3077 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • No problem found at this time.
• This concern may have been caused by the transponder fault.
• Erase all codes before returning the vehicle to the customer.
15
LTSMD150019
NOTE :
If replacing and matching the ECM, choose ⬙read
Immobilizer to EMS ⬙ immediately.
VISMD150019T
• Click ⬙OK⬙.
Try to start the engine.
With the X-431 scan tool, view active DTCs in the Immobilizer.
Is DTC B3060, B3061 or B3077 present?
Yes >> • Go to the next step.
No >> • No problem found at this time.
• This concern may have been caused by the Immobilizer fault.
• Erase all codes before returning the vehicle to the customer.
Using the wiring schematic as a guide, inspect the related wiring and connectors of the ECM.
Verify that there is good terminal contact in the related connectors.
Try to start the engine.
With the X-431 scan tool, view active DTCs in the Immobilizer.
Is DTC B3060, B3061 or B3077 still present?
Yes >> • Replace and match the ECM (This concern may have been caused by ECM internal fault).
• Refer to the procedure to replace and program the Immobilizer.
No >> • No problem found at this time.
LTSM150100
15
15
15
LTSM150032
15–140 LTSM150002
Chery Automobile Co., Ltd.
BODY DIMENSIONS
LTSM150003
Front Structure
Dimension of Front Structure (Units: mm)
Body dimension, Left-Right
LTSM150001
15–142 Chery Automobile Co., Ltd.
BODY DIMENSIONS
CONTROL CONTROL
S/N DIMENSION DESCRIPTION S/N DIMENSION DESCRIPTION
(mm) (mm)
Diagonal distance Center distance
AB=PQ 1485.8
of front windshield between the hole
FH 270.7 of front shock
Distance of front absorber and the
CD 733.2
windshield at Y0 installation hole of
Center distance front fender
between the right Center distance
end of upper between the holes
cover of the lower FG 1126.8
of left/right front
IJ 1491.6 beam of front shock absorber
windshield and
the installation Center distance
hole of front LM 952.8 between the holes
fender of left/right engine
suspension
Center distance
between the Center distance
upper cover hole between the
EH 736.1 of the lower beam upper cover hole
of front windshield KE 690.5 of front windshield
and the beam and the
installation hole of installation hole of
front fender radiator
LTSM150001
NOTE :
Uppercase letters indicate the left side of the body. Lowercase letters indicate the right side of the body (view from
the rear of the vehicle).
15
Frame
Body Frame Dimensions (Units: mm)
LTSM150004
Vehicle Clearance
Front View
15
LTSM150005
LTSM150006
LTSM150007
LTSM150008
LTSM150009
LTSM150010
15
Body
Side View
LTSM150011
NOTE :
• The levelness from point A to B should be evenly changed from 0 to 1, and the levelness from point C to B should
be evenly changed from 1 to 0.
• The clearance from point F to C should be evenly changed from 6 to 7, and the levelness from point G to H
should be evenly changed from 1 to 0.
• The levelness from point K to J should be evenly changed from 0 to 1.
• The tolerance of clearance between front and back doors at MN, NP sections should be within 1.2 mm.
Cross section B1-B1, requirements for clearance and
levelness.
LTSM150012
LTSM150013
15
LTSM150014
LTSM150015
LTSM150016
LTSM150017
LTSM150018
15
LTSM150019
LTSM150020
LTSM150021
LTSM150022
LTSM150023
LTSM150024
15
LTSM150025
Rear View
LTSM150026
LTSM150027
LTSM150028
15
LTSM150029
LTSM150030
LTSM150031
LTSM150074
1. Remove the left and right headlamp (See Headlamp Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
2. Remove the three front bumper mounting bolts (1).
3. Remove the front bumper side mounting bolts and the connecting bolts from the front wheel house (3).
4. Raise the vehicle and remove the mounting bolts under the front bumper (2).
5. Disconnect the front fog light electrical connectors and remove the front bumper.
6. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
15
Front Door
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the inner harness electrical connector
on the front door.
3. Remove the mounting bolts (1) from the front door
hinge.
4. Remove the front door assembly.
LTSM150111
Disassembly
1. Turn the ignition switch off.
2. Using a small trim stick, remove the pull handle
cover (1) from the pull handle (2).
LTSM150139
15
LTSM150134
LTSM150140
6. Carefully pry the door trim panel clips from the door.
7. Disconnect the power window switch and the door lamp electrical connector.
8. Remove the door trim panel.
9. Disconnect the speaker connector (1).
10. Remove the inner door handle assembly mount-
ing screw (2).
11. Disconnect the inner door handle cables (3).
12. Remove the protective film (4).
LTSM150135
LTSM150116
LTSM150137
LTSM150117
LTSM150098
LTSM150114
Assembly
Assemble is in the reverse order of disassembly
LTSM150120
Rear Door
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the inner electrical harness connec-
tor on the rear door.
3. Remove the mounting bolts (1) from the rear
door hinge.
4. Remove the rear door assembly.
5. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150112
15
Disassembly
1. Remove the bolts to remove the bezel for the inside door handle.
2. Pry out the window regulator switch and pull out the electrical harness.
3. Remove the door trim panel.
4. Remove the mounting bolts for the inside door handle to remove the handle.
5. Remove the protective film from the rear door.
6. Lower the glass to a proper position, remove the set bolts, move the glass to the bottom of the door, and then
remove the door glass.
7. Remove the mounting bolts for the glass guide rail.
LTSM150118
LTSM150119
Assembly
Assemble in the reverse order of disassembly.
Disassembly
1. Remove the back cargo door panel.
2. Remove the rear wiper motor (See Rear Wiper
Motor Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body &
Accessories).
3. Remove the protective film from the back cargo
LTSM150113
door.
4. Remove mounting bolts, pull out the harness.
5. Remove the outside handle mounting bolts (1) from
one side of the door panel.
15
LTSM150121
LTSM150122
LTSM150123
Assembly
Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
15
Operation
• Front Combination Lamp: With the light switch in the 2nd position, the Body Control Module (BCM) receives
input requesting head lamp operation. The BCM then supplies power to the head lamps.
• Turn Signal Lamp: When the turn signal switch is in LH or RH position with the ignition switch in the ON posi-
tion, the FBCM detects the RH or LH turn signal request. The BCM supplies power to the respective turn signal
lamp.
• Hazard Lamp: When the hazard switch is in the ON position, the BCM detects the hazard switch signal. The
BCM outputs the flasher signal (right and left). The BCM then activates the hazard indicator and audible
buzzer.
• Fog Lamp: When the front/rear fog lamp switch is in the ON position and also the light switch is in the 1st or
2nd position. The BCM receives input requesting fog lamp operation. The BCM then supplies power to the fog
lamps.
• Stop Lamp: When the brake pedal is applied, the stop lamp switch sends the signal to the RBCM. The RBCM
then supplies power to the stop lamps.
• Backup Lamp: When the BCM receives the signal from the backup lamp switch, then the BCM supplies power
to the backup lamp.
Specification
Torque Specifications
Electrical Schematics
Headlamp Aiming System (Page 1 of 2)
15
LTSMW150015T
LTSMW150016T
15
LTSMW150018T
LTSMW150019T
15
LTSMW150020T
LTSMW150021T
15
LTSMW150022T
LTSMW150023T
15
LTSMW150017T
LTSMW150024T
LTSM150037
LTSM150125
15
LTSM150039
LTSM150126
Headlamp
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the front combination lamp assembly (See Front Combination Lamp Assembly Removal & Installation in
Section 15 Body & Accessories).
2. Remove the headlamp bulb cover.
3. Disconnect the headlamp bulb electrical connector.
4. Remove the headlamp bulb clip.
5. Carefully remove the bulb (1) for the high/low
beam headlamp.
6. Replace the bulb with a new bulb as needed.
7. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150141
15
LTSM150038
LTSM150143
LTSM150082
Tail/Backup/Stop Lamp
Removal & Installation
1. Open the plug cover of storage box at rear luggage
cabin.
2. Use a screwdriver and remove the internal protec-
tive cover (1).
LTSM150144
LTSM150146 15
Turn Signal Lamp
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the front combination lamp (See Front Combination Lamp Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body &
Accessories).
LTSM150142
3. Remove the rear combination lamp (See Rear Combination Lamp Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body &
Accessories).
4. Replace the rear turn signal lamp bulb.
LTSM150146
LTSM150041
LTSM150124
15
LTSM150040
LTSM150145
LTSM150083
FUEL DOOR
Fuel Door
Removal & Installation
1. Open the fuel door.
2. Remove the two fuel door retaining bolts (1).
(Tighten: Fuel door bolts to 5 N·m)
3. Remove the fuel door.
4. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
15
LTSM150128
LTSM150105
LTSM150107
LTSM150108
LTSM150104
15
LTSM150102
LTSM150103
LTSM150132
Operation
The horn system circuit is designed so that the system will remain operational, regardless of the ignition switch posi-
tion.
15
Electrical Schematics
Horn (Page 1 of 1)
LTSMW150003T
Horn
Removal & Installation
1. Remove the right headlamp assembly.
2. Disconnect the horn electrical connector.
3. Remove the horn mounting nuts (1).
(Tighten: Horn mounting nuts to 8 N·m)
4. Remove the horn.
5. Remove the other horn like this horn.
6. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150084
15
Operation
Use the mirror select switch, located on the driver’s door trim panel to adjust the view obtained in the outside mirrors.
Rotate the joystick for Left or Right mirror selection. Select a mirror and press the joystick that correspond with the
direction that you want the mirror to move.
Electrical Schematics
Power Mirrors (Page 1 of 2)
15
LTSMW150007T
LTSMW150008T
15
LTSMW150009T
LTSMW150010T
Outside Mirror
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the outside mirror trim cover.
3. Remove the outside mirror retaining bolts (1).
4. Disconnect the outside mirror electrical connector
(2).
5. Remove the outside mirror assembly.
6. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Installation Notes:
• If replacing the outside mirror lens, remove the lens
and replace it before reinstalling the mirror.
BESM150106
15
LTSM060016
15
LTSM060004
Electrical Schematics
Rear Window Defogger (Page 1 of 1)
15
LTSMW150011T
Front Windshield
Removal
1. Remove the wiper arms and the lower trim panel from the windshield (See Wiper Arm Removal & Installation in
Section 15 Body & Accessories).
2. Using piano wire, insert the piano wire between the
body and the glass. Attach wooden blocks to both
ends of the piano wire.
CAUTION:
To prevent vehicle paint damage, use adhesive
tape on painted surfaces during windshield
removal. Place a plastic cover between the
piano wire and the instrument panel to prevent
the instrument panel from being scuffed when
removing the glass.
BESM150013
3. Pull the piano wire around the glass, and cut off
the bonding agent to remove the glass.
NOTE :
Leave as much bonding agent as possible on the body
when removing the bonding portion of the glass.
BESM150014
Installation
1. Remove the rough portions on the body with a knife and clean the cut bonding agent with a rag soaked with
cleaning solvent.
CAUTION:
Even if the entire bonding agent has been cleared, you should also clean the body surface. Do not
touch the glass surface after cleaning.
2. Remove the stopper with a knife.
3. Clear the bonding agent adhered to the glass with a scraper and clean the glass with glass cleaner.
NOTE :
Do not touch the glass after cleaning.
NOTE :
BESM150015
Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning.
7. Install the water resistance piece:
• Install the water resistance piece using double face adhesive tape as shown in the figure.
8. Apply a layer of primer M on the contact surface of
the body and apply a layer of primer M on the con-
tact face of the body with a brush.
BESM150016
NOTE :
Allow the primer coat to dry for a minimum of 3 minutes. Do not apply the primer to the bonding agent. Do not save
the opened primer M for later use.
9. Apply a layer of primer G on the contact surface of the glass:
• Apply a layer of primer G on the edges and the contact surface of the glass with a brush or sponge.
• Wipe the excess primer off with a clean rag before it dries.
NOTE :
Allow the primer coat to dry for a minimum of 3 minutes. Do not apply the primer to the bonding agent. Do not save
the opened primer G for later use.
10. Mixing the bonding agent: 15
• Clean a mixing board and a scraper completely with solvent.
• Thoroughly mix 500 grams of host crystal with 75 grams of hardener on a mixing board with a scraper.
NOTE :
Make sure that the molding be installed before the bonding agent has cured.
BESM150017
CAUTION:
Verify that the water resistant piece is adhered to the panel of the body as shown in the figure.
13. To install the glass, align the reference marks on
the glass and the body and then lightly press the
glass into the body opening.
14. Apply the bonding agent on the edges of the glass
with a scraper.
15. Remove any excessive or over flown bonding
agent with a scraper.
16. Clamp the glass until the bonding agent has hard-
ened.
17. Check for water leakage:
• Perform the leakage test after the hardening period.
• Seal any leaks with the proper sealant.
18. Install the upper molding of the windshield:
• Install the upper windshield molding on the body BESM150018
Rear Window
Removal
1. Open the back cargo door.
2. Remove the back cargo door trim panel.
3. Disconnect the defroster grid electrical connector.
4. Remove the double face adhesive tape at both ends of the molding with a scraper.
5. Rear window removal:
• Using piano wire, insert the piano wire between the body and the glass.
• Attach wooden blocks to both ends of the piano wire.
• Pull the piano wire through between the body and the glass from inside of the vehicle.
• Pull the piano wire along the bonding agent to cut it off.
CAUTION:
Do not let the piano wire damage the two stoppers.
• Remove the rear window.
Installation
1. Place the rear window molding around the glass and fit it manually.
2. Remove the rough portions on the body with a knife and clean the cut bonding agent with a rag soaked with
cleaning solvent.
CAUTION:
Even if the entire bonding agent has been cleared, you should also clean the body surface. Do not
touch the glass surface after cleaning.
3. Remove the stopper with a knife.
4. Clean the removed rear window:
• Clean any bonding agent adhered to the glass with a scraper.
• Remove the stopper with a knife.
• Clean the glass with glass cleaner.
NOTE :
Do not touch the glass after cleaning
5. Position the glass:
• Place the glass in the proper position.
• Make reference marks on the glass and the body.
• Remove the glass.
6. Clean the contact surface of the glass:
NOTE: Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning.
• Clear any residue around the peripheral contact face of the glass with glass cleaner.
7. Apply a layer of primer M on the contact surface of the body with a brush.
NOTE :
Allow the primer coat to dry for a minimum of 3 minutes. Do not apply the primer to the bonding agent. Do not save
the opened primer M for later use.
8. Apply a layer of primer G on the contact surface of the glass:
• Apply a layer of primer G on the edges and the contact surface of the glass with a brush or sponge.
• Wipe the excess primer off with a clean rag before it dries.
NOTE :
Allow the primer coat to dry for a minimum of 3 minutes. Do not apply the primer to the bonding agent. Do not save
the opened primer G for later use.
9. Mixing the bonding agent:
• Clean a mixing board and a scraper completely with solvent.
• Thoroughly mix 500 grams of host crystal with 75 grams of hardener on a mixing board with a scraper.
NOTE :
Make sure that the molding is installed within the application period of the bonding agent, and the bonding agent
should be mixed within 5 minutes.
10. Applying the bonding agent:
• Cut off the pot tip and fill the bonding agent into
the pot.
• Place the pot into the sealant gun.
• Apply the bonding agent on the glass as shown in
the figure.
15
BESM150017
CAUTION:
Verify that the water resistant piece is adhered to the panel of the body as shown in the figure.
12. To install the glass, align the reference marks on
the glass and the body and then lightly press the
glass into the body opening.
13. Apply the bonding agent on the edges of the glass
with a scraper.
14. Remove any excessive or over flown bonding
agent with a scraper.
15. Clamp the glass until the bonding agent has hard-
ened.
16. Check for water leakage:
• Perform the leakage test after the hardening period.
• Seal any leaks with the proper sealant.
17. Install the rear window molding:
• Install the rear window outer lower molding on the BESM150018
15
BESM150008
Operation
The sunroof control module monitors the sunroof switch input. The sunroof control module controls the output of the
sunroof motor, to move the sunroof glass to the requested position. The power sunroof will operate with the ignition
switch turned to ON.
Electrical Schematics
Sunroof (Page 1 of 2)
15
LTSMW150033T
Sunroof (Page 2 of 2)
LTSMW150034T
15
Installation Notes:
• Operate the power switch to adjust the sliding
mechanism without the glass to the full open posi-
tion, and then place the glass in the middle of the
support bar of the sliding mechanism.
• Loosely install four bolts. Then pull the glass for-
ward slightly and tighten the other bolts slightly
from the middle one by one.
• Operate the sun roof to the full closed position. BESM150009
• Begin to adjust the four glass retaining bolts while
pulling the glass slightly forward.
• Turn on the power switch and operate the sun roof to test the operation (check and adjust the height/start-up
noise/collision of the glass).
• Move the glass to the full open position again, and then stick the inner trim strip to the support bar of the slid-
ing mechanism.
• Test the on/off operation, starting and running operation as well as the noise of the sun roof after installation to
make sure that no abnormal conditions exist.
BESM150010
BESM150011
15
BESM150115
Installation Notes:
• During the weatherstrip installation, every corner should be fitted in place with no folds. The joint of the weath-
erstrip should be placed in the lower middle of the door opening. The weatherstrip should have a proper rigidity
and should not interfere with the opening and closing of the door after the lock and hinge have been adjusted.
The surface of the assembled rubber strip should not have any defects such as deformation and warp.
Installation Notes:
• During the weatherstrip installation, every corner
should be fitted in place with no folds. The joint
of the weatherstrip should be placed in the lower
middle of the door opening. The weatherstrip
should have a proper rigidity and should not
interfere with the opening and closing of the door
after the lock and hinge have been adjusted. The
surface of the assembled rubber strip should not
have any defects such as deformation and warp.
BESM150115
15
Operation
The wiper system is controlled by the wiper and washer switch. The wiper and washer system operate with the
ignition switch is in the ON position. All wiper and washer functions are controlled by rotating the control knob on the
end of the control stalk to the MIST, OFF, INT, LO or HI wiper positions.
Electrical Schematics
Wiper and Washer System (Page 1 of 4)
15
LTSMW150013T
LTSMW150014T
15
LTSMW150083T
LTSMW150084T
LTSM150033
LTSM150034
15
LTSM150035
LTSM150036
LTSM150033
15
LTSM150035
LTSM150034
Washer Bottle
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front bumper (See Front Bumper
Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body &
Accessories).
3. Disconnect the washer hose and the washer pump
electrical connector.
4. Remove the mounting bolts (1) as shown to
remove the washer bottle.
5. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
LTSM150101
Washer Pump
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front bumper (See Front Bumper Removal & Installation in Section 15 Body & Accessories).
3. Disconnect the washer hose and the washer pump electrical connector.
4. Drain the washer fluid.
5. Remove the washer pump assembly.
6. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Wiper Switch
Removal & Installation
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the steering wheel (See Steering Wheel Removal & Installation in Section 11 Steering).
3. Remove the steering column shroud retaining
screws (1) and then remove the shroud.
LTSM110031
15
LTSM150106
WIRING INFORMATION
GENERAL INFORMATION 16-2 Voltmeter 16-5
Description 16-2 Ohmmeter 16-6
Electrical Schematics 16-2
International Symbols 16-3 ELECTRICAL REPAIR 16-7
Wire Repair 16-7
ELECTRICAL TROUBLESHOOTING 16-4 Fuse Replacement 16-7
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems 16-4
Testing For Voltage 16-4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 16-8
Testing For Continuity 16-4 Battery Cable 16-8
Testing For A Short To Ground 16-4 Sensors, Switches, and Relays 16-8
Intermittent and Poor Connections 16-4 Connectors 16-8
ELECTRICAL TROUBLESHOOTING
TOOLS 16-5
Jumper Wires 16-5
16
Electrical Schematics
The electrical schematics are grouped into individual service manual chapters. If a component is most likely found in
a particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For example, the
Engine Control Module (ECM) is most likely to be found in Chapter 03 (Electronic Engine Controls), so it is shown
there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated wiring.
Chery electrical schematics are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content. In order to
effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair Chery vehicles, it is important to understand the following
features and characteristics:
• Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the page, and the
ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
• All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and the key
removed from the ignition switch.
• Components are shown with a solid line around the component.
• It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and wiring as they
appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a long one.
• Switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard to function only.
International Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with those being used
around the world. See How to read Electrical Schematics in Section 01 General Information.
16
BESMW010001T
CAUTION:
Do not connect a jumper wire from the power
source line to a body ground. This may cause
burning or other damage to wiring harnesses
or electronic components.
BESM010026
Voltmeter
• The DC voltmeter is used to measure circuit volt-
age. A voltmeter with a range of 15 V or more is
used by connecting the positive (+) probe (red
lead wire) to the point where voltage will be
measured and the negative (-) probe (black lead
wire) to a body ground.
BESM010027T
16
Ohmmeter
• The ohmmeter is used to measure the resistance
between two points in a circuit and to check for
continuity and short circuits.
CAUTION:
Do not connect the ohmmeter to any circuit
where voltage is applied. This will damage the
ohmmeter.
BESM010028
NOTE :
Do not use acid core solder when making wiring repairs.
5. Solder the connection together using a soldering iron and rosin core type solder only.
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly
sealed and sealant comes out of both ends of the tubing.
Fuse Replacement
• When replacing a fuse, be sure to replace it with
one of the same capacity. If a fuse fails again,
the circuit probably has a short and the wiring
should be checked.
• Be sure the negative battery terminal is discon-
nected before replacing a main fuse.
• When replacing a pullout fuse, use the fuse
puller.
BESM010025
16
LTSMW170001
BESM010024
Connectors
Disconnecting Connectors
• When disconnecting 2 connectors, grasp the con-
nectors, not the wires.
BESM010018
BESM010019
Locking Connector
• When locking connectors, listen for a click indicat-
ing they are securely locked.
BESM010020
Connector Terminals
• Pull lightly on individual wires to check that they
are secured in the terminal.
BESM010023
16
Connector/Terminal Replacement
• Use the appropriate tools to remove a terminal as
shown. While installing a terminal, be sure to insert
it until it locks securely.
• Insert a thin piece of metal from the terminal side
of the connector and with the terminal locking tab
pressed down, pull the terminal out from the
connector.
BESM010029
16
Operation
The power distribution system operates all electrical and electronic engine, transmission, chassis, safety, comfort and
convenience systems.
16
LTSMW170021T
LTSMW170022T
16
LTSMW170023T
LTSMW170024T
16
LTSMW170025T
LTSMW170026T
16
LTSMW170027T
LTSMW170028T
16
LTSMW170029T
LTSMW170030T
16
LTSMW170031T
LTSMW170032T
16
LTSMW170033T
Operation
The ground distribution system provides a grounding path for all electrical and electronic engine, transmission, chas-
sis, safety, comfort and convenience systems.
16
LTSMW170040T
16
LTSMW170041T
LTSMW170042T
16
LTSMW170043T
LTSMW170044T
16
LTSMW170045T
LTSMW170046T
16
LTSMW170047T
Operation
When replacing a open fuse, it is important to use only a fuse having the correct amperage rating. The use of a fuse
with a rating other than indicated may result in a dangerous electrical system overload. If a properly rated fuse con-
tinues to open, it indicates a problem in the circuit that must be corrected.
Operation
All of the current from the battery and the generator output enters the power fuse box through the cable and eyelet
that are secured with a nut to the power fuse box B(+) terminal stud located on one end of the power fuse box
housing. The power fuse box terminal stud cover is unlatched and opened to access the fuses.
16
Overview
Power Fuse Box
LTSMW170004T
Operation
When a circuit fails, the fuse will blow and remove current from the circuit. The front fuse and relay box is equipped
with a label that identifies each component. The label is printed on the inside of the cover. The power fuse box
identifies the rating of each fuse individually. Turn off the ignition switch, and then replace the fuse.
16
Overview
Front Fuse And Relay Box
LTSMW170005T
Operation
When a circuit fails, the fuse will blow and remove current from the circuit.
Turn off the ignition switch, and then replace the fuse.
16
Overview
Body Fuse And Relay Box
LTSMW170006T
16
Operation
Use the wiring harness diagrams in each harness section for component, ground and splice identification. Refer to
the appropriate index for the specific vehicle harness.
16
LTSMW170007T
LTSMW170008T
16
LTSMW170018T
16
LTSMW170002T
16
LTSMW170003T
LTSMW170001T
Main Harness
16
LTSMW170014T
16
Body Harness
LTSMW170015T
Roof Harness
LTSMW170016T
16
LTSMW170010T
16
LTSMW170011T
16
LTSMW170013T
16
LTSMW170012T
16
LTSMW170009T
16
Restraints Harness
LTSMW170017T
16
AI-1
INDEX
Crankshaft Position Sensor, 1.6 L & 1.8 L Diagnosis & Testing, Steering Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-19
Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-209 Diagnosis & Testing, Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4
Crankshaft Position Sensor, 2.0L Engine Controls . . . . . 3-411 Diagnosis & Testing, System Plumbing . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-33
Crankshaft Position Sensor, 2.4L Engine Controls . . . . . 3-519 Diagnosis & Testing, Wheel Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-39
Crankshaft, 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . 2-54 Diagnosis & Testing, Wheels and Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-46
Crankshaft, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-123 Diagnosis and Testing, Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Crankshaft, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-219 Diagnosis and Testing, Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Cylinder Head Cover, 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . 2-16 Diagnosis and Testing, Starting System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Cylinder Head Cover, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . 2-84 Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List, Airbag System . . . . 14-8
Cylinder Head Cover, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . 2-159 Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List, Antilock Brakes . . . 12-44
Cylinder Head Unit Repair, Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List,
1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-57 Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-107, 15-60
Cylinder Head Unit Repair, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . 2-126 Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List,
Cylinder Head Unit Repair, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . 2-227 DP0 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19
Cylinder Head, 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . 2-20, 2-57 Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List,
Cylinder Head, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . 2-126, 2-88 F4A4 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-160
Cylinder Head, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . 2-164, 2-227 Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests,
1.6 L & 1.8 L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32
D Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests,
2.0L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-249
Diagnosing An Electrical Failure,
Electrical Circuit Diagnosis Information . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests,
2.4L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-448
Diagnosis & Testing, 1.6 L & 1.8 L Engine Controls . . . 3-18
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests, Airbag System . . 14-10
Diagnosis & Testing, 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . 2-11
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests, Antilock Brakes . . 12-45
Diagnosis & Testing, 2.0L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . 3-233
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests,
Diagnosis & Testing, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . 2-79
Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-110, 15-61
Diagnosis & Testing, 2.4L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . 3-436
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests, DP0 Automatic
Diagnosis & Testing, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . 2-153 Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21
Diagnosis & Testing, 5-Speed Manual Transaxle . . . . . . 8-264 Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Tests,
Diagnosis & Testing, Air Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-27 F4A4 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-162
Diagnosis & Testing, Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-7 Differential Carrier, Front Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-316
Diagnosis & Testing, Antilock Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-42 Differential Unit Repair, Front Differential . . . . . . . . . . . 8-316
Diagnosis & Testing, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7 Door Lock Assembly, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-32
Diagnosis & Testing, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-215 Door Lock Switch, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-32
Diagnosis & Testing, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . 15-106, 15-58 Door Locks, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-26
Diagnosis & Testing, Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15 Doors, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-158
Diagnosis & Testing, DP0 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . 8-17 DP0 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
Diagnosis & Testing, Drive Shaft (4x4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26 DPO Automatic Transaxle Assembly, DP0 Automatic
Diagnosis & Testing, F4A4 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . 8-159 Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-140
Diagnosis & Testing, Front Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4 Drive Shaft (4x4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24
Diagnosis & Testing, Front Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 Driver Side Airbag, Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-41
Diagnosis & Testing, Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . 4-12
E
Diagnosis & Testing, Manual Temperature Control . . . . 13-12
ECM Power Supply and Ground Circuit Test,
Diagnosis & Testing, Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-79
1.6 L & 1.8 L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25
Diagnosis & Testing, Power Steering Pump . . . . . . . . . 11-29
ECM Power Supply and Ground Circuit Test,
Diagnosis & Testing, Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 2.0L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-242
Diagnosis & Testing, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 ECM Power Supply and Ground Circuit Test,
Diagnosis & Testing, Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11 2.4L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-441
AI-2
INDEX
AI-3
INDEX
Front Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1 Interactive Torque Management (ITM) System (4x4) . . 9-17
Front Wheel Alignment, Wheel Alignment . . . . . . . . . . 10-41 General Information, Manual Temperature Control . . . . . 13-2
Front Wheel Speed Sensor, Antilock Brakes . . . . . . . . . 12-74 General Information, Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-77
Front Windshield, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-206 General Information, Power Steering Pump . . . . . . . . . 11-28
Front Wiper Arm, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-227 General Information, Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9
Front Wiper Link, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-228 General Information, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24
Front Wiper Motor, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-225 General Information, Seat Belt System . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-45
Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 General Information, Starting System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Fuel Door, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-187 General Information, Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9
Fuel Door, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187 General Information, Steering Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18
Fuel Filter, Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 General Information, Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2
Fuel Injector Rail, Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 General Information, System Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18
Fuel Injector, Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20 General Information, System Plumbing . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-31
Fuel Pressure Regulator - With Mitsubishi 2.4L Engine, General Information, Transfer Case (4x4) . . . . . . . . . . 8-328
Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22 General Information, Vehicle Fuse Box Information . . . . 16-37
Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure, Fuel Delivery System . . . 4-14 General Information, Vehicle Ground Distribution . . . . . 16-27
Fuel Pump, Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 General Information, Vehicle Power Distribution . . . . . . 16-12
General Information, Vehicle Wiring Harness Layout . . . 16-44
G
General Information, Wheel Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36
Gear Selector & Shifter Assembly,
General Information, Wheels and Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-45
5-Speed Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-269
General Information, Wiring Information . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-2
General Information, 1.6 L & 1.8 L Engine Controls . . . . 3-3
Generator, Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
General Information, 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . . 2-3
Grille, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-188
General Information, 2.0L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . 3-219
Grille, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
General Information, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . 2-71
General Information, 2.4L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . 3-423 H
General Information, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . 2-141
Headlamp, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-181
General Information, 5-Speed Manual Transaxle . . . . . . 8-254
Headliner, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-12
General Information, Air Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-25
Heated Seat Element, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-103
General Information, Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2
Heated Seat Switch, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-103
General Information, Antilock Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-34
Heater Core, System Plumbing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-44
General Information, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
High Mounted Stop Lamp, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . 15-185
General Information, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-98
Horn, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-193, 15-195
General Information, Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
How To Locate Electrical Schematics In
General Information, Clutch System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-320 The Service Manual, Electrical Information . . . . . . . . . 1-24
General Information, Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 How To Read Electrical Schematics,
General Information, DP0 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . 8-3 Electrical Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
General Information, Drive Shaft (4x4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25 How To Use This Manual, Service Information . . . . . . . . 1-2
General Information, Evaporative Emissions . . . . . . . . . 3-587 HVAC Housing, Air Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-28
General Information, Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
General Information, F4A4 Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . 8-147 I
General Information, Front Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2 Idle Air Control Motor, 2.4L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . 3-518
General Information, Front Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-312 Idler Pulley, 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . 2-37
General Information, Front Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2 Idler Pulley, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-106
General Information, Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 Ignition Coil 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L, Ignition Control . . . . 3-581
General Information, Ignition Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-576 Ignition Coil 2.4L, Ignition Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-582
General Information, Ignition Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-575
AI-4
INDEX
AI-5
INDEX
On-Vehicle Service, Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12 Power Window Switch, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-94
On-Vehicle Service, Steering Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-20 Power Windows, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-90
On-Vehicle Service, Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6 Proper Service Practices, Service Information . . . . . . . . . 1-5
On-Vehicle Service, System Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-23
On-Vehicle Service, System Plumbing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-35 R
On-Vehicle Service, Transfer Case (4x4) . . . . . . . . . . . 8-329 Radiator Support, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-203
On-Vehicle Service, Wheels and Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-47 Radiator Support, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Output Gear For Reverse Gear, Radiator, Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
5-Speed Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-301 Radio, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-7
Output Shaft, 5-Speed Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . 8-293 Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Outside Mirror, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-201 Rear Axle Assembly (4x4), Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
Oxygen Sensor, 1.6 L & 1.8 L Engine Controls . . . . . . 3-208 Rear Brake Backing Plate, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-23
Oxygen Sensor, 2.0L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-410 Rear Brake Caliper, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . 12-20, 12-30
Oxygen Sensor, 2.4L Engine Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-513 Rear Brake Pads, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-25
Rear Brake Rotor, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-22
P Rear Coil Spring, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31
Paint Codes, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-202 Rear Combination Lamp Assembly, Body Exterior . . . . 15-180
Paint, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-202 Rear Crankshaft Oil Seal,
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-76 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
Parking Brake Cable, Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-81 Rear Crankshaft Oil Seal, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . 2-91
Parking Brake Lever, Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-81 Rear Crankshaft Oil Seal, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . 2-168
Parking Brake Shoes, Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-82 Rear Door Weatherstrip, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . 15-219
Pedal Pad, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-12 Rear Door, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-163
Pistons, 1.6L & 1.8L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47 Rear Fog Lamp, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-182
Pistons, 2.0L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-116 Rear Hub and Bearing, Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12
Pistons, 2.4L Engine Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-206 Rear Intermediate Drive Shaft, Drive Shaft (4x4) . . . . . . 9-27
Positive Battery Cable, Starting System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Rear Lower Control Arm, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . 10-28
Power Brake Booster - LHD, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . 12-14 Rear Seat Belt and Pre-Tensioner, Seat Belt System . . . 14-48
Power Brake Booster - RHD, Base Brakes . . . . . . . . . . 12-16 Rear Seats, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-101
Power Fuse Box, Vehicle Fuse Box Information . . . . . . 16-37 Rear Shock Absorber, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30
Power Outlet, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-87 Rear Stabilizer Bar Link, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . . 10-30
Power Steering Filling and Flushing, Steering System . . . 11-6 Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir, Rear Trailing Arm Assembly, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . 10-32
Power Steering Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-33 Rear Upper Control Arm, Rear Suspension . . . . . . . . . 10-29
Power Steering Pressure and Rear Wheel Alignment, Wheel Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42
Return Hoses - 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L, Power Steering
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor, Antilock Brakes . . . . . . . . . 12-75
Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-34
Rear Window, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-208
Power Steering Pressure and Return Hoses - 2.4L, Power
Steering Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-36 Rear Wiper Arm, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-227
Power Steering Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-27 Rear Wiper Motor, Body Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-226
Power Steering Pump - 1.6L & 1.8L & 2.0L, Recirculation Door Actuator, System Controls . . . . . . . 13-23
Power Steering Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) (FOB) Inoperative,
Power Steering Pump - 2.4L, Power Steering Pump . . . 11-32 Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-108
Power Window Motor, Body Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-94 Restraints Control Module, Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . 14-43
AI-6
INDEX
T
AI
AI-7
INDEX
AI-8